READING HALLDOORS OF WISDOM |
BIOGRAPHIKA : UNIVERSAL LIBRARY
Captain Cook1728 –1779
ByW.H.G. Kingston
Chapter One.
Captain
Cook—His Life, Voyages, and Discoveries. Early Training.
Among all those Englishmen who, from a humble origin,
have risen to an honourable position, Captain James Cook is especially worthy
of record. His parents were of the peasant class—his father having commenced
life as a farm-labourer, and his mother being a cottager’s daughter. Probably, however,
they were both superior to others of the same station, as the husband, in
process of time, became farm-bailiff to his employer—a Mr Thomas Skottowe. This
was about the year 1730, and the farm of which he had the management was called
Airy-Holme, near Ayton, in Yorkshire. Not far from this place, at the village
of Marton, near Stockton-upon-Tees; his son James was born, on October 27,
1728. James was one of nine children, all of whom he survived, with the
exception of a sister who married a fisherman at Redcar.
The father of this family spent the latter years of
his life with his daughter at Redcar, and was supposed to have been about
eighty-five years old at the time of his death; so that he must have had the
satisfaction of seeing his son rising in his profession, though probably he
little thought of that son as establishing a fame which would be handed down in
history.
James Cook does not appear to have enjoyed any
peculiar educational advantages, but owed his subsequent advancement chiefly to
his own intelligence, perseverance, and diligence. He first went to a village
school, and was afterwards sent, at the expense of Mr Skottowe, to an ordinary
commercial school, kept by a Mr Pullen. He continued there four years, and was
then apprenticed to Mr William Sanderson, a grocer and haberdasher at the
fishing town of Straiths, ten miles from Whitby. It may be supposed that the
occupation in which he was engaged was not suited to his taste. The sea was
constantly before his eyes, and the desire to seek his fortune on it sprang up
within him, and grew stronger and stronger, till in about a year after he went
to Straiths he obtained a release from his engagement with Mr Sanderson, and
apprenticed himself to Messrs Walker and Company, shipowners of Whitby. He went
to sea for the first time when he was about eighteen, on board one of their
vessels—the Truelove collier, of four hundred and fifty tons burden,
trading between Newcastle and London. The lad soon showed that he was well
fitted for his new profession, and in 1748, not two years after he had
commenced it, we find him especially directed to assist in fitting for sea the
Three Brothers, a new ship of six hundred tons. While he served on board this
ship she was hired by Government as a transport; and on her being paid off she
was employed in the Norway trade.
After making several voyages in the Three Brothers up
the Baltic, young Cook was promoted to the rank of mate on board the
Friendship. He had by this time gained the goodwill of his employers; and had
made several other friends on shore, who, before long, were enabled to render
him essential service. He was now known as a thorough seamen;
indeed, from the moment he went on board ship, he had steadily applied his mind
to acquiring a knowledge of his profession. Still he served on as mate of the
Friendship till the breaking out of the war between England and France in 1756,
when he made up his mind to push his fortunes in the Royal Navy. He knew that
at all events there was a great probability of his being pressed into the
service, and he had good reason to hope that he might be placed ere long on the
quarter-deck, since many young men at that time had been who went to sea, as he
had done, before the mast. He accordingly volunteered, and entered as an able
seaman on board the Eagle, of sixty guns, then commanded by Captain Hamer, but
shortly afterwards by Captain Palliser, who became the well-known Sir Hugh
Palliser—Cook’s warm and constant friend.
As soon as the young sailor’s Yorkshire friends heard
that he had entered on board a man-of-war, they exerted themselves on his
behalf, and a letter of introduction was procured from Mr Osbaldeston, Member
for the county, to his captain, who, having already remarked the intelligence
and assiduity Cook exhibited in all his professional duties, was the more ready
to give him a helping hand.
Considering how best he could assist the young man,
who had served too short a time in the Navy to obtain a commission, Captain
Palliser advised that a master’s warrant should be procured for him—this being
a position for which, both from age and experience, he was well fitted. This was done; and on May 10, 1759, James Cook was
appointed to the Grampus, sloop of war, and was now in a fair way of gaining
the object of his ambition. He had, however, to undergo a trial of patience at
the first outset of his career; for the former master returning, his
appointment was cancelled. His friends were not idle, and four days after this
he was made master of the Garland; but on going to join her he found that she
had already sailed for her destination. On the following day, May 15, he was
appointed to the Mercury, on the point of sailing for the North American
station to join the fleet under Sir Charles Saunders, which, in conjunction
with the army under General Wolfe, was engaged in the siege of Quebec. The
termination of that contest gained for Great Britain one of her finest
provinces. To this success Cook contributed in his particular department; and
it is remarkable that he should have been in various ways instrumental in
giving to his country the three finest provinces she possesses—Canada, the
Australian settlements, and New Zealand.
James Cook was now about thirty-two years of age, and
although the position in life he had filled for the previous twelve years was
not one (especially in those days) conducive to refinement of manners, he
appears from the first to have conducted himself with propriety and credit. He
had already shown his superiority as a seaman. He was now to exhibit his
talents in the more scientific part of his profession, in which officers in the
Navy were in those days greatly deficient.
It was necessary to take the soundings in the channel
of the Saint Lawrence, between the Isle of Orleans and the north shore,
directly in front of the French fortified camp of Montmorency and Beauport, in
order to enable the admiral to place his ships so as to oppose the enemy’s
batteries, and to cover the projected landing of the British army under Wolfe,
and a general attack on their camp. Captain Palliser, who now commanded the
Shrewsbury, a seventy-four gun ship, recommended Cook for this difficult and
dangerous service. He was engaged on it for many consecutive nights, it being a
work which could not be performed in the daytime. At length his proceedings
were discovered by the French, who laid a plan to catch him. They concealed in
a wood near the water a number of Indians with their canoes. As the Mercury’s
barge, in which Cook was making the survey, passed, the canoes darted out on
him and gave chase. His only chance of escape was to run for it. He pushed for
the Isle of Orleans with a whole host of yelling savages paddling at full speed
after him. On they came, every moment gaining on his boat. The English
hospital, where there was a guard, was before him; towards this he steered, the
bows of the Indian canoes almost touching the barge’s stern; a few strokes more, and the Indians would have grappled him. He sprang
from his seat over the bow of his boat, followed by his crew, just as the enemy
leaped in overwhelming numbers over the quarters. They carried off the barge in
triumph, but Cook and his comrades escaped; and he succeeded, in spite of all
difficulties, in furnishing the admiral with a correct and complete draft of
the channel and soundings. This was the more extraordinary, as Sir Hugh
Palliser afterwards expressed his belief that before this time Cook had
scarcely ever used a pencil, and knew nothing of drawing; and it is one of many
proofs that the ardent seaman not only threw his soul into the duties of his
profession, but that this determination enabled him quickly to master every
subject to which he applied his mind.
While his ship remained in the Saint Lawrence, Cook,
at the desire of the admiral, made an accurate survey of the more difficult
parts of that river below Quebec. So complete and perfect was the chart which
he executed, and which, with his sailing directions, was afterwards published,
that until a late period no other was thought necessary. So little were the
English acquainted with the navigation of the river before this, that when,
early in the season, the fleet under Rear-Admiral Darell arrived at its mouth,
some difficulty was expected in getting up it. Fortunately, when off the island
of Caudec, the inhabitants, mistaking the English ships for their own fleet,
sent off their best pilots. These were of course detained, and proved of great
use in taking the English fleet up the river.
After the conquest of Canada had been accomplished,
Admiral Saunders despatched the larger ships to England, following himself in
the Somerset, and leaving the command of the fleet in North America to Captain
Lord Colvill, who had his commodore’s flag flying on board the Northumberland.
To this ship Cook was appointed as master, by warrant from his lordship, on
September 22, 1739. The squadron wintered at Halifax. Cook employed the leisure
which the winter afforded him in acquiring that knowledge which especially
fitted him for the service in which he was thereafter to be engaged. At Halifax
he first read Euclid, and began to study astronomy and other branches of
science, in which, considering the few books to which he had access, and the
want of assistance from others, he made wonderful progress. In the following
year, 1760, a lieutenant’s commission was presented to him as a reward for his
services.
In 1762 the Northumberland was engaged in the
recapture of Newfoundland. The activity which Cook displayed in surveying its
harbour and heights attracted the attention of Captain Graves, the acting
governor, and commander of the Antelope. Captain Graves, on becoming farther
acquainted with Cook, formed a high opinion of his abilities, while he admired
the energy and perseverance he exhibited in surveying the neighbouring coasts
and harbours.
At the end of the year Cook went to England, and on
December 21 he married, at Barking, in Essex, Miss Elizabeth Batts, a young
lady of respectable family, to whom he had some time before been engaged. As
she died in 1835, at the age of ninety-three, she must at the time of her
marriage have been twenty years old. Her husband was tenderly attached to her,
but his married life, like that of most sailors, had long and frequent
interruptions. She bore him six children, three of whom died in their infancy.
Soon after Cook’s marriage, peace with France and
Spain was concluded. On this Captain Graves was again appointed Governor of
Newfoundland. As the island was of great importance to England, he obtained
from the Government, with some difficulty, an establishment for the survey of
its coasts, and offered the direction of it to Cook, who, notwithstanding his
recent marriage, accepted the offer. In the following year, 1764, Sir Hugh
Palliser being appointed Governor of Newfoundland and Labrador, Cook was made
Marine Surveyor of the Province, the Grenville schooner being placed under his
command. The charts made by Cook enlightened the Government as to the value of
Newfoundland, and induced them, when drawing up articles of peace with France,
to insist on arrangements which secured to Great Britain the advantages which
its coasts afford. Not content, however, with merely surveying the shore, Cook
penetrated into the interior of the country, and
discovered several lakes hitherto unknown.
On August 5 an eclipse of the sun occurred, an
observation of which was taken by Cook from one of the Burgeo Islands, near the
south-west end of Newfoundland. The paper that he wrote on it was published in
the Philosophical Transactions of the Royal Society. This fact alone proves
that he must already have become a good mathematician and astronomer. The last
time he went to Newfoundland as marine surveyor was in 1767.
We have now briefly traced the career of James Cook
from his childhood to the period when he had established his character as an
able seaman, a scientific navigator, and a good officer. He was soon to have an
opportunity of proving to his country and to the world in general the very high
degree in which he possessed these qualities, and which enabled him to accomplish
an undertaking which has proved of inestimable benefit to millions of the human
race. By his means, discovery was made of fertile lands of vast extent,
previously trodden only by the feet of wandering savages; and numberless
tribes, sunk in the grossest idolatry and human degradation, were made known to
the Christian world. And Christians, roused at length to a sense of their
responsibility, began to devise means, under the blessing of God, for teaching
these, their ignorant brethren of the human family, the knowledge of the only
true God, and the way of eternal life.
Chapter Two.
First
Voyage of Discovery. August 1768 to July
1771.
In the year 1763, on the restoration of peace, the
desire to explore unknown seas and to discover new countries revived among the
English, and was warmly encouraged by King George the Third. Two expeditions
were at once fitted out to circumnavigate the globe—one under Lord Byron, and
the other under Captains Wallis and Carteret; the former commanding the
Dolphin, in which Lord Byron had just returned, the latter the Swallow. As,
however, Captains Wallis and Carteret accidentally parted company at an early
period of their voyage, and kept different routes, they are generally considered
as having led two separate expeditions.
Before the return of these ships, another expedition
was determined on, the immediate object of which was to observe a transit of
Venus which it had been calculated by astronomers would occur in 1769. It was
believed that one of the Marquesas, or one of the Friendly Islands, called, by
Tasman, Amsterdam, Rotterdam, and Middleburg, would be an advantageous spot for
making the proposed observation.
The King was memorialised by the Royal Society, and
through his Majesty’s intervention the Lords Commissioners of the Admiralty
undertook to furnish a suitable vessel and crew to convey the astronomers and
other scientific persons who might be selected to carry out the proposed
objects. The Royal Society had fixed on Mr Alexander Dalrymple to take the
direction of the expedition; but as he was not in the Royal Navy, Sir Edward
Hawke, then at the head of the Admiralty, would not hear of his being appointed.
Mr Dalrymple, on the other hand, would not consent to go unless he received a
brevet commission as captain. It was necessary, therefore, to find some one
else, and Mr Stephens, the Secretary of the Admiralty, a warm supporter of the
expedition, mentioned Cook to the Board, and suggested that Sir Hugh Palliser’s
opinion should be asked respecting him. This, as may be supposed, was in every
respect favourable; and consequently Lieutenant Cook was directed to hold
himself in readiness to take command of the proposed expedition. Sir Hugh
Palliser was requested to select a fit ship for the purpose, and with Cook’s
assistance he fixed on a barque of three hundred and seventy tons, to which the
name of the Endeavour was given. She mounted ten carriage and ten swivel guns;
her crew, besides the commander, consisted of eighty-four persons, and she was
provisioned for eighteen months.
The well-known Sir Joseph Banks, then Mr Banks, one of
the chief promoters of the expedition, volunteered to accompany it. On leaving
Oxford he had visited the coasts of Newfoundland and Labrador, to obtain
information on scientific subjects. Although he suffered no small amount of
hardship on that occasion, he returned home with unabated zeal in the cause he
had adopted, and ready again to leave all the advantages which his position
afforded him, for the discomfort and dangers of a long voyage in unknown seas.
Mr Banks was, however, more than a philosopher—he was a large-hearted
philanthropist, and he was animated with the hope of diffusing some of the
advantages of civilisation and Christianity among the people who might be
discovered. He engaged, as naturalist to the expedition, the services of Dr
Solander, a Swede by birth, educated under Linnaeus, from whom he had brought
letters of introduction to England. Mr Banks also, at his own charge, took out
a secretary and two artists—one to make drawings from subjects of natural
history, the other to take sketches of scenery and the portraits of the natives
who might be met with. He had likewise four personal attendants, two of whom
were negroes.
The Government, on its part, appointed Mr Charles
Green, who had long been assistant to Dr Bradley at
the Royal Observatory, Greenwich, to assist Lieutenant Cook in the astronomical
department of the expedition; and in every respect the persons engaged in this
celebrated expedition were well fitted to attain the objects contemplated.
While these preparations were going forward, Captain
Wallis returned from his voyage round the world. He expressed his opinion that
a harbour in an island he had discovered, and called King George’s Island,
since well-known as Otaheite or Tahiti, was a fit spot for observing the
transit of Venus. That island was accordingly to be the first destination of
the Endeavour. After having accomplished the primary object of the voyage, the
commander was directed to proceed in making discoveries through the wide extent
of the Great Southern Ocean.
Lieutenant Cook received his commission as commander
of the Endeavour (which was then in the basin in Deptford Yard) on May 25,
1768. On the 27th he went on board, and immediately began fitting her for sea.
The work in dockyards was not executed so rapidly in those days as it is now,
and it was upwards of two months before the vessel was ready. On July 30 she
dropped down the river; but it was not till August 15 that she reached
Plymouth. On Friday, August 26, the wind becoming fair, the Endeavour finally
put to sea, and commenced the first of one of the most memorable series of
voyages which have ever been performed by a single vessel. Next to Commander
Cook in authority in the Endeavour were her two lieutenants—Zachary Hicks and
John Gore; her senior mate was Charles Clerke, who accompanied Cook in each of
his subsequent voyages, and succeeded to the command of the third expedition on
the death of his beloved captain. He had previously served as midshipman under
Lord Byron in his first voyage round the world.
A long sea voyage is almost always felt to be
extremely tedious and dull to landsmen; but every change in the atmosphere, the
varied appearance presented by the sea, the numberless creatures found in it,
the birds which hovered about the ship or pitched on the rigging, all afforded
matter of interest to the enlightened persons on board the Endeavour.
At Madeira the naturalists of the expedition set to
work collecting specimens. The social condition of the people has probably
altered little since those days, though the monasteries, which then existed,
have long since been abolished. The nuns of the convent of Santa Clara
especially amused Mr Banks and his companions by the simplicity of the
questions they put on hearing that they were philosophers. Among others, they
requested them to ascertain by their art whether a spring of pure water existed
within the walls of their convent, and also when the next thunderstorm would
occur.
On leaving Madeira the course was shaped for Rio de
Janeiro, which was reached on November 13. The voyagers were not treated by the
viceroy with the courtesy which might have been expected. The object of the
voyage was utterly beyond the comprehension of that functionary, who could form
no other conception of the matter than that it had something to do with the
passing of the North Star through the South Pole. This ignorance and suspicion
caused the voyagers a great deal of annoyance during the whole of their stay;
though the viceroy could not refuse them water and other necessaries. When, at
length, these were procured, and the Endeavour was going out of the harbour,
she was fired at from the forts of Santa Cruz. Cook immediately sent on shore
to demand the cause of this act. The excuse offered by the commandant of the
port was that he had received no orders from the viceroy to allow the ship to
pass. It appeared that the letter had been written, but that through neglect it
had not been forwarded. Through the whole of the contest with the viceroy, Cook
behaved with equal spirit and discretion. Among the remarks which Cook makes in
his journal on Brazil, is one on the fearful expense of life at which the royal
gold mines in that country were worked. No less than forty thousand negroes were annually imported to labour in the royal mines.
In the year 1766, through an epidemic, the number required falling short, twenty thousand more were drafted from the town of
Rio. A very similar account may be given of the silver and other mines on the
other side of the continent; while the treacherous system which was organised
to supply the demand for labour from among the inhabitants of the Pacific
Islands must be looked on with even greater horror and indignation than that
which existed for supplying Brazil with slave labour. So strictly were the
Brazilian gold mines guarded, that no stranger was allowed to visit them, and
any person found on the roads leading to them was immediately hanged by the
guards stationed there. Altogether Cook formed a very unfavourable opinion of
the inhabitants of Brazil, though few parts of the tropics surpass it in beauty
of climate, fertility of soil, and power of production.
After a stay of three weeks in the harbour of Rio, the
Endeavour put to sea on December 7, and stood down the coast of South America.
On approaching the latitudes of the Falkland Islands, the crew, complaining of
cold, received what was called a Magellanic jacket, and a pair of trousers made
of a thick woollen stuff called Fearnought. Instead of going through the
Straits of Magellan, as was the custom in those times, the Endeavour was
steered from the Strait of Le Maire between Helen Island and Tierra del Fuego.
On her anchoring in the Bay of Good Success, several of the party went on
shore. Thirty or forty Indians soon made their appearance, but, distrustful of
the strangers, quickly retreated to a distance. On this, Mr Banks and Dr
Solander advanced, when two of the Indians approached them and sat down. As the
Englishmen drew near, the savages rose and each threw away from him a stick
which he had in his hand, returning immediately to their companions and making
signs to the white men to follow. This they did, and friendly relations were at
once established between the two parties. Three of them were induced to go on
board, and were chiefly remarkable for the entire want of interest with which
they regarded all the novelties by which they were surrounded. One of them, who
was conjectured to be a priest, did little else than shout all the time he was
on board. He was supposed, by this, to be engaged in the performance of some
heathenish incantation. When these three men were landed, their fellow-savages
showed great eagerness to learn what they had seen in the strange big canoe, as
they would probably have termed the English ship.
On December 16, Mr Banks and Dr Solander, with Mr
Green, Mr Monkhouse the surgeon, and several attendants, landed, with the
intention of ascending a mountain seen in the distance, and penetrating as far
as they could into the country. The atmosphere when they set out was like that
of a warm spring day in England. It being the middle of summer, the day was one
of the longest in the year. Nothing could have been more favourable for their
expedition. They had gone through a wood, and were about to pass over what at a
distance they had taken to be a plain, but which proved to be a swamp covered
thickly with tangled bushes three feet high. Still they pushed across it, and
reached the mountain, on which Mr Banks and Dr Solander commenced collecting
specimens. Most of the party were greatly fatigued,
and Mr Buchan, the draughtsman, was seized with a fit. He was therefore left
with some of the party while the rest went forward. The weather, however,
changed—the cold became intense, and snow fell very thickly. Dr Solander had
warned his companions not to give way to the sensation of sleepiness which
intense cold produces, yet he was one of the first to propose to lie down and
rest. Mr Banks, however, not without the greatest difficulty, urged him on, but
the two black servants lay down and were frozen to death, and a seaman who
remained with them nearly shared the same fate. The survivors collected
together at night, but their provisions were exhausted; one or two were very
ill, and they were a long day’s journey from the ship. There appeared, indeed,
a great probability that the chief objects of the voyage would be frustrated by
the death of the principal scientific persons engaged in it. After a night of
great anxiety, a vulture they had shot being their only food, the snow
partially cleared off, and they made their way to the beach, which was not so
far distant as they had supposed.
After this disastrous adventure the party again went
on shore, and found a tribe of savages, numbering fifty persons, living in a
collection of conical huts, rudely formed of boughs, and open on the lee side.
The people, who are stout and clumsily formed, had their faces painted, and
were very imperfectly covered with seal-skins. Their chief article of clothing,
indeed, was a small cloak which they wore on the side on which the wind comes
when walking or sitting. They lived chiefly on shell-fish, and in search of
them wandered from place to place. They were considered as among the most dull
and stupid of the human race. No wonder, indeed, considering the few objects on
which their minds could be expanded. A farther acquaintance with these tribes
has shown that they have minds as capable of receiving good impressions as
other human beings, and that they are not destitute of a considerable amount of
intelligence.
The Endeavour took her departure from Cape Horn on
January 26, 1769. She ran for seven hundred leagues without land being seen.
After that she passed several coral islands, the appearance of which is now
familiar to most people, but in those days was but little-known. To three of
them the names of Lagoon Island, Bow Island, and Chain Island were given;
several of them were inhabited.
On April 11 she sighted Otaheite, (now known as
Tahiti) called King George’s Island by Captain Wallis, which appeared high and
mountainous, and on the 13th came to an anchor in Matavai Bay. As she
approached the land numerous canoes came off, their crews carrying young
plantains and other green branches as a sign of friendship. Several of the boughs
were handed on board, and it was intimated that they should be placed in
different parts of the ship to show that the voyagers also wished for peace.
The natives exhibited great satisfaction on this being done. They gladly
exchanged cocoanuts, fruit resembling apples, bread-fruit, and small fish, for
beads and other trifles. They had a pig, which they would not part with for
anything but a hatchet; this Cook would not allow to be given, considering that
if a hatchet was given them it would be considered from that time forward to be
the proper price of a pig.
The bread-fruit, with which the voyagers now first
became acquainted, grows on a tree about the height of an ordinary oak. Its
leaves are about a foot and a half long, of an oblong shape, deeply sinuated
like those of the fig-tree, which they resemble in consistency and colour; they
also, on being broken, exude a white, milky juice. The fruit is about the size
and shape of a child’s head, and the surface is reticulated. It is covered with
a thin skin, and has an oblong core four inches long. The eatable part, which
lies between the skin and the core, is as white as snow, and of the consistency
of new bread. It must be roasted before it is eaten, being first divided into
three or four parts. Its taste is insipid, with a slight sweetness somewhat
resembling the crumb of wheaten bread mixed with a Jerusalem artichoke.
The first person who came off was Owhaw. He was
well-known to Mr Gore, and to others who had been there with Captain Wallis. It
was hoped that he would prove useful, and he was therefore taken on board and
every attention shown him. Captain Cook at once issued a set of rules to govern
the ship’s company in all their intercourse with the natives. They were as
follows:—
“1. To endeavour by every fair means to cultivate a
friendship with the natives; and to treat them with all imaginable humanity.
“2. A proper person or persons will be appointed to
trade with the natives for all manner of provisions, fruit, and other
productions of the earth; and no officer or seaman, or other person belonging
to the ship, excepting such as are so appointed, shall trade or offer to trade
for any sort of provision, fruit, or other productions of the earth, unless
they have leave so to do.
“3. Every person employed on shore, on any duty
whatsoever, is strictly to attend to the same; and if by any neglect he loses
any of his arms or working tools, or suffers them to be stolen, the full value
thereof will be charged against his pay, according to the custom of the Navy in
such cases; and he shall receive such further punishment as the nature of the
case may deserve.
“4. The same penalty will be inflicted on every person
who is found to embezzle, trade, or offer to trade with any part of the ship’s
stores of what nature soever.
“5. No sort of iron, or
anything that is made of iron, or any sort of cloth, or other useful or
necessary articles are to be given in exchange for anything but provisions.”
Though there can be no doubt as to Captain Cook’s own
feelings and wishes, his subordinates did not always act in accordance with
them; and his judicious and benevolent designs with regard to the natives were
thus frequently frustrated. As soon as the ship was secured, he, with Mr Banks,
Dr Solander, and a party of men under arms, went on shore, where they were
received by hundreds of the natives, whose countenances exhibited their
friendly feelings. At first, however, the simple people were so struck with awe
that they approached their visitors crouching down almost on their hands and
feet, while they carried in their hands the green boughs as emblems of peace.
The leader presented Captain Cook with a bough, which he and his companions
received with looks and gestures of kindness and satisfaction. Each of the
Englishmen also immediately gathered a bough, and carried it in the same way
the natives did theirs. The party then proceeded about a mile and a half
towards the place where Captain Wallis’ ship, the Dolphin, had watered. Here a
halt was called, and the natives having cleared away all the plants that grew
on the ground, the principal persons among them threw their green branches on
the bare spot, and made signs that their visitors should do the same. Captain
Cook at once yielded to this request. The marines being drawn up, each as he
passed dropped his bough on those of the Indians, the officers then doing the
same. The natives now intimated to Captain Cook that he might make use of the
ground for any purpose he desired; but as it was not suitable for the purpose
of the expedition, the offer was declined.
The party now took a circuitous route of four or five
miles through groves of trees which were loaded with cocoanuts and bread-fruit,
and afforded the most grateful shade. Under these trees were the habitations of
the people, most of them in the daytime presenting the appearance of a roof
without walls. Mats at night were let down to afford
such privacy and shelter as the habits of the people and the genial climate
required. The whole scene seemed to realise to the voyagers the poetical fables
of Arcadia.
The reception Captain Wallis met with from these
people was in the first instance very different from that which Captain Cook
and his companions now received. No sooner did the Dolphin, which the savages
called a huge canoe without an outrigger, appear, than several thousand people,
in canoes laden with stones, came off and attacked her. Not until they had been
repeatedly fired on, and many of their number had been killed, did they retire.
Several shots were fired at the crowds on shore before they would disperse. The
people then saw that it would be hopeless to contend with the strangers, and
with green boughs in their hands sued for peace. After this, Captain Wallis was
treated with great attention, especially by a female chief, whom he called a
queen or princess, and who lived in a house much larger than any others in the
neighbourhood. On Captain Cook’s arrival, no trace of her house was to be
found, and the princess herself had disappeared. Indeed, the voyagers were
convinced that as yet they had seen none of the leading chiefs of the island.
The next day, however, two persons of greater consequence than any who had yet
appeared came off, called Matahah and Tootahah; the first fixing on Mr Banks as
his friend, and the latter on Captain Cook. The ceremony consisted in the
natives taking off a great part of their clothing, and putting on that of their
white friends. A similar ceremony exists among some of the tribes of North
America. The dress of the natives was formed from cloth made of the bark of the
paper-mulberry tree.
Captain Cook, Mr Banks, and others accompanied these
chiefs on shore, where they met another chief, Tubourai Tamaide, and formed a
treaty of friendship with him. He invited them to his house, and gave them a
feast of fish, bread-fruit, cocoanuts, and plantains, dressed after the native
fashion. The natives ate some of the fish raw, a feat the Englishmen could not
accomplish. The general harmony was interrupted by Dr Solander and Mr Monkhouse
finding that their pockets had been picked, the one of an opera glass, the
other of his snuff-box. Mr Banks on this started up and struck the butt end of
his musket violently on the ground. On this, most of the people ran away, but
the chief remained. To show his concern, and that he had
nothing to do with the theft, he offered Mr Banks several pieces of native
cloth as a compensation. When Mr Banks refused it, and let him
understand that he required only what had been taken away, the chief went out,
and in half an hour returned with the snuff-box and the case of the opera
glass. His countenance fell when he found the case empty, and taking Mr Banks
by the hand, he led him out towards the shore at a rapid rate. On the way,
followed by Dr Solander and Mr Monkhouse, he passed a woman, who handed him a
piece of cloth, which he took, and went on till he reached another house, where
a woman received them. He intimated that they should give her some beads. These
with the cloth were placed on the floor, when the woman went out, and in half an
hour returned with the glass. The beads were now returned, and the cloth was
forced on Dr Solander, who could not well refuse it, though he insisted on
giving a present in return. This, among other instances, shows that the people
had a sense of justice, and were raised above the savage state in which the
inhabitants of many of the surrounding islands were plunged.
A spot was at last fixed on, away from habitations,
where the astronomical instruments could be set up, protected by a fort; and on
the 10th, Captain Cook, accompanied by Mr Banks, Dr Solander, and Mr Green,
went on shore with a party of men to commence operations. A number of natives,
on seeing them, collected to watch their proceedings; though they had no
weapons, it was intimated to them that they must not cross a line which the captain
drew in front of the ground it was proposed to occupy. Having taken all the
precautions he considered necessary, he left a midshipman and a party of
marines to guard the tent, and, with Mr Banks and the other gentlemen, set off
on an excursion through the woods, accompanied by Owhaw, who, however, seemed
very unwilling that they should go far from the shore. One of their objects was
to obtain poultry and pigs. Owhaw’s unwillingness to proceed arose, they
believed, from the fact that their live-stock had been driven into the interior
by the natives lest their white visitors should lay violent hands on them.
As fresh meat or poultry was much wanted, Mr Banks,
seeing some ducks, fired and killed three at one shot, which so astonished the
natives that most of them fell flat on the ground as if knocked down by the
same discharge. They soon recovered, however, and proceeded with the white men.
The Englishmen were walking somewhat apart, when, shortly after the
above-mentioned incident, two shots were heard. Owhaw, on this, seemed to
think, as the visitors did, that something was wrong, and signing to them to
keep together, sent most of the natives away. Three chiefs, however, remained,
who instantly broke off green boughs from the nearest trees, and extended them
towards the English, to show that they wished to be on terms of friendship,
whatever had happened. The Englishmen, of course, full of anxiety, hurried back
to the tent. On their arrival they found that the natives had fled, and that
one of them had been killed. It appeared that a native had suddenly seized the
sentry’s musket and made off with it, when the midshipman, most improperly,
ordered the marines to fire. This they did, into the very middle of the flying
crowd; but finding that the thief did not fall, they pursued and shot him dead.
It is easy to fancy Captain Cook’s grief and annoyance at this incident. In
spite of his humane desire to treat the natives justly and kindly, and to
cultivate their goodwill, and notwithstanding all his precautions against
violence, blood had been shed. Though the native had acted wrongly, death was
too severe a punishment for his fault. The chiefs who had remained with Cook
behaved very well. Calling the people around, they enabled him to explain to
them that though the English would allow no liberties to be taken, yet their
desire was to treat them with kindness.
Notwithstanding these assurances, the next morning
very few natives came near the ship, and she was consequently warped closer in,
more effectually to protect the intended fort. Before long, however, the
natives got over their alarm, and the two chiefs Tubourai Tamaide and Tootahah
returned, bringing in their canoes not branches only, but two young trees, and
would not venture on board till these had been received as emblems of peace.
They each also brought, as propitiatory gifts, a hog and bread-fruit ready
dressed—both very acceptable articles at that time. In return, a hatchet and a
nail were given to each of them.
At this time the expedition had the misfortune to lose
Mr Buchan, the landscape-painter brought out by Mr Banks.
Rapid progress was made with the forts, and on April
18, Mr Banks’s tent being set up, he slept on shore for the first time. The
natives had by this time completely recovered from their alarm, and an
abundance of provisions was offered for sale. Their friend Tubourai Tamaide
even brought his wife and family to the fort, and did not hesitate to throw
himself down and sleep on Mr Banks’s bed. The voyagers were gradually gaining
an insight into the manners and customs of the people. Mr Monkhouse, in one of
his walks, learned their mode of treating their dead. He found the body of the
poor man who had been shot. It was wrapped in cloth, and placed on a high
platform supported by stakes, with a roof over it; near it were some
instruments of war and other articles. Two other bodies were seen near, in a
similar position, the bones of which were perfectly dry. The first was near the
hut in which the man had lived. On the approach of the white man to the bodies
the natives showed considerable uneasiness, and seemed greatly relieved when
the examination was over.
A few days afterwards Tootahah amused them by a
concert. There were four performers on flutes having two stops, which were
sounded by application to the end of the nose, instead of the mouth; one
nostril being stopped by the hand.
Longer excursions from the shore than they had at
first ventured to take gave the explorers a good notion of the fertility and
resources of the country. After passing a belt of fertile land, about two miles
wide, they came to a range of barren hills. These being crossed, they descended
into a wide plain, watered by a river issuing from a fertile valley, which was
nearly a hundred yards wide, and at a considerable distance from the sea.
This plain was thickly studded over with houses, the
inhabitants of which seemed to live in the full enjoyment of the ample
productions of their country. As they became better acquainted with the people,
it was discovered that, amiable as the people appeared, they had many vicious
habits. They were generally expert and pertinacious thieves, although some of
the chiefs appear to have been exempt from this vice, or to have been ashamed
of practising it on their liberal visitors.
The fort was completed on April 26, and six swivel
guns were mounted on it. This seemed very naturally to excite the apprehensions
of the people, and some fishermen who lived near wisely moved farther off. Owhaw, indeed, intimated by signs that the English would begin to
fire their guns in four days. Notwithstanding this, Tubourai Tamaide and
other chiefs, with their wives, came into the fort and ate without showing any
signs of fear. Again the commander’s patience was tried by the misconduct of
one of his own people. The butcher had taken a fancy to a stone hatchet in the
hands of the wife of the above-named chief, and because she refused to give it
to him for a nail, he threatened to kill her. Being proved guilty of this
crime, as well as of an infraction of the rules drawn up by the commander, he
received a severe flogging, in the presence of a number of the natives. It
speaks well for their kind feelings that when they saw the first strokes given
they begged that the rest of his punishment might be remitted, and when Captain
Cook would not consent to this they burst into tears. Indeed, numberless
instances proved that these people were mere children of impulse. They had
never been taught to disguise or suppress their feelings; easily affected by
all the changes of the passing hour, their sorrows were transient, and their
joy and pleasure speedily excited. Unaccustomed to dwell on the past, or to
allow themselves to be troubled with thoughts of the
future, all they desired was to gratify the desire of the moment. About this
time—the beginning of May—an event occurred which threatened disappointment to
the object of the expedition. This was the disappearance, from the middle of
the fort, of the quadrant, a large instrument in a case, on which the
possibility of making the proposed observations entirely depended. Search was
instantly made in every direction, and at length, through the intervention of
the friendly chiefs, portions were discovered in the possession of the natives.
They had been carried off by different people, but fortunately, not broken, and
finally all the parts were collected and the instruments set up. At the
suggestion of the Earl of Morton, before leaving home, Captain Cook sent out two
parties to observe the transit of Venus from different situations—one to the
east, the other to the westward. The anxiety for such weather as would be
favourable to the success of the experiment was powerfully felt by all parties
concerned; they could not sleep the preceding night; but their apprehensions
were removed by the sun’s rising without a cloud on the eventful morning of
June 3. The weather continued with equal clearness throughout the day, so that
the observations at each post were successfully made. At the fort Captain Cook,
Mr Green, and Dr Solander were stationed. The passage of the planet Venus over
the sun’s disc was observed with great advantage.
The explorers had been, from the first, anxious to see
the person who had been looked upon by Captain Wallis as the queen of the
island, and at length, a number of people being collected at the tents, Mr
Mollineux, the master, declared that one of the females, who was sitting
quietly among the rest, was the lady herself. She, at the same time, acknowledged
him to be one of the strangers she had before seen. Her name, they soon
learned, was Oberea. She was tall and stout, and must have been handsome in her
youth. Her countenance indicated much intelligence, and she was also unusually
fair. She was thenceforth treated with great attention, and many presents were
offered her. It was curious that among them all she seemed to value most a
child’s doll. On this, Tootahah, who was apparently at that time the principal
chief on the island, jealous of the favours shown to Oberea, was not content
till he also had a doll given to him. For the moment he valued it more than a
hatchet, probably supposing that its possession conferred some mark of dignity;
or perhaps he took it for one of the gods of the white men. Whatever the
position really held by Oberea, her moral conduct was not superior to that of
most of her countrywomen. She seems to have been the repudiated wife of Oamo,
one of the principal chiefs of the island. There appeared to have been three
brothers, chiefs—Whappai, the eldest, Oamo, and Tootahah. As soon as a son is
born to a head chief, he succeeds as king, and generally the father becomes
regent. Whappai had a son who was thus king, but
Tootahah, having distinguished himself as a leader in battle, was chosen as
regent instead of Whappai, and a son of Oamo and Oberea was the heir-apparent.
It was thus manifest to our voyagers that even among those simple savages—“the
children of nature” as they were sometimes called—ambition for greatness and
jealousy of power were passions not unknown nor unfelt, any more than they are
among civilised and highly cultivated nations and races of men.
Among the attendants of Oberea was Tupia, who had been
her minister in the days of her power, and was now a priest, and possessed of
considerable influence. He from the first attached himself to the English, and
soon expressed a strong desire to accompany them whenever they should leave the
country. As it was very important to have an intelligent native of a South Sea
island attached to the expedition, Captain Cook gladly availed himself of this desire, and Tupia was subsequently received
on board the Endeavour as interpreter.
During his first visit to the island, Captain Cook
learned very little about the religion of the people. He came to the conclusion
that they believed in one God or Creator of the universe, and in a number of
subordinate deities, called Etuas, as also in a separate state of existence
with different degrees of happiness. They did not seem to fancy that their deities
took any notice of their actions. Their religion, such as it was, had therefore
no restraining influence over them. Their priests were called Tahowas. The
office was hereditary. All ranks belonged to it. The chief priest was generally
the younger brother of a good family, and was respected in a degree next to the
king. Of the little knowledge existing in the country the priests possessed the
greatest share, especially with regard to navigation and astronomy. The name
Tahowa signifies, indeed, a man of knowledge. Like all heathen superstitions,
their system was one of imposture; and the priests supported their authority by
cunning, and by working on the credulity of the people. Captain Cook was not
aware at that time that it was their custom to offer up human sacrifices, and
that they exercised a fearful influence over the people by selecting for
victims those who had in any way offended them. The persons fixed on, often
young men or girls in the pride and strength of youth, were followed,
unsuspicious of the fate awaiting them, and were struck down by the clubs of
the assistant priests without warning. They were then offered up at their
morais to the Etuas, whose anger they desired to propitiate. The priests
professed also to cure diseases by incantations very similar to those practised
by the medicine-men or mystery-men among the Indians of North America. A
society existed, called the Arreoy, the object of which was to set at defiance
all the laws of morality which the rest of the people acknowledged. Many of the
principal people of the island belonged to it. By its rules any woman becoming
a mother was compelled instantly to strangle her infant. Both Captain Cook and
Mr Banks spoke to some who acknowledged that they had thus destroyed several
children, and, far from considering it as a disgrace, declared that it was a
privilege to belong to the association. For a long period this dissolute
society existed, and opposed all the efforts of the Christian missionaries to
get it abolished. From the lowest to the highest, the people were addicted to
thieving; for even the principal chiefs could not resist temptation when it
came in their way. On one of their expeditions Mr Banks and his companions had
the greater part of their clothes stolen from them while they were asleep. They
had no doubt that Oberea was concerned in the robbery.
Still the people possessed qualities which won the
regard of their visitors. In all their habits they were scrupulously clean.
They regularly bathed three times in the day, washed their mouths before and
after eating, and their hands frequently during each meal. It was the custom
for the chiefs to take their meals alone, seated on the ground, with leaves
instead of a cloth spread before them, and their food ready cooked in a basket
by their side. Their chief animal food consisted of pigs and dogs, the latter
being carefully kept for the purpose, and fed entirely on vegetable diet. It
was agreed that South Sea dog was but little inferior to English lamb. The meat
was either broiled or baked in earth-ovens. A hole was dug in the ground, and a
fire lighted in it, small stones being mixed with the wood. When the hole was
sufficiently hot, the fire was raked out, and a layer of hot stones placed at
the bottom; on this leaves were put. The animal to be cooked was laid on the
top of them, and covered, first with more leaves, and then with the remainder
of the hot stones; the whole being then covered up with earth. All the fish and
flesh eaten by the natives was baked in the same way.
An excursion in the pinnace, made by Captain Cook and
Mr Banks, round the island, gave them a perfect knowledge of its shape and
size. It consists of two peninsulas joined by a narrow neck of land, and was
found to be about thirty leagues in circumference. Though they were received in
a very friendly way, the natives stole their clothes or whatever they could lay
hands on. On this excursion they met with a representation of one of their
Etuas, or deities. It was the figure of a man constructed of basket-work, rudely
made, and rather more than seven feet high. The wicker skeleton was completely
covered with feathers, which were white where the skin was to appear, and black
in the parts which it is their custom to paint or stain. On the head was a
representation of hair; there were also four protuberances, three in front and
one behind, which the English would have called horns, but which were called by
the natives Tate Ete (little men).
In the northern peninsula they visited a
burying-place, the pavement of which was extremely neat; upon it was raised a
pyramid five feet high, covered with the fruit of two plants peculiar to the
country. Near the pyramid, under a shed, was a small image of stone, of very
rude workmanship—the first specimen of stone-carving which had been seen among
the people. Continuing their voyage, they came to a district belonging to
Oberea, and were entertained at her house, which, though small, was very neat.
Not far from it they saw an enormous pile, which they were told was the morai
of Oamo and Oberea, literally their burying-place and temple. It was a pile of
stone-work, raised pyramidically upon an oblong base or square two hundred and
sixty-seven feet long and eighty-seven wide. It was like the small mounds
erected for sun-dials, with steps leading on all sides to the summit. The steps
at the sides were broader than those at the ends, and it terminated in a ridge
like the roof of a house. There were eleven steps, each four feet high, so that
the height of the pile was forty-four feet; each course was formed of white
coral stone, neatly squared and polished; the rest of the mass, for there was
no hollow within, consisted of round pebbles. Some of the coral stones were
measured, and found to be three feet and a half by two feet and a half. The foundation
was of stones squared, and one of them measured four feet seven inches by two
feet four inches. It was surprising that such a structure should have been
raised without iron tools to shape the stones, or mortar to join them. The
quarried stones must have been brought from a considerable distance by hand,
and the coral must have been raised from under the water, where, though there
is an abundance, it is at a depth of never less than
three feet. To square these stones must have been a work of incredible labour,
though the polishing might have been more easily effected by means of the sharp
coral sand from the sea-shore. The whole pyramid was not straight, but formed a
slight curve, and made one side of a spacious area or square of three hundred
and sixty feet by three hundred and fifty-four feet, enclosed by a stone wall,
and paved throughout its whole extent with flat stones. Several trees, called etoa and plantains, were growing through the pavement. On the top of the pyramid
stood the figure of a bird carved in wood, and near it lay the broken figure of
a fish carved in stone. About a hundred yards to the west of this building was
another paved court, in which were several small stages raised on wooden
pillars seven feet high. These were altars, called Ewattas, and upon them were
placed provisions of all sorts as offerings to their gods. In the neighbourhood
of the morai were found large numbers of human bones. These were said to have
been the remains of the inhabitants killed a few months before by the people of
Tirrabou, in the south-east peninsula, who had made a sudden descent on the
coast. The jaw-bones had been carried away as trophies, as the Indians of North
America carry off the scalps of their enemies. The natives conjectured,
probably, that the English would not approve of human sacrifices, and therefore
refrained from offering up any, or did so only when they knew that their
visitors would not interrupt them in their horrible proceedings.
The inhabitants of Otaheite were remarkably intelligent,
and their minds were capable of a high state of cultivation. The climate was
considered healthy, and the natural productions of the island abundant. The
bread-fruit was, perhaps, the most valuable. They had also cocoanuts, thirteen
sorts of bananas, plantains; a fruit not unlike an apple, sweet potatoes, yams,
cacao; a kind of arum, the yambu, the sugar-cane; a fruit growing
in a pod, like a large kidney bean; the pandana tree, which produces fruit like
the pine-apple, and numerous edible roots of nutritious quality. Among other
trees must be mentioned the Chinese paper-mulberry, from which their cloth was,
and is still, manufactured, and two species of fig-trees. There were no
serpents and no wild quadrupeds on the island, except rats. Their tame animals
were hogs, dogs, and poultry, and there were wild ducks, pigeons, paroquets,
and a few other birds. The complexion of the people was olive or light brown;
that of the women of the upper classes being very clear, with well-formed faces
and expressive eyes, the nose only being flatter than is admired in Europe. In
their persons, as already observed, they were remarkably cleanly; and they
certainly showed that they were neither treacherous nor revengeful. Mr Banks,
Dr Solander, and Captain Cook himself, were constantly in their power, often in
their villages, sleeping in separate huts, without any watch or guard.
Contrary to the usual custom, the men wore their hair
long or tied up in a bunch, while the women wore it cropped short round their
ears. The bodies of both sexes were tattooed, but not their faces. They
manufactured three sorts of cloth for dress. The finest and whitest was made
from the paper-mulberry tree, and was used for the dresses of the chief people.
The second, used by the common people, was made from the bread-fruit tree, and
the third from a tree resembling a fig-tree. The latter was coarse and harsh,
and of the colour of the darkest brown paper; but it was valuable because it
resisted the wet, while the others did not. The women of the upper class wore
three pieces of cloth; one, eleven yards long and two wide, was wrapped round
the waist, and hung down like a petticoat; while the two others were formed
like the South American poncho, the head being put through a hole in the
middle, so as to leave the arms at liberty. The men dressed in much the same
way, except that instead of allowing the cloth to hang down like a petticoat,
they brought it between their legs so as to have some resemblance to breeches.
The higher a person’s rank, the more clothes he wore,
some throwing a large piece loosely over the shoulders. They shaded their eyes
from the sun with hats made at the moment required, of cocoanut leaves or
matting, and the women sometimes wore small turbans, or a head-dress which
consisted of long plaited threads of human hair, wound round and round, with
flowers of various kinds stuck between the folds, especially the Cape
jessamine, which was always planted near their houses. The chiefs sometimes
wore the tail feathers of birds stuck upright in their hair. Their personal
ornaments besides flowers were few; but both sexes wore ear-rings of shells,
stones, berries, or small pearls.
Their houses were always built in woods, sufficient
space only being cleared to prevent the droppings from the boughs from rotting
the roofs. They were simply formed of three rows of parallel stakes for the
support of the roof, the highest part of which was only nine feet from the
ground, while the eaves reached to within three feet and a half. The houses
were thatched with palm-leaves, and the floor was covered some inches deep with
soft hay. They were, indeed, scarcely used for any other purpose than as
dormitories, the people living almost constantly in the open air. The great
chiefs, however, had houses in which privacy could be enjoyed; and there were
guest-houses for the reception of visitors, or for the accommodation of the
people of a whole district. Some were two hundred feet long, thirty broad, and
twenty high under the ridge; on one side of them was an area enclosed with low
palings. They were maintained at the public expense.
The style of cookery among these islanders has already
been described. They baked in their earth-ovens hogs and large fish, as also
the bread-fruit. The baked pork and fish were considered more
juicy and more equally done than by any mode of cooking known at home.
Of the bread-fruit they made various dishes, by putting to it either water or
the milk of the cocoanut, and then beating it to a paste with a stone pestle,
and afterwards mixing it with ripe plantains and bananas. They made an
intoxicating beverage from a plant they called Ava. The chiefs only
indulged in the vice of drinking to excess, and even they considered it a
disgrace to be seen intoxicated. They sometimes drank together, and vied with
each other in taking the greatest number of draughts, each draught being about
a pint. They ate a prodigious quantity of food at each meal, and would finish
off by swallowing a quart of pounded bread-fruit of the consistency of custard.
They had various amusements, and were especially fond
of dancing, in which they kept admirable time, their movements being often
graceful; but their gestures too generally showed the very debased condition of their morals. Their musical instruments were flutes and
drums. The flutes were made of hollow bamboo, about a foot long. The drums were
blocks of wood of cylindrical form, solid at one end, but scooped out and
covered at the other with shark’s skin. They were beaten by the hands instead
of sticks. The natives sang to these instruments, and often made extempore
verses.
The men delighted especially in wrestling. They also
practised archery and spear-throwing. They shot, not at a mark, but to try how
far they could send an arrow; their spears, however, they threw at a mark,
generally the bole of a plantain, at the distance of twenty yards. These spears
were about nine feet long. They also, in war, used clubs of hard wood, often
well carved, and six or seven feet long; pikes, headed with the stings of
sting-rays; and slings, which they wielded with great dexterity. Thus armed,
they fought with obstinacy and fury, and gave no quarter to man, woman, or
child who, while their passion lasted, fell into their hands. Although they
could not be said to live under a regular form of government, there was a
certain subordination established among them, not unlike that of European
nations under the feudal system.
Their tools were few and rude: an adze of stone, a
chisel or gouge of bone—generally that of a man’s arm between the wrist and elbow—a rasp of coral, and the sting of a
sting-ray, with coral sand as a file or polisher. With these tools they built
their houses and canoes, hewed stone, and felled, clove, carved, and polished
timber. Their axes were of different sizes, but even with the largest it took
them several days to cut down a tree. The canoes were often large, and
constructed with great labour and ingenuity. They were of two builds: one, the Ivaha,
for short excursions, was wall-sided, with a flat bottom; the other, the Pahie,
for longer voyages, was bow-sided, with a sharp bottom. There was the fighting
Ivaha, the fishing Ivaha, and the travelling Ivaha. The fighting Ivaha was the
largest; the head and stern were raised sometimes seventeen feet or more above
the sides, which were only three feet out of the water. Two of these vessels
were always secured together by strong poles about three feet apart. Towards
the head a platform was raised, about twelve feet long, wider than the boats,
and on this platform stood the fighting men, armed with slings and spears; for
they did not use their bows and arrows except for amusement. Below the stage
the rowers sat with reserved men, who supplied the place of those that were
wounded. Some of their war canoes had stages or decks from one end to the
other. The fighting Pahie was often sixty feet long, and two were also joined
together, with a large platform above them. One measured by Captain Cook was,
though sixty feet long, only one foot and a half at the gunwale, with flat sides;
then it abruptly widened out to three feet, and narrowed again to the keel. The
double canoes were sometimes out a month together, going from island to island.
Some carried one, some two masts, with sails of matting, of shoulder-of-mutton
shape. The bottom of a large Pahie was formed of three or more trunks of trees
secured together and hollowed out, above this flooring were the sides of plank,
two inches thick, and about fifteen inches broad; and then there were the upper
works, hollowed out of trunks of trees like the bottom. Sometimes these canoes
were used singly, but then they were fitted with outriggers like the flying
Proa of the Ladrone Islands. The outrigger is a log of wood fixed at the end of
two poles, which lie across the vessel, projecting eight or ten feet, according
to her size. The length and high sterns of these canoes gave them great
advantage in putting off from the shore through the surf; they also sailed and
paddled very fast. The amount of time and labour expended in the construction of
one of these canoes must have been very great, and speaks well for the
intelligence as well as for the industry and perseverance of the islanders.
Before quitting the island, Mr Banks planted a
quantity of seeds of water-melons, oranges, lemons, limes, and other plants and
trees which he had collected at Rio de Janeiro. He had prepared the ground for
them in the neighbourhood of the fort, in as many varieties of soil as he could
select. He also gave away seeds liberally to the natives, and planted others in
the woods. The plants from some melon-seeds which were sown on their first
arrival were flourishing, and the natives eagerly begged for more.
Many articles manufactured by the natives have not yet
been described. The mode of making cloth from the bark of the paper-mulberry
was curious. When the trees were of a fit size, they were pulled up, and the
tops and roots being cut off, the bark was slit longitudinally, and was this
easily removed. It was then placed under stones in running water. When sufficiently
softened, the coarser parts were scraped away with a shell, the fine fibres of
the inner coat only remaining. They were then placed on plantain-leaves, in
lengths of about twelve yards, one by the side of the other, for about a foot
in width. Two or three layers were also placed one on the other, care being
taken that the thickness should be equal throughout. In this state it remained
till the following morning, when all the water it contained being drained off
or evaporated, the fibres were found to adhere so closely together that the
whole piece could be lifted up and carried home. There it was placed on a long,
smooth board, to be beaten by the women. The instrument they used was a
four-sided piece of wood, with a long handle. This mallet was scored with
grooves of different finenesses, those on one side
being wide enough to receive a small pack-thread, the size of the grooves
diminishing by degrees till those on the last side were fine as the finest
silk. The fabric was beaten with the coarser side first, the women keeping
time, and it spread rapidly under their strokes. The finest side was the last
used, and the groove marked the cloth so as to give it the appearance of having
been made of fine thread. It was then almost as thin as English muslin, and
became very white on being bleached in the air. The scarlet dye used was very
brilliant, and was extracted from the juice of a species of fig; a duller red
was from the leaves of another tree. A yellow pigment was extracted from the
root of the Morinda citrifolia. A brown and a black dye were also used.
The natives, when visited by Cook, manufactured mats
of various descriptions, some of them exceedingly fine and beautiful. One sort
served them for clothing in wet weather. They made also coarse mats of rushes
and grass, to sit or sleep on, plaiting them with great rapidity and facility.
They produced every variety of basket-work of great beauty; they also made
ropes and string of all sorts; their fishing-line, made from the bark of a
species of nettle, was far stronger than any English line of the same
thickness. Their fishing-nets, though coarse, answered their purpose. They were
often eighty fathoms in length. Harpoons, made of cane, were used to catch
fish, and fish-hooks of mother-of-pearl. One used for trawling had a white tuft
of dog’s or hog’s hair attached to it, to look like the tail of a fish. The
fishermen watched for the birds which always follow a shoal of bonetas, and
seldom returned without a prize. Both sexes were expert swimmers, and would dash
out through the fiercest foam, diving under the breaking seas as they rolled
in, and coming up on the other side. One of their amusements was to tow out a
small raft on which they would sit, and allow themselves to be carried in on
the top of a high foaming sea, amid which no boat could live for an instant.
They were not without the comfort of artificial light. Their candles were made
of the kernels of a kind of oily nut, which were stuck one over another on a
skewer running through the middle. The upper one being
lighted burnt down to the second, which took fire, the part of the skewer which
went through the first being consumed, and so on to the last. These
candles burnt a considerable time, and gave a very tolerable light.
From the brief description which has been given of
their manufactures it will be seen that the islanders of Otaheite possessed a
considerable number of the conveniences of life. Had they but been blessed with
true religion and a good government, they would already have had most of the
elements of a happy existence, without further intercourse with the rest of the
world.
That a life such as was apparently led by these South
Sea islanders—a life of comparative ease, and in a luxurious and enervating but
inviting climate—should have presented charms to such men as chiefly composed
the crew of the Endeavour, can excite no surprise. Rude, ignorant, and, for the
most part, vicious themselves, in spite of the boasted civilisation of their
country, they saw nothing repulsive in the rudeness, ignorance, and vices of
the dusky natives. On the other hand, they were attracted by visions of
indolence and savage freedom from care. Some of them also had formed
attachments not easy to be broken; and they were willing to barter their
distant homes, connections, and prospects for the licentious pleasures so near
at hand. It was very difficult for them to resist these enticements; and
notwithstanding the vigilance of the commander of the expedition, two marines
managed to desert from the ship. In order to recover these deserters, Captain
Cook thought himself under the necessity of detaining several of the principal
people of the island on board the Endeavour. This led to reprisals; for on a
party being sent on shore to bring off the deserters, they were, in turn,
seized by the natives, who made it understood that
they should not be restored till their chiefs were set at liberty. A stronger
party was consequently sent from the ship, with a message from Tootahah (one of
the captives), desiring that the Englishmen should be released. This, happily,
had the desired effect, and the deserters, as well as the other men, were
immediately sent back. Thus, in this, as in previous transactions, the prudence
and mildness of the islanders averted a quarrel which, had it proceeded to
extremities, would have left the civilised visitors little to boast of, beyond
the superior power they possessed. And it must be a source of deep regret to
every Christian reader that in the protracted intercourse which had been carried
on between these professed Christians on the one hand, and the poor heathens on
the other, not one attempt, so far as is known, had been made to impart a
knowledge of that glorious Being who is the “Light of the world” and “the
Saviour of men;” nor of God the Holy Spirit, who is the Giver of the only true
and eternal life. The scientific objects of the voyage had, indeed, thus far
been successful, and, to a great extent, had been rendered so by the goodwill
of the islanders; but to the silent appeal for religious teaching and spiritual
aid made to the philosophers of that party by the ignorance of their hosts
there was no reply.
The fort was now completely dismantled, and
preparations were made for sailing. At a last interview with the chiefs, all
differences were settled, and the voyagers parted from the islanders on the most friendly terms. The latter, indeed, were loud in their
demonstrations of grief. Tupia, who still adhered to his determination of
sailing in the Endeavour, though he shed tears, bade farewell to his countrymen
in a dignified manner, and as far as he was able, concealed the sorrow he
evidently felt. The Endeavour had remained exactly three months at the island.
It was high time for her to leave; for the season for cocoanuts and bread-fruit
being over, the natives could no longer spare any of their provisions for the
strangers. Tupia, who had gone on shore, returned again on board with his
servant, a lad of thirteen, called Tayeto, and on July 13, 1769, the Endeavour
sailed from Otaheite to continue her voyage towards the west.
Tupia informed Captain Cook that four islands, called
Huaheine, Ulietea, Otaha, and Bolabola, lay at the distance of between one and
two days’ sail of Otaheite, and that refreshments in abundance might be
procured at them. In consequence, however, of light winds, the Endeavour did not
get off Huaheine till the morning of the 16th. Tupia probably fancied that he
could impose on the white men as he did on his own people, for in his character
of priest he began to offer prayers, or rather to perform incantations, as soon
as he saw the prospect of a breeze springing up.
Upon the ship’s getting close in with the land, several canoes came off, but kept at a distance till they discovered Tupia. In one of them were Oree, king of the island, and his wife. On receiving reiterated assurances that they would be treated as friends, they ventured on board. Though at first struck with astonishment at what they saw, they soon became familiar with their visitors, and the king expressed his wish to change names with the captain, who was henceforth called Captain Oree, while the chief took the name of King Cookee. The ship having anchored in a small, excellent harbour called Owharee, the captain, Mr Banks, Dr Solander, and Mr Monkhouse, with Tupia and King Cookee, went on shore. On landing Tupia stripped himself to the waist, and desired Mr Monkhouse, whom he seems to have looked on as a brother priest, to do the same; and sitting down in a large guest-house, full of people, opposite the king, he began a sort of incantation, the king answering in what appeared to be set responses. During this he made presents of some handkerchiefs, beads, two bunches of feathers, and plantains to the Etua, or god of the island, and received in return a hog, two bunches of feathers, and some young plantains, as presents to the white man’s God. These he ordered to be carried on board. On the
treaty, as the ceremony was supposed to be, being concluded, every one went his
way, and Tupia repaired to worship at a morai. The next day, as Tupia was much
engaged with his friends in the island, the captain and Mr Banks took Tayeto as
their companion in their rambles. The most interesting object they met with was
a chest or cask, the lid of which was nicely sewed on, and neatly thatched with
palm-leaves. It was fixed on two horizontal poles, and supported on arches of
wood neatly carved. The object of the poles seemed to be to remove it from
place to place. There was a circular hole at one end, stopped, when it was
first seen, with cloth. The chest was, on a second visit, found to be empty.
The general resemblance between it and the ark of the Lord among the Jews was
remarkable. The boy called it Ewharre no Etua (the house of the god).
He, however, could give no account of its use.
Some hogs were exchanged for axes, and some medals
bestowed on the king, and no accident having happened to mar their friendly
intercourse with the natives, the voyagers took their departure. The people
were superior in size and appearance to the general run of the natives of
Otaheite, and the women fairer and better-looking. Not having experienced the
effects of the guns of the Dolphin, they were less timid than the people of
Otaheite, and did not fall down on hearing a musket fired. On one of them being
detected in thieving, his companions prescribed a good beating, which was at
once administered.
The next island visited was Ulietea, where, within the
coral reef, the ship anchored in a good harbour. Two canoes at once came off,
each bringing a woman and a pig—the one as a mark of confidence, the other as a
present. The ladies each received a spike-nail and some beads, greatly to their
delight. On landing, the Union-Jack was hoisted, and the three islands in sight
taken possession of in the name of his Britannic Majesty. Here was a large
morai, called Tapodeboatea, which was visited, and found to be different from
those of Otaheite. It consisted only of four walls, eight feet high, built of
coral stones—some of immense size—enclosing an area of five-and-twenty yards
square, filled up with smaller stones. On the top of it many carved planks were
set on end, and at a little distance was an altar, on which lay a hog of about
eighty pounds weight, roasted whole, supposed to have
been a sacrifice. Round it were four or five arks resting on poles like that
seen at Huaheine. In the interior of one of them Mr Banks found a package done
up tightly in mats. He had opened several folds, but the last resisted all his
attempts; and as he saw that his proceeding gave great offence, he was
compelled to desist. Not far off was a long house, where, among rolls of cloth,
was the model of a canoe, about three feet long, to which were tied eight human
jaw-bones. Other jaw-bones were seen near the ark, and Tupia affirmed that they
were those of natives of the island.
Bad weather detained the ship in the harbour of Oopoa
for two more days, and when at length she got out, she was in imminent danger
of striking on a reef, having got unexpectedly close to the edge of one, which
was discovered from the water being shallow on one side, though deep enough
under the keel to float her. Some time was expended in endeavouring to beat up
to an anchorage off Bolabola, and several smaller islands were visited.
A leak having been discovered, and some more ballast
being required, Captain Cook put into a harbour in Ulietea, at the opposite
side of the island to that he had before visited. While the ship’s company were
taking in ballast and water, Mr Banks and Dr Solander went on shore, and were
everywhere received with the greatest respect by the natives, who seemed
conscious that their white visitors had the power, though not the desire, to do
them every possible harm. Men, women, and children crowded round them, and
followed them wherever they went; but no one was guilty of the least incivility.
On the contrary, the men vied with each other in lifting them over any dirt or
water in the way.
On approaching the first house, they saw the people
arrange themselves on either side of a long mat spread on the ground, at the
farther end of which sat some young girls and very pretty children, dressed
with the greatest neatness and taste, who kept their position, evidently
expecting the strangers to come up and make them presents. At one house, at the
end of a mat thirty feet long, sat a girl about six years old; her dress was
red, and a large quantity of plaited hair was wound round her head. She was
leaning on the arm of a good-looking woman, supposed to be her nurse. The
gentlemen walked up to her, and as soon as they approached she stretched out her
hands for the beads which they offered, and received them with a grace which no
princess in Europe could have surpassed. The people, in consequence of these
gifts, seemed to be so pleased with their visitors that they employed every
means in their power to amuse them. The master of one of the houses where they
stopped ordered a dance to be performed before them, different from any they
had yet witnessed. It was executed by one man, who put on a high head-dress of
feathers, edged round with sharks’ teeth. As he moved slowly round he made it
describe a circle, bringing it often close to the faces of the spectators so as
to make them start back, always to the great amusement of the rest.
In the course of their walk the next day they met a
company of dancers—two women and six men, with three drums—who were making a
tour of the island for their own amusement, for they received no pay, and were
said by Tupia to be among the principal people of the country. The women wore
graceful head-dresses of long braids of hair and flowers. The upper parts of
their bodies were without clothing; but they were amply clothed from the breast
downwards in black, and they wore pearls in their ears. The dances were of the
immoral kind general in the islands. Regular dramas were also represented
before the strangers.
It appeared that the island had lately been conquered
by the subjects of Opoony, King of Bolabola, whose acquaintance Captain Cook
wished to make. Instead of seeing a fine-looking warrior as he had expected, he
found a withered, decrepit wretch, half blind with age; yet it seemed that he
was the terror of all the surrounding islands.
A good supply of hogs, poultry, and other provisions
having been obtained at Ulietea, and her leak being stopped, the Endeavour
sailed on August 9. As Bolabola was difficult of access, Captain Cook gave up
his intention of touching there. To gratify Tupia, however, he fired a shot
towards the island, though it was seven leagues distant. The object of Tupia
appeared to be that of showing his resentment against the king of that island,
as well as of exhibiting the power of his new allies.
To the six islands which had been visited or seen,
namely, Ulietea, Otaha, Bolabola, Huaheine, Tubai, and Maurua, Captain Cook
gave the name of the Society Islands. Otaheite was not included in the group,
but continued to be known as King George’s Island. (Note 1.)
The voyagers were much disappointed in finding that
they could not keep their live-stock. The hogs would not eat European grain of
any sort, nor bread-dust; and the fowls were seized with a disease which made
them hold their heads between their legs till they died.
Nothing worthy of notice occurred till the 13th, when
an island, called, by Tupia, Oheteroa, was seen. The next morning Mr Gore was
sent in the pinnace to attempt a landing, accompanied by Mr Banks, Dr Solander,
and Tupia. As the boat approached the land a number of natives, armed with long
lances, appeared. The main body sat down, while two walked abreast of the boat
as she pulled along the shore. At length they leaped into the water and swam
towards the boat, but were left behind. Two others followed, but were soon
distanced. At last, one man, running on, got up to the boat. Mr Banks, wishing to gain the goodwill of the natives by kind treatment, urged
Mr Gore to take him in; but he declined doing so. On the English attempting to
land, soon after this, several natives came off in a canoe and boarded the
boat, evidently with the intention of capturing her; indeed, it was not till
muskets were fired over their heads that the savages leaped out and swam
ashore. As no harbour or good landing-place was discovered in the circuit of
the island, and as the natives were everywhere hostile, the attempt to land was
abandoned. The clothing of the inhabitants was considered superior to that of
the natives of the islands before visited. The cloth of which their dresses
were made was richly coloured. One piece of red or yellow was crossed on the
breast, and sewed round the waist as a sash. They had also head-dresses of
white or lead-coloured cloth, shaped like a small turban; and some wore the
feathers of the native birds round their heads. They had well-finished lances
in their hands, twenty feet long, and highly carved and polished clubs and
pikes. The canoe also, though small, was richly carved; and her head and stern
were ornamented with white feathers. Tupia stated that there were numerous
islands between the south and north-west, at different distances from Oheteroa;
and that there was one, three days’ sail to the north-east, called Manua, or
Bird Island. The most distant island with which he was acquainted to the south
was Mouton, but his father had told him of islands to the south of that. But
considering the uncertainty of this information, Captain Cook determined not to
lose time in looking for islands, but to steer to the south in search of a
continent.
In leaving these islands we cannot help expressing
regret that the voyagers were so forgetful, as they appear to have been, of
their obligations to the religion they professed, and of the eternal welfare of
those among whom they sojourned. They found a people sunk in idolatry and
superstition, and should have endeavoured to do as the Apostle Paul did at
Athens, where, finding an altar inscribed “To the unknown God,” he said to the
assembled multitude, “Whom therefore ye ignorantly worship, Him declare I unto
you,” and then began to preach Jesus Christ and His great salvation. But so far
from imitating this example, they, in many instances, took part in their
idolatrous and superstitious ceremonies. It is vain to attempt an excuse of
these Englishmen by saying either that it was the fashion of the times to pass by
the heathen without a thought for their wretched lost condition, or that the
party of philosophers and scientific men and discoverers were not Christian
missionaries. Every Christian ought to look upon himself as a missionary, when
work for his Lord can be done by him; and it was a bad fashion to follow,
surely, that of suffering heathens to perish without one effort made for their
salvation. No doubt there were great physical and natural impediments in the
way of Cook and his associates making anything known to the natives of those
islands; but these impediments were overcome in relation to other matters.
The Endeavour sailed from Oheteroa on August 15, 1769.
The 25th was the first anniversary of the day she had quitted the shores of
England. To celebrate it a Cheshire cheese was cut, and a cask of porter broached, and both were found excellent. Those who have
been long at sea and away from home can best understand the importance attached
to such trifles, and the pleasure they afford.
On the morning of the 30th a comet was seen in the
east, a little above the horizon. Tupia, who observed it with others, instantly
cried out that as soon as the people of Bolabola perceived it they would attack
the inhabitants of Uhetea, who would have to fly to the mountains to save their
lives. Meeting with a heavy sea and strong gales from the westward, on
September 1 Captain Cook wore and stood to the northward. On the weather
moderating he continued his course to the westward during the whole of
September. Several seals were seen asleep on the surface of the water, and
various birds were perceived, a sure indication that the ship was approaching
land. On October 6 land was seen from the mast-head, bearing west by north. In
the evening it could be seen from the deck. It was not till the evening of the
next day that the voyagers got near enough to observe the nature of the
country, when it appeared of great extent, with four or five ranges of hills
rising one over the other, and beyond them a lofty chain of mountains. The
general opinion was that they had found the Terra Australia incognita. A
bay was seen, and smoke rising from the shore, but night coming on, they were
obliged to stand off till daylight. The next day, on standing in again, some
small but neat houses were seen, and a considerable number of people seated on
the beach. Farther on was discovered a tolerably high and regular paling,
enclosing the whole of the top of a hill. Some on board supposed it to be a
park for deer, others an enclosure for oxen or sheep. In the afternoon the ship
came to an anchor in a bay off the mouth of a river. The sides of the bay were
white cliffs of great height; the middle was low land, with hills rising behind
and terminating in a chain of lofty mountains.
Captain Cook, with Mr Banks, Dr Solander, and a party
of men in the yawl and pinnace, landed on the east side of the river; but some
people being perceived on the west side, the yawl crossed over, and while the
gentlemen landed, four boys were left in charge of her. On the approach of the
Englishmen the natives ran away, and the former advanced towards some huts two
or three hundred yards from the water’s edge. When, however, they had got some
distance from the yawl, four men with long lances rushed out of the woods
towards her, and would have cut her off had not the people in the pinnace
covered them, and called to the boys to drop down the stream. This they did,
but the natives pursued in spite of two musket-shots fired at them. At length,
one of the natives was poising his spear to dart it at the boys, when the
coxswain of the pinnace fired a third time, and shot the native dead. The other
three at first attempted to drag off the dead body, but fear soon made them
drop it and take to flight.
On the captain and his companions returning to the
boat they stopped to examine the body, which had been shot through the heart.
It was that of a man of middle stature, of a brown, but not very dark
complexion. One side of his face was tattooed in spiral lines of regular
figure, and his hair tied in a knot on the top of his head, but no feathers in
it. He wore a garment of a fine cloth, of a manufacture new to the English.
When the voyagers returned on board, they could hear the natives talking very
loudly. The next day the captain and the same party landed with Tupia, and the
marines were afterwards sent for. A large body of natives had collected on the
opposite side of the river, apparently unarmed; but on the approach of the
English they started up, each man holding a spear or dart, and made signs to
the strangers to depart. The marines being drawn up, the visitors again
approached the natives, when Tupia addressed them in the language of Otaheite,
which they perfectly understood. He told them that their visitors wanted
provisions and water, and would pay them with iron, the properties of which he
explained as well as he could. They replied that they were willing to trade if
the English would cross over to them. Captain Cook consented to do this,
provided they would put aside their arms. This they would not consent to do.
Tupia warned the English, during the conversation, that the natives were not
friendly. Captain Cook then invited the natives to come across to them. At
last, one of them stripped himself and swam over without his arms. He was soon
after followed by others, to the number of twenty, most of whom came armed; and
though iron and beads were offered them, they set no value apparently on
either, for a few feathers were offered in return, and they at once showed
their hostile disposition by endeavouring to snatch the weapons from the hands
of their visitors. They were told, through Tupia, that if they continued to
proceed in that manner they would be killed; notwithstanding this, one of them
seized Mr Green’s hanger from his side, and ran off with it. Mr Banks on this
fired at him with small shot; but though hit, he still continued to wave the
hanger round his head. Mr Monkhouse, seeing this, fired at him with ball, when
he instantly dropped. Upon this, the main body, who had retired to a rock in
the middle of the river, began to return. Two that were near the man who had
been killed tried to drag off the body. One seized his weapon of green talc;
and the other tried to secure the hanger, which Mr Monkhouse had but just time
to prevent. As the whole body were now returning with threatening gestures,
those who had their guns loaded with small shot fired. The effect was to make
the natives turn back, and to retreat up the country, several of them being
wounded. Such was the first unhappy attempt of the English to open up an
intercourse with the inhabitants of New Zealand, for that was the magnificent
country Captain Cook and his companions had now reached. Painful as it is to
reflect on the sacrifice of human life which often in those days attended the
first intercourse of civilised Europeans with the savage inhabitants of
newly-discovered countries, and the cruelties and injuries inflicted, we must
not judge our countrymen too harshly. Much less value was set on human life a
century ago than is the case at present, and dark-skinned savages were scarcely
regarded as beings of the same nature as white men. Captain Cook was, however,
undoubtedly a kind and humane man, and was sincere in his expressions of regret
at the blood his followers so frequently shed whenever they met with opposition
from the natives of the lands they visited.
Having no longer any hope of establishing a friendly
intercourse with the inhabitants of this place, and finding that the water in
the river was salt, Captain Cook proceeded with the boats round the head of the
bay, in search of fresh water, intending also, if possible, to surprise some of
the natives, and, by kind treatment and presents, to obtain their friendship.
Everywhere, however, a dangerous surf beat on the
coast, and he was unable to land. But seeing two canoes coming in towards the
shore, one under sail, and the other moved by paddles, he judged it necessary
for the object he had in view to intercept them. Supposing that they were
fishermen without arms, he hoped to do this without bloodshed. Notwithstanding
the way in which he had placed the boats, one of the canoes managed to escape;
but the other, under sail, came directly into the middle of the English boats
without perceiving what they were. On discovering the strangers, the natives
lowered their sail and took to their paddles. Tupia called out to them that
those in the boats wished to be friends; but the natives preferred trusting to
their paddles, and continued their flight. On this, a musket was fired over
their heads, when they ceased paddling and began to strip, not to swim to the
shore but to fight to the last.
When the boat came up they attacked the English with
paddles, stones, and other weapons, and showed a determination not to be taken
alive. The English, in their own defence, fired, when four
out of the seven people in the canoe were killed. The other three were
lads—the eldest of whom, about nineteen years old, leaped into the sea,
swimming vigorously, and resisting every effort made to capture him. At last he
was seized and taken into the boat, as were the two younger lads, without
further attempt to escape. As soon as they were in the boat, the lads squatted
down, evidently expecting instant death. Every effort was made to win their
confidence, and with so much success that by the time the ship was reached they
appeared not only reconciled to their fate, but in high spirits. On food being
offered them, they ate it voraciously, and asked and answered questions with
every appearance of pleasure. At night, however, they sighed, and seemed to be
mourning for the friends they had lost; but, encouraged by Tupia, they quickly regained their cheerfulness, and in the morning ate another
enormous meal. On being told that they would be put on shore where the English
had landed the previous day, they expressed great alarm, and said that the
inhabitants were their enemies and would eat them. At last, on landing on the
other side of the bay, after hesitating for some time, the lads cried out that
they saw, among a large body of natives who were approaching, one of their
relations. Still they seemed doubtful about joining them, and evidently
regretted leaving their new friends. The body of the native who had been killed
the previous day still lay on the shore. The boys, seeing it, went and covered
it with some of the clothes they had received on board the Endeavour. Soon
after, a man, who proved to be the uncle of one of the boys, swam over with a
green bough in his hand, which was here, as at Otaheite, an emblem of peace.
Tupia received the branch, and several presents were made to the native.
Notwithstanding this, he refused to go on board the strange ship. Breaking off
another bough, he then approached the dead body, before which he performed
numerous ceremonies. When this was done he returned to his companions, and held
with them a long consultation. The boys refused to go back to their countrymen,
and begged again to be taken on board. The natives, after this, were observed
from the ship to cross the river, and to carry off the dead body on a kind of
bier.
Later in the day, the captain directed Tupia to ask
the boys if they had any longer a fear of landing, the body having been carried
off, which was supposed to be a ratification of peace. They replied that they
were perfectly ready to go, and stepped with alacrity into the boat which was
prepared to carry them on shore.
On the boat reaching the shore they landed willingly,
but soon after, when she put off, waded back into the water, and entreated to
be taken on board. As the midshipman in charge of the boat had received strict
orders not to receive them, their request was not granted. After a time a man
came and took them across the river, on a raft, to where a large number of
people were assembled. They appeared to be well received, and shortly after
were seen standing on the beach, when they waved their hands three times and stepped
nimbly back to their companions.
Captain Cook gave the name of Poverty Bay to the place
where these events occurred; and in his journal he strongly expresses his
regret at the destruction of the four unfortunate fishermen, saying that, had
he supposed they would have resisted, he would not have attempted to stop them;
but that, as it was, he could not allow his people to be knocked on the head by
the savages. It may be asked, why were the savages not permitted to escape? The
reply of Captain Cook is, that he considered it his
duty, in prosecution of his enterprise, to open a communication with the
natives by force if he could not succeed by gentle means. In pursuance of that
object, and in accordance with this supposed duty, our countrymen had little scruple
in shedding the blood and taking the lives of their fellow-men, even when
violence was not necessary for their own safety.
The next morning the Endeavour sailed from Poverty
Bay, but, being becalmed, several canoes came off to her. The natives in one
canoe setting the example, the rest were easily persuaded to come on board, to
the number of fifty men. Only two weapons were seen among them; these were made
of green talc, and called patoo-patoo, being shaped somewhat like a
pointed battledore, with a short handle and sharp edges. They were well
contrived for close fighting, and would certainly split the thickest skull at a
single blow. The sad truth of this some of our countrymen were afterwards to
experience, when not far from this spot the greater part of a ship’s company
were destroyed, each savage producing one of these weapons from under his
cloak, and singling out a victim for instant destruction. Presents were made by
the officers of the Endeavour to the natives, who were all so eager for the white
men’s goods that they afterwards exchanged everything they had with them, even
to the paddles of their canoes. Inquiries were made for the poor boys, and the
captain was assured that no harm had happened to them, and that it was in
consequence of the account they had given of their reception on board that the
present party had come off to the ship.
An hour before sunset the natives paddled off, leaving
three of their number below. As soon as this was discovered they were hailed,
but would not return, nor did the deserted natives seem to be alarmed. The next
morning, however, when they discovered that the ship was at a distance from the
land, their consternation was excessive, and Tupia had great difficulty in
pacifying them. On standing in again, a canoe with an old chief came off, but
he and his followers would not venture on board till Tupia had used numerous
arguments to persuade them—among others, an assurance that the strangers did
not eat men. This remark, coupled with those of the boys, gave the English
their first suspicions of the horrible propensity of the people with whom they
were now attempting to open up an intercourse. The old chief, after remaining a
short time on board, returned with the three men to the shore.
The point of land first made to the north of Poverty
Bay proved to be the most eastern part of New Zealand, and was called East
Cape. The Endeavour was now steered to the south. An island close to the main
was passed, which, from its similarity to Portland in Dorsetshire, received the
same name. A number of natives were here seen seated on the cliffs watching the
ship’s movements. When she suddenly got close to a reef, and there was some
sign of confusion on board, they showed a disposition to attack her. Canoes at
different times came off, and in one the people performed certain ceremonies,
sometimes offering peace, and then threatening war. Five
large canoes full of armed men soon after came off. As the boat’s crew
were sounding, it was necessary to drive them away. A musket fired over their
heads had no effect, but a four-pounder charged with grape shot, though fired
wide, put them to flight.
Farther along the coast, the next morning, nine or ten
large canoes, which must have contained little short of two hundred men, came
off. When the first five were within a hundred yards of the ship, the natives
began to sing their war-songs and to brandish their weapons. Tupia, on this,
was ordered to inform them of the power and effects of the English
thunder-making arms, and a four-pounder loaded with grape was fired wide of
them. The result was satisfactory, and the natives went peaceably away. The
following day another fleet of canoes came alongside, and though they had only
stale fish to sell, Captain Cook accepted it for the sake of encouraging
traffic. The natives, however, showed every disposition to take advantage of
the strangers, and one of them having agreed to exchange a black cloak for a
piece of red cloth, on receiving the cloth, packed it in a basket with the
cloak, which he refused to give up, and made off with both cloth and cloak.
Among those who were leaning over the ship’s side to hand up the articles
purchased from the natives was Tupia’s boy, Tayeto. One of the natives,
watching his opportunity, suddenly seized the boy, and dragging him over, held
him down in the canoe, which made off. The marines on deck were ordered to
fire, and to aim at the end of the canoe farthest away from the boy. One of the
natives was seen to fall, when the other let go his hold of Tayeto, who leaped
overboard and swam to the ship. A boat was lowered, and he was taken up unhurt,
but dreadfully frightened. The canoes made towards the shore, and it was
observed that three men were lifted out of them, either killed or badly
wounded.
In this instance the natives actually deserved the
punishment they received. Captain Cook called the headland off which this
circumstance occurred Cape Kidnappers. When Tayeto
recovered from his fright he took a fish to Tupia, that he might offer it to
his Etua. Tupia praised him, and ordered him to throw it into the sea.
Captain Cook having now stood to the southward for a
considerable distance without finding a harbour, tacked and stood to the
northward, in hope of being more successful in that direction. The ship was off
a high bluff headland with yellowish cliffs, which was accordingly called Cape
Turnagain. Soon afterwards two chiefs and their three attendants paddled off,
and willingly came on board. One of the chiefs had a very pleasing and honest
expression of countenance. Though they would not eat, they seemed disposed to
be very friendly, so much so that they insisted on remaining on board all
night. The next morning they were somewhat surprised at finding themselves so
far from the shore, but went away without hesitation. As the ship sailed along,
several canoes came off to her, a few at a time. In one were two old chiefs,
who, with many expressions of goodwill, invited the strangers on shore. The
surf prevented their going, but in the evening, the wind moderating, Captain
Cook, with Mr Banks and Dr Solander, landed, and were received in a most
friendly manner. The natives took care not to appear in large bodies, the
members of two or three families only keeping together. These little companies
sat on the ground, and by signs invited their visitors to draw near. These
indications of a friendly disposition determined the commander to fill his
casks with water at this place.
The next morning, while this operation was going
forward, Mr Banks and Dr Solander walked along the shore of the bay by
themselves without anxiety, and collected numerous plants. They visited several
huts, and found the inhabitants at dinner, their food consisting, at this time
of the year, of fish and the root of a large fern. The roots were prepared by scorching
them over a fire, and then beating them till the charred bark fell off. The
remainder was a clammy, soft substance, not unpleasant to the taste, but mixed
with three times its bulk of fibres, which could not be swallowed. This part
was spat out into baskets ready at hand for its reception. No animals were
seen, except some ugly little dogs. Carefully cultivated and closely fenced
plantations of sweet potatoes and other vegetables were seen. The women were
plain, and had their faces painted with red ochre and oil; the men generally
did not follow the latter custom, but one man was observed who had a piece of
yellow ochre in his hand, with which he renewed the coloured decorations on his
person whenever he supposed them to be deficient. Mr Banks and others, having
remained on shore after the boats had gone off with the casks, were brought on
board by the natives in one of their canoes. Indeed, all the intercourse with
the people in this place was carried on in the most friendly manner.
At the watering-place the natives entertained their
visitors with a war-song, in which the women joined, with horrid distortions of
countenance, rolling their eyes, thrusting out their tongues and heaving deep
sighs, all keeping perfect time. A canoe was seen here, sixty-eight feet and a
half long, five broad, and three feet and a half deep; she had a sharp bottom,
consisting of three trunks of trees hollowed; the side planks were sixty-two
feet long in one piece, carved in bas-relief; the head being still more richly
carved. A large unfinished house was also visited; the side ports were carved
in a masterly style, though with whimsical taste. The bay was called by the
natives Tolaga.
Wood and water, and an abundance of wild celery, which
proved an excellent anti-scorbutic, having been got on board, the Endeavour
weighed and stood to the north. The wood they had cut was like the English
maple; and a cabbage-tree was met with and cut down for the sake of the
cabbage, or the succulent soft stem, so-called by the voyagers from its taste
when boiled. The country abounded with plants, and the woods
with birds in an endless variety, and exquisitely beautiful. After
rounding each cape, numerous villages were seen, and much cultivated ground.
Some way on an immense canoe with sixteen paddles on each side, and carrying
sixty armed men, gave chase to the ship. To prevent an attack, a round shot was
fired near them, when they paddled off; the headland near at hand was therefore
called Cape Runaway. After this, a large number of canoes came off to trade;
but the natives were disposed to cheat. At length some linen hanging over the
bows to dry was carried off by a man, who, though fired at, deliberately packed
it up and made off with it. As the natives continued to insult the English, a shot
was fired close to them, which went bounding over the water far ahead, and made
them paddle away at great speed.
Several villages were seen larger than any before
observed, built on eminences near the sea, and fortified on the land side by a
bank and ditch, with a high paling within it, carried all round; some of them
had also outworks. They were supposed to be the fortified villages called by
the natives Pahs or Hippahs. There seems to have been much doubt in the minds
of the officers of the Endeavour as to whether the land on which they were now
coasting was an island or part of a vast continent. The captain seems to have
held to the former opinion, his officers to the latter.
The ship was now near a cluster of islands to which
the names of the Mayor and the Court of Aldermen were given. Farther on more
villages were in sight, with some hundreds of large canoes drawn up on the
beach under them. The whole country from Cape Turnagain, thus far, was said to
be under the rule of a single chief, called Teratu. A large inlet was next
entered, and here the ship anchored. Several canoes of a less ornamental
description came alongside, and tried to steal the buoy of the anchor. Three
times during the night they repeated the attempt, hoping, it seemed, to catch
the crew asleep. Again they came at daylight, and sang a war-song, preparatory
to an attack. Tupia, however, expostulated with them, and explained so
successfully that they would certainly be the sufferers in case of a skirmish,
that instead of fighting, they began to trade. Here, again, a native made off
with two pieces of cloth, both of which he had got for one weapon, which he
refused to deliver up. A musket-ball was fired through his canoe; but he would
not return. It was curious that the people in the other canoes paid no
attention to him, though he was bleeding, but continued to trade as if nothing
had happened. Soon afterwards, indeed, the same trick was played by others. Two
muskets were fired, the bullets going through the sides of the canoe between wind
and water. This only made the savages pull off more rapidly. As the commander
intended to remain in this place for some days, to observe the transit of
Mercury, it was necessary to make the natives understand the superiority of the
English; and a round shot was therefore fired over their heads.
All the natives, however, were not alike dishonest.
One chief, in particular, had behaved with great propriety during
the day, neither attempting to cheat nor showing any fear of the
English. He came off the next morning, and soon established friendly relations
with them. He said that the people were generally convinced of their power, and
would, he hoped, behave properly in future. His name was Toiava.
An officer, with the marines and a party of men, was
sent on shore to cut wood. No houses were seen; but there were a number of
people, who seemed to have slept under the bushes. The state of warfare in
which the people existed was shown by Toiava when on board one day. Two canoes
were perceived coming in from the opposite side of the bay, when, saying that
they were enemies, he hastened off to the shore with all his canoes. He soon
returned, however, they not being the people he supposed. A large number of
mackerel were obtained here from the natives, the sailors salting enough to
last for a month.
Fortunately, a fine day enabled the commander and Mr
Green to obtain a satisfactory observation of Mercury; and the name of Mercury
Bay was, therefore, given to the harbour on the shore of which it was taken. While they were on shore another case, of cheating by a native
occurred. The thief and his companions having pulled off in their canoe,
sang their war-song, and shook their paddles in defiance. This so provoked Mr
Gore, the officer in charge, that he fired and killed the man, a circumstance
for which Captain Cook expressed his deep regret. Though at first alarmed, the
natives on shore, on inquiring into the matter, seemed to think that the man
had received his deserts, and the friendly intercourse begun between them and
the English was not further interrupted.
A little before sunset, the natives retired to eat
their supper, consisting of birds, fish, and lobsters. Some were roasted, stuck
on sticks inclined towards the fire; others were baked in ovens on the ground,
in the way practised by the people of Otaheite. Among the natives was a woman
mourning for the death of a relative. She sat on the ground by herself, and cut
herself all over with pieces of shell till she was covered with blood, singing
in a mournful voice, at the same time, a song the meaning of which Tupia could
not understand.
The shore abounded with clams, cockles, and, in some
places, rock-oysters. Numerous wild-fowl also were seen, and several were shot.
The boats rowed up a river at the head of the bay for four or five miles, and
near it a deserted fort of considerable strength was visited. Several beds of
oysters were also discovered, dry at half-ebb, and a boat being sent to fetch
some, returned completely laden, so that the ship’s company had a regular feast
of them. Fish, also in abundance, were brought off by the natives. On the north
side of the bay, a pah, small, but very strong and
beautifully situated, was visited. It stood on the top of a rock detached from
the mainland, surrounded at high-water. The centre part was perforated by an
arch sixty feet in height, and of considerable width. The only way of reaching
the top was by a very narrow winding path. Here there was room only for four or
five huts. Farther on was a much larger fortified village, the inhabitants of
which, to the number of a hundred, came out and invited the strangers to visit
them, and seemed highly pleased when their invitation was accepted.
This pah, or fort, was examined with much interest,
and afterwards minutely described by the English visitors. It seemed, indeed, a
place which, if resolutely defended, was capable of holding out against any
number of assailants famished only with such arms as were seen in the hands of
the natives. It was curious that men capable of constructing so elaborate a
fortification should have invented simply such weapons as lances, small and
large battle-axes, and clubs; for not a sling nor a
bow was seen among them, nor any other weapon but those mentioned. When stones
were used they were thrown by the hand.
The Endeavour, having taken an ample supply of celery
on board, sailed from Mercury Bay. The most successful generals of ancient and
modern times were able to take advantage of their greatest victories by having
paid careful attention to their commissariat; and Cook, for the same reason,
could prolong his researches for a greater length of time than any previous
navigator, and keep his crew in tolerable health, more especially preserve them
from that fearful scourge of seamen, the scurvy. Of course he was greatly
indebted to the experienced botanists on board, who were able to discover any
anti-scorbutic plants grown on the shores they visited. Probably the lives of
thousands of seamen might have been saved had the commanders been acquainted
with the wild plants that the loving God has everywhere provided for the use of
His creatures, capable of preventing that dire complaint.
About fifty miles to the north of Mercury Bay, the
natives came off and threw stones at the ship, nor would they listen to the
expostulations and advice of Tupia, till a musket-ball was sent through the
bottom of one of their canoes, when they were convinced of the truth of his
account respecting the power of the strangers.
On the 19th a large inlet was entered, in which the
ship brought up. Immediately natives came off, who said that they had heard of
the strangers from Toiava. One young man introduced
himself as his grandson, and received several presents. They also addressed Tupia
by name, showing that they had heard of the English from their friends. The
commander and his usual companions proceeded in the boats nine miles up the
inlet, which they discovered terminated in a river. This they entered with the
flood, and found fresh water three miles from the mouth. Here they saw a large
village on a sand-bank entirely surrounded by mud, probably considered a
sufficient protection from their enemies. They were particularly struck by the
great size of the pine trees which grew on the banks. One measured nineteen
feet eight inches in girth at the height of six feet from the ground. From the
root to the first branch it was eighty-nine feet, and as straight as an arrow,
tapering very little in proportion to its height. It probably contained, by the
captain’s computation, three hundred and sixty-six cubic feet of solid timber.
Others still larger were seen. A small one was cut down, and found to be
similar to the pitch pine, too heavy for masts, but the carpenter was of
opinion that, by tapping, the wood would be lightened, and that then the trees
would make the finest masts in the world. These trees were the celebrated Kauri
pine, from which a valuable gum is extracted. It also makes very fine planking.
This tree, the flax plant, and the gigantic fern are among the characteristic
productions of New Zealand.
The name of the Thames was given to the river
explored. The natives in the neighbourhood behaved in the most
friendly manner; but while the commander and Dr Solander were on shore,
and Mr Banks with Tupia and some of the natives were below, a lad took
possession of a half-minute glass from the binnacle. Mr Hicks, who was
commanding officer, ordered the lad to be triced up and a dozen lashes given to
him. His countrymen interfered, and called for their arms from the canoes
alongside. In vain Mr Banks, hearing the noise, and coming on deck,
expostulated with the lieutenant. Tupia at length pacified the natives by
explaining what was to happen, and allowed the punishment to proceed. As soon
as it was over, an old man, supposed to be the father of the boy, gave him a
beating and sent him into the canoe; but the confidence of the natives was
gone, and though they promised to come back, no more was seen of them.
The natives on most occasions were ready to steal and
cheat, whenever they thought they could do so with impunity. This occurred
nearly every day as the Endeavour proceeded along the coast. In one day, at
different times, nearly five hundred natives were on board or alongside,
showing that the country was very populous. One of these was making off with an
article of which he had possessed himself without giving anything in return,
when the midshipman to whom it belonged hove a lead with a hook secured to it
at the end of a line, with such aim that the hook caught the thief, but broke
off. While at anchor in another part of this bay, which is known as the Bay of
Islands, the commander gave a piece of cloth to an old chief, one of several
hundred natives crowding round the ship. Notwithstanding this, some of them
tried to steal the buoy, and not till one of them was hit by a musket-ball
would they give it up. After this, the commander, with Mr Banks, Dr Solander,
and two boats’ crews, landed in a little cove. They had not been there long, before
they saw nearly three hundred people rushing towards them from behind the heads
of the cove, and over the top of the hill. Some of the savages rushed to the
boats to seize them, and others, led by a chief, advanced towards the English.
The commander, Mr Banks, and two of the man fired with small shot. The natives,
though at first they fell back, soon again rallied and advanced. On this Dr
Solander fired again, and hit the chief, who, with the rest, ran off. The
natives still continued in a body, and, as seen from the ship, appeared very
numerous. A few round shot fired over their heads dispersed them. Happily not a
single life was lost, and only two men were slightly wounded. As it happened,
the old chief to whom the cloth had been given in the morning had, with some of
his family, concealed himself in a cave. While the party were collecting celery
he was discovered, and was soon put at his ease. He said that one of the men
who had been hit with small shot was his brother, and inquired anxiously
whether he would die. He was assured that he would not; and a bullet and small
shot being shown to him, he was told that those who were hit with the first
would die, but that the wounds made by the last were seldom mortal. He and his
companions now came and sat down by the English, who gave them a few trifles.
Several days were passed in the Bay of Islands, and a
friendly intercourse was maintained during the remainder of the time with the
natives. On going out of it the ship grazed a rock to windward of her with great
violence, but received no injury. This part of the country was evidently very
densely inhabited; and the people seemed to live on friendly terms with each
other, though no head or leading chief was heard of. Fishing seemed to be one
of their principal occupations, and nets of great length were seen—one of not
less than from three to four hundred fathoms. Their towns were all fortified.
Farther on, while becalmed, some people who came off told the voyagers that at
the distance of three days’ rowing the land would take a sharp turn to the
south, and extend no more to the west. It was conjectured, therefore, that this
headland was one seen by Tasman, and called by him Cape Maria Van Diemen; and
an eager lookout was kept for the important headland.
At six in the morning on December 16 land was seen
from the mast-head, which proved to be North Cape. It lies in latitude 34
degrees 22 minutes South, and longitude 186 degrees 55
minutes West. The isthmus which joins this head to the mainland is low, which
gives it the appearance of an island. On the cape a hippah, or village, was
seen, with several inhabitants. Soon after this, when off Cape Maria Van
Diemen, the Endeavour met with a gale which, though it was in the middle of the
summer of that hemisphere, Captain Cook says, for its strength, and the length
of time it lasted, was such as he had scarcely ever been in before. The ship
was three weeks getting ten leagues to the westward, and five weeks in getting
fifty leagues. During the gale the ship was a considerable distance from the
land, or it is highly probable, he says, they would not have returned to relate
their adventures.
It is not necessary to mention the various courses run
for several days, as no communication was held with the shore. At length a
lofty peak was seen towering above the clouds, and covered with snow, to which
the name of Mount Egmont was given. It was surrounded by a flat country of a
pleasant appearance, being clothed with verdure and wood. Near it a bay was
entered, in a safe and convenient cove of which the ship anchored. Some canoes
at once paddled off, and much against the wishes of his people, an old chief
from one of them came on board. He was received with all possible friendship,
and after some time was dismissed, with many expressions of kindness, to his
companions. This treatment had a beneficial effect, though some of the natives
showed an inclination to try how far they might go with the strangers. On one
occasion they pursued the long-boat as it was going on shore with casks; but
some small shot quickly made them desist.
The bay where they were at anchor was found to be
about fifteen miles south of one visited by Tasman, though none of the people
among whom Tupia made inquiries had any tradition of his having been on the
coast. The commander, with Mr Banks, Dr Solander, and others, on their way one
day to visit a cove two miles off, saw the body of a woman floating, having
apparently been dead for some days. Immediately on landing they found a family
who seemed greatly alarmed at their approach, and ran away. In a short time,
however, they were induced to return, and confidence being established, became
very communicative. The body of the woman was that of a relation whom they had
buried at sea fastened to a stone, from which they supposed it had broken. The family were dressing some provisions, and as the gentlemen
cast their eyes into one of the baskets which stood near, two bones were
perceived, which, upon nearer examination, were found to be those of a human
body. The natives, on being questioned by Tupia, acknowledged, without the
slightest hesitation, that they were the bones of a man whom they had eaten;
that a canoe belonging to their enemies had come into the bay five days before;
that seven persons in her had been killed, and that this man was one of them.
On Tupia asking why they did not eat the body of the woman, they replied that
she was a relation, and that they only eat the bodies of their enemies killed
in battle. One of the natives took hold of his own forearm, and intimated that
the bone Mr Banks held in his hand had belonged to that part of the human body;
he also bit and gnawed the bone which Mr Banks had taken, drawing it through
his mouth, and showing by signs that it had afforded a delicious repast. A
woman of this family of cannibals had her arms, legs, and thighs frightfully
cut, in token of her grief for the loss of her husband, who had lately been
killed and eaten by their enemies.
Mr Banks and Dr Solander were several times on shore,
but their walks were much circumscribed by climbing plants of luxuriant growth,
which completely filled up the spaces between the trees, so as to render the
woods impassable. Preparations had been made for erecting a durable memorial of
the Endeavour’s visit, and their old friend promised that it should never be
removed. Presents of coins and spike-nails, with the king’s broad arrow on
them, were given to the natives, and two posts, of which the memorial was to be
constructed, were taken to the highest part of the island near which the ship
lay. The Union-Jack was then hoisted, and formal possession was taken of the
country in the name of His Majesty King George the Third; the name of Queen
Charlotte’s Sound being given to the inlet. A bottle of wine was then drunk to
Her Majesty’s health, and the empty bottle given to the old man, who seemed
highly delighted with it.
The Endeavour left the sound on February 6, and soon
after, during a calm, was very nearly driven on shore
by the strong current setting through the straits between the northern and
middle island, now known as Cook’s Straits. Over the land was seen a mountain
of stupendous height, covered with snow. Passing through the straits, the
Endeavour steered north again, and continued on till, the weather clearing,
Cape Turnagain was distinctly seen. Captain Cook on this asked his officers
whether they were satisfied that Eaheinomauwe was an island. They replying in
the affirmative, the Endeavour hauled her wind and stood to the eastward.
Eaheinoniauwe was the name given by the natives to the northern island,
Poenammoo to the southern, or rather, as it is now called, the middle island.
The Endeavour was now steered down the eastern coast
of the last-named portion of New Zealand. Some lofty mountains were seen,
partially covered with snow, and inferior in height to Mount Egmont. During a calm, when close in shore, Mr Banks went out in a small
boat for the purpose of shooting. While he was away four double canoes were
seen to put off from the shore, and to pull towards him. Captain Cook trembled
for his friend’s safety, for Mr Banks could not see the signals made to hasten
his return. At length he noticed the natives, and his boat’s head was turned
towards the ship. The natives also approached. He, however, got on board before
them, thankful for his escape. Probably, indeed, their attention had been so
engrossed with the ship that they had not seen him. When they came about a
stone’s throw off, they stopped and gazed at the ship with vacant astonishment;
but even Tupia’s eloquence could not induce them to come on board. After
surveying the ship, they made towards the shore, but it was dark before they
could have reached it. This was the only sight Captain Cook had of the
inhabitants of the middle island, or Tovy Poenammoo.
An island about twenty-four leagues in circumference,
and five leagues from the main, was discovered, to which the name of Banks’s
Island was given. Some persons on board asserting that they saw land to the
south-east, the commander, though believing that they were mistaken, steered in
that direction; but no land being discovered, the ship wore, and was steered
east-south-east. Tovy Poenammoo was found to be very much larger than Captain
Cook expected to find it, from the description of the natives in Queen
Charlotte’s Sound. Heavy gales and rough seas were encountered, and on one
occasion, at dawn, rocks were seen close under the ship’s bows, she having in
the night passed close to another dangerous reef, some leagues from the main.
The land discovered appeared green and well wooded, but destitute of
inhabitants. Several whales and seals were observed, whereas none had been seen
off the north island. At length, on March 5, the South Cape was rounded. At the
time Captain Cook was doubtful whether it was part of the large island or a
separate island, though he marked it in his chart as the former. Nothing of
importance occurred during the passage back to the entrance of Cook’s Straits,
on the northern shore of which, in a bay called Admiralty, the Endeavour again
anchored, that she might fill up with wood and water. This was accomplished by
March 31, 1770, when a course was shaped by which it was hoped the eastern
coast of New Holland would be reached. It was intended, after visiting that
coast, to return home by the East Indies and the Cape of Good Hope. Captain
Cook himself had wished to return by Cape Horn, with the view of settling the
question of a great southern continent; but the ship was deemed unfit to brave
the tempests to be expected in a high southern
latitude in the most inclement season of the year. The name of Cape Farewell
was given to the last point of land seen as the Endeavour quitted the coast of
New Zealand. The manners and customs of the inhabitants, as well as the
features of New Zealand, are now almost as well-known as those of any country
in Europe, and we are able to judge of the extraordinary accuracy of all
Captain Cook’s descriptions whenever he had an opportunity of observing them.
Cape Farewell was left on March 31, and the Endeavour
sailed westward. Nine days afterwards a tropical bird was seen, and on the 15th
the voyagers caught sight of an egg-bird and a gannet; and as these birds never
fly far from land, the lead was constantly heaved through the night. No bottom,
however, was found; and it was not till six o’clock on the morning of April 19
that land was seen by Mr Hicks, the first lieutenant. This land proved to be
part of the vast country of New Holland, since better known as Australia. The
coast first seen was that of New South Wales.
The Endeavour now coasted along about three leagues
from the shore, and as the weather was clear, a pleasant landscape presented
itself before the eyes of the explorers. The land was of moderate elevation,
diversified by hills and valleys, ridges and plains. Here and there were open
spaces clothed with verdure, but in general the country was covered with
timber. Smoke was in several places seen, showing that the country was
inhabited.
Several days were spent—the Endeavour coasting along
the shore to the northward; but on account of a northerly wind the voyagers
were seldom near enough to remark the features of the country. At last a bay
was discovered which seemed to be well sheltered from all winds, and Captain
Cook determined to anchor in it. Just before this several natives had been seen
on the shore, four of them carrying a canoe, but they did not come off, and
when the yawl, in which the commander attempted to land, approached, they all
ran away. So heavy a surf broke on the beach that it
was found impossible to go ashore.
The pinnace was now sent ahead with the master to
sound, while, the wind being out, the ship beat into the bay. A smoke being
seen on shore, the glasses were directed towards it, when ten men were observed
sitting round a fire, which they presently left, and then ascended a slight
eminence, whence they could observe the proceedings of the English visitors. As the pinnace pulled along the shore most of the natives kept
abreast of her. Some of them used threatening gestures, brandishing
their weapons: there were two especially, whose faces seemed to have been
dusted with a white powder, and their bodies painted with broad streaks, also
white, which, passing obliquely over their breasts and backs, looked not unlike
the cross-belts worn by soldiers. The same kind of streaks
were also drawn round their legs and thighs, like broad garters. They
were armed with long spears, and each of these men held in his hand a weapon
curved like a scimitar, and which appeared to be about two feet and a half
long. The Endeavour anchored two miles within the bay, in six-fathom water,
abreast of a small village consisting of six or eight huts. On the two points
on either side of the entrance a few huts, and men, women, and children, were
seen, as were four small canoes, with a man in each engaged in fishing, so
intent on their occupation that they took no notice of the ship. An old woman
also, followed by three children, came out of a thicket, laden with fire-wood,
each of the children having its burden. When she reached the huts three more
children came out to meet her. She looked often at the ship, but manifested no
surprise, and went on with her occupation and kindled a fire. Presently the men
landed, hauled up their canoes, and began to dress the fish, apparently unconcerned
at the stranger ship within half a mile of them. None of the savages had on a
particle of clothing. It was a curious scene, like that of a drama in which the
actors take no notice of the spectators.
In this instance, however, the actors were not so indifferent as they at first appeared; for when Captain
Cook and several companions approached the shore in one of the boats, although
the greater number of the people ran away, two men armed with lances came down
on the rocks to dispute the landing of the strangers. It was not an inapt representation on a small scale of the contest
which, ere many years had rolled by, was to begin on these shores between
savagedom and civilisation, when the latter would, with giant strides, sweep
over and subdue the land. The two brave savages kept flourishing their lances
and shouting in discordant tones, and Captain Cook, unwilling to injure them,
ordered his crew to lie on their oars while he tried to parley with them. To
show also his goodwill, he threw them nails, beads,
and other trifles, which they took up and seemed pleased to obtain. They then
waved their hands and seemed to invite their visitors on shore, but as soon as
the boat approached they hurried again to oppose a landing. Captain Cook, as a
last resource, fired a musket between them. On hearing the report the youngest
dropped a bundle of lances, but quickly picked them up; while the eldest, as if
in defiance, threw a stone at the intruders. Upon this a musket with small shot
was fired at his legs, on which he scampered off to the huts. It was hoped that
the contest was now over, and accordingly the English stepped on the shore of
that vast territory which was to become the heritage of millions of the
Anglo-Saxon race. Still the savage was not subdued, and appeared once more with
a shield on his arm, and advancing, made one more significant protest against
the intrusion of the white man, by hurling a spear into the very midst of the
strangers. Happily, no one was hurt, and a third musket loaded with small shot
being fired at them, after another spear had been thrown by one of the brave
natives, they both took to flight, and the English claimed to be, by right of
conquest, the lords of the soil. They might have pursued and overtaken the savages,
but Mr Banks suggested that the spears were possibly poisoned, and that it
would be imprudent to venture into the woods.
On entering one of the huts some little children were
seen partially concealed, but they were not disturbed, and when the English
went away, some beads, ribbons, and pieces of cloth were left in the huts as
presents, which it was hoped would gain the goodwill of the natives. Fifty
spears, from six to fifteen feet long, found lying about, were carried off. It
was at first supposed that they were poisoned, but on further examination it
was found that they were used for spearing fish, and that the green substance
found sticking to them was seaweed.
The next morning a stream was found at which the casks
could be filled. While this operation was going on, the natives came down and
watched the proceedings with wonder, but did not venture to approach the
strangers, though Mr Hicks advanced towards them with presents in his hands,
making every sign of friendship he could think of. That the bay was full of
fish, and capable of giving food to a large population, Captain Cook had ample
proof; for going with Mr Banks and Dr Solander to a cove on the north side of
the bay, in three or four hauls with the seine they took above three
hundredweight of fish.
An expedition into the country was planned the same
day by the commander, Mr Banks, Dr Solander, and seven others, and from it a
very fair idea of the general face of the country was obtained. On visiting the
huts they found that the natives had not taken away the presents that had been
left for them; and others, therefore, of greater value, were added. Presents
were left also at all the huts which were passed, in the hope of thus gaining
the goodwill of the natives. The trees were tall, straight, and without
underwood, and at such a distance from each other that the land might be
cultivated without cutting down a tree. The ground was covered with an
abundance of grass, growing in tufts close together, about as large as could
well be grasped in the hand. Although numerous huts were seen, the natives kept
themselves carefully concealed, though probably watching the strangers at a
distance; a glimpse only was caught of one man, who instantly ran away. A
transient view was got of an animal as big as a rabbit, and of the tracks of
another of the size of a wolf, clawed like a dog; traces of a third, which fed
on grass, and judged to be not less than a deer in size, were also seen. The
trees overhead abounded with birds of various kinds, among which were many of
exquisite beauty, particularly loriquets and cockatoos, which flew in scores
together. The trees, however, were not of many species; among others was one
which yielded a gum not unlike the sanguis draconis.
Many other excursions were made on shore, especially
by Mr Banks and Dr Solander, in search of plants, of which they found vast
quantities; and from this circumstance Captain Cook gave the place the name of
Botany Bay, a name the whole country commonly bore for more than half a century
afterwards.
Every effort to establish a friendly intercourse with
the natives failed. They had undoubtedly watched, though unperceived, the
effect of the white men’s weapons, and from awe and terror kept at a distance;
still, when they had an opportunity, they showed their hostility to the
strangers, and Mr Monkhouse narrowly escaped a spear thrown at him while he was
wandering in the woods.
During the ship’s stay in Botany Bay, Captain Cook had
the English colours hoisted every day on a flag-staff on shore, and caused the
ship’s name, and the date of her visit, to be engraved on a tree near the
watering-place.
At daybreak, on Tuesday, May 6, 1770, the Endeavour
sailed from Botany Bay, and at noon the same day, in latitude 33 degrees 50
minutes South, she was abreast of a fine-looking harbour, to which Captain Cook
gave the name of Port Jackson. Northerly winds prevented the ship from making
much progress till, in latitude 32 degrees 40 minutes, another harbour was seen,
and called Port Stephens. The ship continued her course to the north; smoke was
frequently seen, and occasionally the natives were observed. The land increased
considerably in height as she advanced, and in many places exhibited a pleasing
variety of ridges, hills, valleys, and plains, all clothed with wood. A wide,
open bay was passed in latitude 27 degrees 6 minutes, and called Moreton Bay.
It had now become necessary to lay the ship ashore,
and Captain Cook’s object was to find a place where this might be accomplished
with safety. Had he entered Port Jackson, he would have found one of the finest
harbours in the world for his purpose. He several times anchored while
proceeding along the coast, and landed to explore the country—the natives, as
before, running off and hiding themselves. Rockingham Bay was passed and named,
in latitude 17 degrees 59 minutes. Hitherto the Endeavour had met with no
misfortune; but as she was now to make acquaintance with it, the point seen
farthest to the north was called Cape Tribulation. It lies in latitude 16
degrees 4 minutes South, and longitude 145 degrees 26
minutes East.
One beautiful moonlight night, as the ship was
speeding on her course with a fair wind, among the shoals of that coral sea,
and while most of the officers and crew were tranquilly asleep, she suddenly
struck upon a reef, and instantly roused every one on board to the horrors of
shipwreck on an inhospitable coast, where they might linger for years without
succour. However, the captain and his officers and crew were equal to the
emergency, and by throwing everything weighty overboard that could be spared,
the ship floated, but was making water rapidly. Had the weather been at all
stormy, no human power could have saved their vessel. As it was, the fine weather
continued long enough to enable them to draw a sail over the leak. This served
the purpose of keeping her in sailing trim, until she was safely moored at the
mouth of a creek, which was named Endeavour River. This was on June 17, and
they remained there repairing the damage to the ship, as well as circumstances
permitted, until August 4.
Although the Endeavour was now out of danger, her
captain had still abundant cause for anxiety on another account: in spite of
all his care, the fearful malady of scurvy had gained, and was still gaining
ground among the ship’s company. Poor Tupia, who all his life had been
accustomed to fresh fruit and vegetables, was among the chief sufferers, and
symptoms were showing themselves which proved that the malignant disease had
already made rapid progress. Mr Green, the astronomer, was also, among many
others, stricken and disabled. As soon as possible, therefore, a tent was put
up on shore for the reception of the sick, and recourse was had to nets, for
providing fresh fish for the invalids.
The ground in the immediate neighbourhood of the river
was either swampy, sandy, or stony. Mr Banks, who went
on shore with his gun, saw great quantities of pigeons and crows: of the
former, which were very beautiful, he shot several. He also saw some deserted
human habitations, but no natives.
Four guns having been got up from the hold, were mounted on the quarter-deck of the ship, and the
heavy stores and powder were landed, that her damages might be examined. It
was, indeed, both wonderful and providential that she had escaped destruction;
for not only had the sharp rock torn off the planking and worked its way into
the timbers, but one point had cut a hole right through the bottom, and,
breaking off, had happily remained fixed. Had it fallen out, no human power
could have prevented the ship from foundering. Besides the leak, which was on
the starboard side, the ship had sustained very extensive injury on the
larboard. The sheathing from the bow on that side was torn off, and a great part
of the false keel was gone. The carpenters at once commenced their work; and
the forge was set up, that the smiths might make bolts and nails.
While this was going on, some of the people were sent
on shore to shoot pigeons for the sick, and on their return they reported that
they had found a stream of fresh water, and had seen several native huts, and
an animal as large as a greyhound, of slender form, mouse-coloured, and very
swift. The next day Captain Cook himself saw the same animal; it had a long tail,
and leaped liked a hare or deer, and the prints of its feet were like those of
a goat. For some time afterwards nothing more was seen of the animal, which Mr
Banks, the naturalist, considered must be of some hitherto unknown species; so,
indeed, it was, for it had no congeners in any quarter of the globe previously
visited; though now the kangaroo is familiar enough to all readers of natural
history, and it forms part of the arms of the colony of New South Wales.
Mr Banks likewise captured an Australian opossum, a
female, with two young ones. This class of animal was formerly supposed to be
peculiar to America, from whence its name is derived. Being nocturnal in their
habits, nothing is to be seen of them in the daytime, unless you can catch a
glimpse of one at noontide, sleeping soundly in the hollow of a tree. When
night comes, they leap from bough to bough with the greatest animation,
especially if it be moonlight. Some species, with thin membranes between the
fore and hind paws, can take a flying leap of, sometimes, thirty yards from
tree to tree; and hence they are called flying squirrels, though perfectly
distinct in their nature, and in some of their habits, from that animal.
The carpenters continued to work hard on the ship
whenever the tide permitted them. The position in
which she was now placed, with her bow on the bank, naturally threw all the
water aft, and from this circumstance the world was very nearly losing the
results of Mr Banks’s labours. For greater security he had placed his collection
of plants in the bread-room, into which the water ran, and covered them
completely. By great care most of them were dried, but many were entirely
spoilt.
In consequence of the carpenters being able to work
only at low tide, the repairs of the ship proceeded very slowly. In the
meantime, however, the people benefited from being on shore, and every effort
was made to obtain fresh provisions, calculated to improve their health. The
commander himself went to superintend the hauling of the seine; but this was
attended with little success, for during one evening only between twenty and
thirty fish were caught. A root with leaves like spinach, many cabbage-trees,
and a wild plantain, were found, with a fruit of a deep purple colour, of the
size of a pippin, which improved on keeping; Mr Banks also discovered a plant,
called, in the West Indies, Indian kale, which served for greens. These greens,
with a large supply of fish afterwards caught, afforded great relief to the
voyagers, who had so long been compelled to live on salt meat. Their fresh
provisions were further varied by some large cockles, one of which was of such
size that it furnished an ample meal for two men. What was of still greater
value was the discovery of some fine turtle by the master, three of which he
caught when out surveying; though afterwards, when sent out expressly to find
more, he seems to have purposely thwarted the wishes of his commander, who,
indeed, had too much cause to complain of the narrow-mindedness and ignorance
of several of his officers. Many other turtles were, however, afterwards
caught, of a species called the green turtle.
Some time elapsed before one of the animals which had
been so much the subject of speculation was shot by Mr Gore. This was a young
one, but others were seen equal in size to sheep; the larger sort are, indeed,
much larger than sheep. The fore legs of this specimen were only eight inches
long, and the hind legs two-and-twenty; its mode of progress being by a
succession of hops and leaps, helped by its long tail, with which also it
balances itself in its progress. It is easy to imagine the interest with which
this curious animal, now seen for the first time by civilised men, was examined
by Mr Banks and his brother naturalists. The next day their kangaroo (for so
the animal was called by the natives) was dressed for dinner, and proved most
excellent. The explorers might now have been said to fare sumptuously every
day; for they had an abundance of green turtle, fish, and vegetables of
different sorts, with an occasional kangaroo. It was indeed fortunate for the
crew of the Endeavour that the accident happened to her in this latitude,
instead of farther south, where, although the soil amply rewards the labours of
men, yet its spontaneous productions are very inferior to those of the north.
Kangaroos certainly would have been found in abundance, and perhaps fish, but
scarcely any vegetables fit for the food of man.
Favourably, however, as the navigators were situated
for diet, their position in other respects was unsatisfactory. This was
ascertained by the captain, who, with Mr Banks, one day started on a long walk
northward, partly to obtain a view of the country, but chiefly to take note of
appearances seaward. After traversing the country about eight miles, they
ascended a high hill, and were soon convinced that the danger of their
situation was at least equal to their apprehensions; for in whatever direction
they turned their eyes, they saw rocks and shoals without number, and no
passage out to sea but through the winding channels between them, which could
not be navigated without the last degree of difficulty and peril. The reports
of the master were equally unsatisfactory with regard to the shoals and dangers
off the mouth of the harbour, and it seems surprising that the ship should have
escaped them on her passage up the coasts. Still, as she had got in, there was
no doubt that she might get out, could the right passage be found. They had
other causes for hope and thankfulness: the natives were not likely to prove
troublesome, the climate was healthy, and food abundant.
Besides kangaroos, wild dogs were seen, which were
supposed to be foxes or wolves, as they partly resembled both these animals.
With the natives for some time no intercourse was opened. At last some appeared
on the opposite side of the river, very black, totally naked, and with lances
in their hands. The commander judiciously ordered his people to take no notice
of them, as the best means of drawing them near. This plan succeeded so well
that two of them came off in a canoe to within a musket-shot, and talked very loudly. They were answered in the same tone, and by degrees
they drew nearer, when some cloth, nails, beads, paper, and other trifles were
thrown to them. Of these things, however, they seemed to take no notice, but
were highly pleased when a fish was offered them. Some of them afterwards
landed where Tupia and the rest of the crew were sitting, and he prevailed on
them to lay down their arms, and to come forward without them. He then made
signs that they should sit down by him. With this they complied, and seemed to
be under no apprehension or constraint, although on more people going on shore
they expressed by their gestures some fear lest the newcomers should get
between them and their arms. More presents were made to them, to show the
goodwill of the strangers, and their desire to continue on friendly terms. To
prove this the Englishmen made signs that they were going to dinner, and
invited the blacks to eat with them; the latter, however, declined the honour,
and went away in their canoes. These men were of the common stature, but their
limbs were remarkably small; their hair was black, but not woolly, some of them
wearing it short cropped, others lank and long, and others had it curled. Their
colour was dark chocolate, but the tint was owing somewhat to the dirt which covered their skins. They had lively eyes, and their
teeth were even and white. The tones of their voices were soft and musical, and
there was a flexibility in their organs of speech
which enabled them to repeat, with great facility, many English words.
The next day three of the same party of natives paid
the strangers a visit with a fourth, whom they introduced as Yaparico. This
personage was distinguished by having the bone of a bird, six inches long,
thrust through the cartilage of his nose. He seemed to prize this strange
ornament as much as a young dandy does his newly raised silken moustache. On
examination, all his companions were found to have holes in their ears, as he
also had, while on the upper part of their arms they wore bracelets of plaited
hair; thus evincing a taste for ornament, although they had not a rag of any
sort of clothing. The previous day the only gift they seemed to prize was a
fish which was offered them. To-day they brought one in return. They were,
however, excessively jealous and suspicious, and in consequence of one of the
gentlemen examining their canoe, they at once jumped into her and paddled away.
The following day three natives ventured down to
Tupia’s tent, and were so well pleased with the way he received them that they
went away and brought two others, whom they introduced to him formally by name;
a ceremony they never omitted. Some fish were given to them, but after eating a
small portion, they threw the rest to Mr Banks’s dog. They could not be
persuaded to go far from their canoe, which was about ten feet long, fitted
with an outrigger, and though very inferior, like those of the Society Islands.
They used paddles, and in shallow water poled it along.
One day, on the commander’s return from an excursion
on shore, he found several natives on board. Of all the articles exhibited to
them, nothing seemed to have attracted their attention so much as the turtles,
of which there were no less than twelve on deck. Two days afterwards they came
again, bringing with them a greater number of lances than before. These they
placed in a tree, with a man and a boy to watch them. It was evident that their
object was to get one of the turtles. They asked for one by signs, and being
refused, appealed to everybody who appeared to them to have any authority. Then
seizing one, they attempted to drag it overboard. On its being taken from them,
they jumped into their canoe in a rage, and went on shore. Here Mr Banks and
others followed them. Before they could be stopped they seized their arms, and,
snatching a brand from under a pitch-kettle, they whirled it round with great
dexterity and rapidity, and set fire to the grass, which was six feet or more
high, and dry as stubble. The fire burnt with fearful rapidity. The woodwork of
the smith’s forge was destroyed; it caught a sow and some young pigs, one of
which was scorched to death, and Mr Banks had great difficulty in saving his
tent, which had been set up for Tupia on shore. Happily most of the stores,
with the powder, had been taken back to the ship, or the consequences might
have been more serious.
In another place the seamen were washing, and a
quantity of linen and the nets were spread out to dry. Here the natives,
disregarding all threats and entreaties, again set fire to the grass. By great
exertions the fire was extinguished before it had done much damage, but where
it had first been kindled it burnt with great fury, and spread into the woods
to a long distance. A gun loaded with small shot was now fired at the natives, which put them to flight, one of them being wounded; and to
give them a lesson, a bullet was fired to pass near them, and this of course
hastened their retreat. It was thought that now they would give no more
trouble; but in a short time they came back, and Mr Banks and others went out
to meet them.
An old man among the natives then advanced, having a
lance in his hand without a point. He came forward slowly, stopping several
times, and the English made signs to him that they wished to be friends. On
this he turned round and addressed his companions, and they, having set up
their arms against a tree, also came forward in a friendly manner. The lances
which had been taken from them were then returned; this evidently afforded them
great satisfaction, and the reconciliation was considered complete.
Several strangers who were among the party were now
introduced by name; and on receiving some presents they went away highly
contented.
The next day no natives appeared, but the hills all
round, for many miles, were on fire, the effects of which by night were very
striking. Had the voyagers been compelled by circumstances to remain on that
coast, the result of these fires would have been serious, as the conflagration
would have driven the kangaroos and the feathered tribes to a distance, and
thus deprived the crew of the Endeavour of some of their principal means of
support. But the ship was now ready for sea, though the master had been unable
to find any channel to the northward by which an escape could be made from
among the coral reefs which hemmed her in.
It was necessary, however, to make the attempt without
delay, as provisions and stores were running short, and the proper time for
navigating the Indian seas was passing by. They were doomed to have their
patience yet further tried, for when all was ready heavy gales prevented the
ship from putting to sea.
On July 29 the weather moderated, the wind came off
the land, and everything appeared favourable for sailing, when it was found
that there was not sufficient water on the bar for the ship to pass over it.
For several days more the ship was detained by the unfavourable state of the
weather: the detention would have been of still greater consequence had not the
boats sent out to catch fish and turtle been tolerably successful. At length,
on August 4, Captain Cook had the satisfaction of sailing out of Endeavour
Harbour. The ship was surrounded by shoals, and he was yet in doubt whether he
should beat back to the southward, or seek a passage to the north or east. He
had now a most anxious time, for it was clear that there was no way to sea
except through the labyrinth of shoals amid which the ship lay. The navigation
of a ship among coral rocks is at all times dangerous, for the lead gives no
notice of their vicinity, their sides rising up like walls from almost
unfathomable depths.
Night now approaching, the Endeavour anchored, when
soon afterwards it came on to blow very hard, and at eleven she began to drive.
More cable was veered away, and this brought her up; but in the morning, it
coming on to blow harder, she drove again. All the appliances of seamanship
were put into operation, but still she drove, when topgallant masts were got
down, and yards and topmasts struck; and now, at length, she rode securely.
In this position she continued till the 10th, when,
Captain Cook having resolved to search for a passage close in shore to the
northward, she got under way, and stood in that direction with the boats exploring
ahead. Nothing but the greatest caution, perseverance, and first-rate
seamanship could have taken the Endeavour free of the dangers which surrounded
her. Hour after hour the sagacious commander was at the mast-head, or away in a
boat searching for a passage, while the rest of the boats were employed in a
similar service. At length a passage was discovered, and with the boats
piloting ahead, the Endeavour stood through it.
A long rolling swell convinced the voyagers that they
had no rocks or shoals to fear, but at the same time proved to them that they
must not place the same confidence in their ship as before she had struck; for
the seas she now encountered so widened the leaks that they admitted no less
than nine inches of water an hour, which, considering the state of the pumps
and the navigation before them, was a matter of serious consideration.
The great object Captain Cook had now in view was to
ascertain whether the coast of New Holland, along which he was sailing, was or
was not united to that of New Guinea. He was afraid that, if he stood on long
to the north, he might overshoot the passage, should one exist. At six in the
evening, therefore, he brought the ship to with her head to the north-east, no
land being in sight. The next morning sail was made, and land seen; and as the
day advanced a reef appeared over which the sea broke heavily, extending from
north to south as far as the eye could reach, with an occasional break between
the ship and the land. The wind was then east-south-east; but scarcely had the
sails been trimmed to haul off it than the wind shifted to east-by-north, which
made it very doubtful whether the ship could clear the reef. The lead was kept
going all night while the ship stood to the northward, but no bottom was found,
yet at four o’clock the roaring of the surf was distinctly heard, and at break
of day it was seen foaming to a vast height at not more than a mile off. The
seas, too, which rolled in on the reef rapidly carried the ship towards it. The
wind fell to a dead calm, and the depth made it impossible to anchor. The only
prospect of saving the ship was by rowing; but the pinnace was under repair and
useless: the long-boat and yawl were, however, sent ahead to tow, and sweeps were got out.
Still these efforts could only delay the destruction
which seemed inevitable. The ship continued to drive on towards the fatal reef;
she was within a hundred yards of it, and the same billow which washed her side
broke on the reef to a tremendous height the very next time it rose. The carpenters had been working at the pinnace, and
she was now lowered, but even with her assistance the Endeavour drove nearer
and still nearer to the reef. At the very moment that her doom seemed fixed a
light air sprang up, and, with the help of the boats, gave her once more
head-way. Scarcely, however, had ten minutes passed before the wind again
dropped, and the ship was driven back towards the roaring breakers. Again the
gentle breeze returned, and lasted another ten minutes. During this time an opening
had been discovered, and the ship was towed towards it, but so strong a current
set through it that she was driven fully a quarter of a mile away from the
reef. Aided by the boats, the ebb tide carried her nearly two miles away by
noon. When the flood made, however, she was once more carried back towards the
reef; but in the meantime the first lieutenant had discovered a passage, and a
light breeze springing up, it was resolved to attempt it. The boats continued
towing ahead; the raging, roaring sea leaped up on either side; the breeze
filled the sails; the tide swept rapidly onward; and in a short time the
Endeavour was within the reef, safe from present danger, and anchored in
nineteen-fathom water.
Captain Cook now resolved to keep the land close on
board, in spite of all dangers, for fear of missing the channel. Numerous
islands and headlands were passed and named, and rocks and reefs were escaped,
and at length perseverance and sagacity were rewarded by the discovery of York
Cape, the northern promontory of the country, and the southern side of Torres Straits,
through which the Endeavour triumphantly passed.
As Captain Cook was now about to leave the eastern
coast of New Holland, which he had followed up from latitude 38 degrees, and
which he was confident no European had ever before seen, he landed on an
island, which he named Possession Island, and once more took formal possession
of the whole eastern coast of the mainland, in right of His Majesty King George
the Third. He gave to the country, with all its bays, rivers, and islands, the
name of New South Wales. Three volleys of small arms were then fired, and these
were answered by the same number from the ship. Ten natives were seen on the
island when this ceremony was performed, and seemed astounded, as they very
well might be.
They were seen to be armed with spears; one of them
had also a bow and a bundle of arrows, which weapons had not before been seen.
Two of them had large ornaments of mother-of-pearl hanging round their necks.
It was expected that when the boats approached they would have made a show of
opposing a landing, but instead of that, they walked leisurely away. They and
their descendants have never been disturbed in their possession of the island,
and at the present day it is exactly in the state it was when Cook visited it.
Some time was occupied in the intricate navigation of
the straits, and the Endeavour then steered north, along the south-western
coast of New Guinea, but the water being shallow, at such a distance from the
shore that it could scarcely be seen from the ship. Still, as the commander
wished to ascertain the character of the country and the appearance of the
inhabitants, he steered in for the land till about three or four miles from it,
and in three-fathom water, when the ship came to an anchor on September 3.
The pinnace being hoisted out, Captain Cook, with Mr
Banks and his servants, Dr Solander and the boat’s crew, in all twelve persons,
well armed, embarked in her and pulled directly for the shore. But the water
was so shallow that they could not reach it by about two hundred yards; they
therefore waded the rest of the way, and left two
seamen to take care of the boat. As yet no inhabitants had been seen, but when
the party landed they discovered the print of feet on the sand below high-water
mark, showing that people had lately been there. A thick wood came down to
within a hundred yards of the water. To avoid the risk of being cut off by an
ambush, the explorers proceeded cautiously, skirting the wood till they came to
a grove of cocoanut trees of small growth which stood on the bank of a little
stream. The trees were well hung with fruit, and near them was a small hut,
round which lay a number of the freshly picked shells. Tempting as was the
fruit, it was not considered safe to climb the trees to obtain it; they were
obliged, therefore, to leave the grove without tasting a nut. Farther on they
met with a bread-fruit tree and some plantains, and had got about a quarter of
a mile from the boat when three blacks rushed out of the wood with a hideous
shout, and ran towards them. The foremost threw something from his hand which
burnt like gunpowder, and the other two darted their lances at the strangers.
As it was necessary to keep these savages at a distance, they were fired at with
small shot, but as this did not make them retreat, and they threw another dart,
some bullets were discharged at them. The effect was to make them run; but it
was hoped that none of them were wounded. As Captain Cook says, he had no
desire to invade the country, either to gratify appetite or curiosity; he
judged it right and merciful to retreat at once, so as not to have to destroy
more of the ignorant savages. There was no time to lose, as the men in the boat
made signs that more natives were collecting. They had succeeded in getting
safely on board, when they saw nearly a hundred savages, who shouted and threw fire-darts, several at a time, towards them. On board ship it
was supposed, from the effect produced, that the natives had fire-arms, and
even from the boat, had they not been so near, the English would have fancied,
from the flash and smoke, that the blacks were firing musketry; the sound only
was wanting. Some muskets being fired over their heads, they walked leisurely
away.
In appearance these natives were very similar to those
of New Holland, though their skin was not quite so dark. They were all stark
naked. The land was low, and covered with a luxuriance of wood and herbage that
can scarcely be conceived. Some of the officers wished to send on shore to cut
down the cocoanut trees for the sake of the fruit, but the commander refused to
comply with their proposal, feeling that it would be cruel and criminal to risk
the lives of the natives, who would certainly try to defend their property,
merely for the sake of a transient gratification. The boat was therefore
hoisted in, and sail made to the westward.
The more interesting portion of Captain Cook’s first
voyage round the world was now accomplished. He had successfully made the
important observation for which he was sent out; he had become intimately
acquainted with the inhabitants of Otaheite and several of the adjacent
islands, though, from the cunning of the people, he had failed to discover that
it was among the darkest of “the dark places of the earth.” He had shown that
if there was a great southern continent it must be in a very high latitude; he
had proved that New Zealand consisted of two great islands, and had cause to
suspect the existence of a third smaller one. He had sailed along the coast of
New Holland, and had made the acquaintance of its inhabitants and many of its
animal and vegetable productions. Though he had seen the coast of Tasmania, and
admired its beauty, he had not discovered that it was separated from New
Holland; but he had settled the point before in dispute—whether that
little-known land was or was not joined to New Guinea—by sailing between them;
and he had shown that the eastern coast of the island-continent of Australia
was fit to become the habitation of civilised men. This great fact was, after
all, the most important result of the voyage.
The condition of the Endeavour had, by this time,
become very critical. So battered were her lower timbers and planks, and so out
of order were her pumps, that a heavy sea might at any
moment have sent her to the bottom. It was absolutely necessary to find a
harbour where she might be hove down to undergo a complete refit. Under these
circumstances the commander of the expedition determined to go to Batavia, the
capital of the Dutch settlements in the island of Java, and at that time the
centre of commerce in those seas. He had, indeed, no option, for there was not
another port which he could hope to reach, where the ship would receive the
necessary repairs. He was not, indeed, ignorant of the unhealthiness of the
climate; but he hoped not to be detained there long, and that his hardy crew
would be able for a short time to withstand its ill effects.
The first island of any size which the Endeavour
sighted after leaving New Guinea was Timor, along the shore of which she
coasted. Notwithstanding the wishes of some of his officers, Captain Cook
declined to put in there, as he was anxious to reach Batavia without delay.
Between that island and Java, however, he fell in with a small island, which at
first he thought was a new discovery; but on steering for it, and getting close
in with the north side, houses, plantations, and numerous flocks of sheep were
seen. The temptation of obtaining fresh meat and vegetables was not to be
resisted, as there were many sick on board; and accordingly Mr Gore was sent on
shore to open a communication with the natives. Two persons were seen riding on
the hills as if for their amusement, and often stopping to look at the ship.
This made the voyagers suspect that there must be a settlement of Europeans on
the island. Such was in fact the case. The Dutch East India Company had a short
time before taken possession of it, and sent a resident to superintend their
affairs, though the native rajah or chief was still retained as the nominal
ruler of the island. This island proved to be Savu, at that time so little
known that it was not to be found on any of the charts on board. It is about
thirty miles long, and was then very thickly populated.
In the evening the ship entered a bay before a large
native town, over which the Dutch colours were flying, and three guns were
fired. The native chief treated the strangers very courteously, and was
evidently ready to supply them with all they desired. They were informed that the
island abounded in buffaloes, sheep, horses, asses, goats, hogs, dogs, cats,
fowls, and pigeons, with most of the fruits of the tropics. The resident, Mr
Lange, however, though polite in his manners, very soon showed that he was
determined to make a gain of the visitors, and asked the most exorbitant prices
for all the provisions they required, besides insisting that they should be
paid for in gold. Fortunately, by a well-timed present to an old man, the
rajah’s prime minister, his services were engaged, and ultimately, through his
means, all the provisions which were required were procured at fair prices. The
island was divided into five provinces, with a rajah over each, who could
altogether muster upwards of seven thousand fighting men. All the rajahs were
said to live on friendly terms with each other, and the inhabitants were
described by Mr Lange as being particularly well conducted and moral. Their
religion was a kind of paganism, but of a most liberal description, according
to the account given by Mr Lange, each man having the liberty to set up a god
in his own house, and to worship it after his own fashion. Although, in many
instances, the Dutch have been sadly unmindful of the spiritual as well as
temporal interests of the inhabitants of their colonial possessions, they had
sent to this island a Dutch officer, and a native woman who had been brought up
a Christian, charged with the education of the people, and their instruction in
the principles of Christianity. The Dutch had also printed versions of the New
Testament, a catechism, and several tracts in the language of this and the
neighbouring islands. The number of Christians in the township of Seba alone
was estimated at six hundred. If the character given by Mr Lange of these
islanders was correct, a true Christian missionary would have found a prolific
field open to him among them.
The Endeavour left the interesting island of Savu on
September 21, 1770, and made Java Head, at the west end of Java, on October 1.
Poor Tupia was very ill, and on the morning of the next day a boat was sent on
shore to procure some fresh fruit for him, and some grass for the buffaloes,
which, with sheep, pigs, and fowls, had recently been got on board. On passing
through the Straits of Sunda, the Endeavour was boarded by the Dutch
authorities, and various official inquiries were made as to whence she had
come, and the object of her voyage. These being answered, she proceeded to
Batavia.
Captain Cook and his companions were received into
port by the Dutch governor with all the courtesy and kindness which could be
expected. Permission was given them to take up their abode in private
residences, although strangers were, as a rule, compelled to live at an hotel, under the direct supervision of the authorities.
Leave was also obtained to heave down the ship in order to repair her damages,
which were found on inspection to be of a very serious nature. Indeed, in one
place the planking was so worn by the grinding on the rocks, that it did not
exceed the thickness of the sole of a man’s shoe. Her frame in many places was
much shattered, and her pumps had become rotten and utterly useless.
Batavia had long had the reputation of being very
unhealthy. The crew, however, thought themselves thoroughly seasoned to all
climates, and their rosy countenances contrasted favourably with the pale faces
of those who had been even a few weeks at the place. All, indeed, with the
exception of Tupia, were in good health when they entered the port. Even he
revived at the strange sights which met his gaze as he entered, for the first
time, a civilised town. The houses, carriages, streets, people, and a number of
other novel objects had the effect on him of fascination. Tayeto expressed his
wonder and delight with still less restraint, and danced along the street in a
kind of ecstasy, examining every object with a restless and eager curiosity.
Tupia, remarking the various dresses of the people of different countries,
desired likewise to put on his native costume. South Sea cloth was therefore
sent for from the ship, in which he immediately equipped himself.
In the course of a few days, however, the effects of
the climate began to be felt. Poor Tupia, after the excitement caused by the
novelties he witnessed had subsided, experienced a reaction, and every day grew
worse and worse. Young Tayeto also was seized with an inflammation of the
lungs, and both Dr Solander and Mr Banks and his two servants were taken
seriously ill; indeed, almost all the people belonging to the ship, on board or
ashore, were sick, affected by the low swampy situation of the place, and the
numberless dirty canals which intersected the town in all directions.
Tents were then set up on shore, on Cooper’s Island,
for the ship’s company, and one was also pitched, by Mr Banks’s desire, for
Tupia, who was anxious to escape from the close air of the town. Mr Banks
accompanied him, and remained with him for two days, till compelled by his own
illness (a regular tertian ague) to return to his lodgings. Mr Monkhouse, the
surgeon of the ship, was the first victim, and Dr Solander could with
difficulty crawl out of lied to attend his funeral, which Mr Banks, from
illness, was unable to do. On the 9th the poor young boy Tayeto died, and
Tupia, who loved him as a son, was so much affected that he rapidly sank, and
in two days followed him to the grave. The lives of Mr Banks and Dr Solander
were saved by their removal to a healthy spot, some miles from the city.
Altogether, seven persons who had come in the ship were buried at Batavia; but
many others imbibed the seeds of disease, which, in a short time, proved fatal.
Every possible assistance which Captain Cook required was given by the Dutch governor, and on December
26th, 1770, having taken leave of him and the principal people in the place,
the voyagers set sail from Batavia with a light breeze from south-west. At that
time the number of sick on board amounted to forty, and the rest of the ship’s company were in a very feeble condition. Every man
had been ill except one, the sail-maker, who was upwards of seventy years of
age; he, however, was among those who died on the passage to the Cape of Good
Hope.
After leaving Java, the Endeavour touched at Prince’s
Island, where she took in water and fresh provisions. Shortly afterwards,
dysenteries and slow fevers appeared, and so violent were the symptoms that the
ship was a complete hospital, those who were able to move about being
insufficient to attend to the sick in their hammocks. Mr Banks was so ill that
his life was despaired of. Mr Green, Mr Sporing, Mr Parkinson, the natural
history painter, with Mr Monkhouse, and many others, three-and-twenty persons
in all, in addition to the seven buried at Batavia, died before the ship
reached the Cape of Good Hope. On March 15 the Endeavour anchored in Table Bay,
near the Cape of Good Hope, where Captain Cook’s first care was to provide a
place for the sick on shore. Here the greater number recovered, though some
were still ill when again taken on board. The country appeared to the voyagers
to be of a most sterile and forlorn character, and from the accounts they
received of the great distances from each other at which the settlers were
situated, they conjectured that such must be the general nature of the country
in the interior. Possibly the Dutch settlers may not have been anxious to
praise it to the English, as it must have been obvious that it would prove a
very important possession, on account of our extensive commerce with the East
Indies.
Cape Town, at that time, consisted of about a thousand
houses, neatly built of brick, and white-washed on the outside, with thatched
roofs. The streets were broad and commodious, and through the principal street
ran a canal, with rows of oaks planted on either side, but, on account of the
slope of the ground, having numerous locks. The healthiness of the climate of
Cape Town contrasted favourably with that of Batavia, and most of the sick
rapidly recovered. The Dutch, at this time, appear to
have been living on friendly terms with all the neighbouring tribes of natives,
nor did Captain Cook seem to be aware that any of the Hottentots were reduced
to a state of slavery. He speaks only of their being servants to the Dutch
farmers, and taking care of their cattle. Their only enemies were the bushmen,
who never engaged in open warfare, but stole the cattle of their neighbours at
night, being armed with lances and poisoned arrows.
The Endeavour left Table Bay on April 14, and after
calling at Robin Island, a Dutch convict station, she proceeded with her voyage
on the 25th. On that day she lost her master, whose health had been destroyed
by intemperate habits, and just before she reached England her first
lieutenant, Mr Hicks, died of consumption, from which he had been suffering the
greater part of the voyage; thus making up a long catalogue of deaths since the
ship left England. Mr Hicks was succeeded by Mr Charles Clerke, who accompanied
Captain Cook in his subsequent voyages, and was highly esteemed by his
commander, as well as by all who sailed under him.
On May 1 the Endeavour called off Saint Helena, then
known only as the summit of a submarine mountain, the water round it being of
unfathomable depth; although the island was of especial importance to Indiamen,
as it was the only British possession at which they could call on their voyage.
Here the Endeavour found the Portland man-of-war, commanded by Captain Elliot,
and twelve sail of Indiamen. In company with this fleet, she stood out of the
roads on May 4. But finding that his ship sailed more heavily than the rest of
the fleet, Captain Cook deposited his logs, or ship’s papers, and some of the
journals of his officers, with Captain Elliot; and on the 23rd not one of the
ships was in sight.
By this time the rigging and sails of the Endeavour
had become so bad that every day something was giving way. But, notwithstanding
this, she continued her course in safety, and on June 10 land, which proved to
be the Lizard Point, was seen by Nicholas Young, the same boy who first sighted
New Zealand. On the 12th the ship came to an anchor in the Downs, and Captain
Cook went on shore at Deal.
The importance of the voyage just described can be
better appreciated by the present generation than it could have been by those
who were alive at the time of its conclusion. Captain Cook’s own modest summary
of it is interesting. He says:—
“I sailed from Deptford July 30, 1768; from Plymouth
August 26; touched at Madeira, Rio de Janeiro, and Straits of Le Maire; and
entered the South Pacific Ocean, by Cape Horn, in January, the following year.
“I endeavoured to make a direct course to Otaheite,
and, in part, succeeded; but I made no discovery till I got within the tropic,
when I fell in with Lagoon Island, Two Groups, Bird Island, Chain Island, and
on April 13 arrived at Otaheite, where I remained three months, during which
time the observations on the transit of Venus were made.
“I then left it; discovered and visited the Society
Isles, and Oheteroa; thence proceeded to the south till I arrived in the
latitude of 40 degrees 22 minutes, longitude 147 degrees 29 minutes West; and
on October 6 fell in with the east side of New Zealand. I continued exploring
the coast of this country till March 1, 1770, when I quitted it and proceeded
to New Holland, and having surveyed the eastern coast of that vast country,
which part had not before been visited, I passed between its northern extremity
and New Guinea; landed on the latter, touched at the island of Savu, thence to
Batavia, the Cape of Good Hope, Saint Helena, and arrived in England on July
12, 1771.”
On their arrival in London, Cook and his companions
were received by the scientific, as well as by the great and fashionable world,
with the attention and respect they so well-deserved; for no previous
expedition undertaken by England had been more generally successful. Cook was
promoted to the rank of Commander, his commission being dated August 29, 1771.
He was also introduced to the King at Saint James’s Palace, and had the honour
of presenting the journal of his voyage, illustrated by maps and charts; while
their Majesties the King and Queen, and numerous people of high rank and
attainments, took delight in listening to the accounts given by the explorers
of their adventures, and in examining the specimens of manufactures and of
natural history which they had brought home.
It was not, however, present éclat, nor the apparent
magnitude of the discoveries made, but their consequences, which rendered this
voyage of real importance. The ultimate result was the founding of two nations
of the Anglo-Saxon race; and whatever cause there may be to question, if not to
condemn, the manner in which possession has been obtained of distant countries,
and in which, also, their colonisation has been effected, in almost every
instance, and by almost all nations having the power which civilisation gives,
it must still be borne in mind that God has overruled, and is overruling, these
transactions for His own glory and for the spiritual benefit of the world. He
makes not only “the wrath,” but the ambition, and pride, and cupidity of man
“to praise Him;” and then the remainder “He restrains.” And all circumstances
are made, in His infinite wisdom and power, to advance the spread of “the
glorious Gospel of the blessed God,” and to usher in the kingdom of Him whose
right it is to reign, even of Christ Jesus, the Prince of peace, the Lord of lords,
and the King of kings.
With regard to the discoveries made in the voyage just
recorded, it is almost superfluous to say that the countries then visited for
the first time by our countrymen have, after the lapse of a century, become
familiar as household words to the whole world. Australia, Tasmania, and New
Zealand have become component parts of the British empire, and have already
been made the home of hundreds of thousands of the crowded population of the
British Isles, as well as of emigrants from other European countries; and these
lands will, probably, before another century has passed away, become centres,
not only of civilisation, but of evangelical truth and saving faith. And herein
the Christian reader will and must rejoice.
Chapter Three.
Second
Voyage of Discovery. June 1772 to July
1775.
It had long been the opinion of geographers that a
great southern continent existed; and in 1738 a French expedition, under
Monsieur Lozier Bouvet, had been sent out in search of it. On January 1, 1739,
he got sight of land, in latitude 45 degrees 20 minutes, and longitude 25
degrees 47 minutes East from Teneriffe. It was,
according to his description, a lofty and steep cape, backed by mountains
mostly covered with snow, while the coast had so broad a fringe of ice that it
was impossible to approach it near enough to make any thorough examination. In
remembrance of the day of discovery, the cape, which was supposed to be part of
the southern continent, was called Cape de la Circoncision.
It had been supposed, before the return of Cook from
his first voyage, that New Zealand, New Holland, and New Guinea formed part of
the great southern land, which was generally denominated Terra Australis
Incognita.
Cook, indeed, dispelled this idea by proving that
these three territories were islands; but the question as to the existence of
the great southern land still remained to be proved.
The subject was under discussion by men of science
when the Endeavour returned from her first voyage; and the Royal Society soon
afterwards resolved to recommend the despatch of another expedition, for the
purpose of attempting to settle the question. An offer of the command of this
exploratory voyage was at once made to Captain Cook, who gladly accepted it—the
selection of ships suitable for the purpose being wisely left to his judgment.
The qualities he considered essential were great capacity, or stowage room, a
rig easily worked, a size not too large to enter small harbours, and a build
which would enable the vessel to take the ground and be easily got off again.
The Endeavour, having been sent out to the Falkland
Islands as a store ship, was not available; two more vessels, therefore, made
by the same ship-builder as the Endeavour, were purchased at Hull. The largest,
named the Resolution, was of four hundred and sixty-two tons burden; and the
other, called the Adventure, was three hundred and thirty-six tons. Captain
Cook took possession of the former, as commander of the expedition; and Tobias
Furneaux, who had been second lieutenant with Captain Wallis, was promoted and
appointed to serve under Cook in command of the Adventure.
Captain Cook’s first lieutenant was Robert Cooper; his
second, Charles Clerke, who had accompanied him on his previous voyage, as had
also his third lieutenant, Richard Pickersgill, and the lieutenant of marines,
John Edgecombe, with two of the warrant and several of the petty officers.
Mr Banks and Dr Solander had intended going, but not
finding the accommodation on board which they considered necessary for the
comfort and convenience of themselves and their attendants, they gave up the
project. So great, however, was the public enthusiasm on the subject of the expedition, that, according to Boswell, even Dr Johnson
thought of applying for leave to accompany it, though, if he ever seriously
entertained the wish, it was speedily abandoned.
Two astronomers, Mr William Wales and Mr William
Bayley, were engaged by the Board of Longitude—the former sailing in the
Resolution, the latter in the Adventure. The Admiralty appointed, as
landscape-painter, Mr William Hodges; and Mr John Reinhold Forster, and his
son, were engaged to attend to the department of natural history. The Board of
Longitude also amply furnished the expedition with the best astronomical and
other instruments which might be required, and with four watch-machines, as
chronometers were then called. Lord Sandwich, who was at the head of the
Admiralty Board, anxiously watched the equipment of the ships, visiting them
from time to time to satisfy himself that everything was done in the best way
to secure the success of the undertaking and the comfort and health of those on
board.
Captain Cook had, in his former voyage, paid great
attention to the means best adapted for preserving the health of his crew, and
he had seen the importance of having an ample supply of provisions of an
anti-scorbutic character. He also endeavoured to have the ship well dried and
ventilated, and determined, as far as possible, that the men’s clothes should
be kept dry, and their persons clean. Each ship had two years and a half
provisions on board, and among other articles were wheat and sugar (in lieu of
oatmeal), oil, malt, salted cabbage, portable broth, mustard, marmalade of
carrots, and inspissated juice of wort, from which beer could be at once made.
The frame of a vessel of twenty tons was put on board each ship, to be set up,
if found necessary, to serve as tenders, or to enable the crews to escape
should the ships be wrecked. The Resolution had a complement of one hundred and
twelve officers and men, and the Adventure of eighty-one. Fishing-nets and
hooks of all sorts, articles to barter with the natives or to bestow as
presents, and additional clothing for the crews were put on board. Medals also
were struck, with the likeness of his Majesty on one side, and of the two ships
on the other, to be given to the inhabitants of newly-discovered countries, as
memorials of the explorers’ visit. Indeed, no expedition with a similar object
in view had ever left the shores of England so well equipped in every respect
as was the one now about to sail.
The Resolution, being ready for sea, sailed from
Deptford on April 9, 1772; but after being joined by the Adventure, she was
detained by contrary winds till May 10, when, both again sailing, the
Resolution was found to be so crank (Note 1) that it was necessary to lower her
upper works, and for this purpose she put into Sheerness. Lord Sandwich and Sir
Hugh Palliser went down to see the alterations made in an effectual manner. On
June 22, the ship, being again ready for sea, sailed from Sheerness and joined
the Adventure in Plymouth Sound on July 3. Thus it will be seen that there was
a delay of nearly three months after the expedition was supposed to be ready,
before it was fully prepared for sea. Lord Sandwich and Sir Hugh Palliser again
visited the ships in Plymouth Sound, and the chronometers being set going in
the presence of the astronomers and the chief officers, the ships at length, on
July 13, set sail and shaped a course for Madeira.
Anchoring in Funchal Roads on the 29th, and having
taken on board fresh beef and vegetables, including onions, for sea stores, the
ships sailed again on August 1. Finding their water run short, they put into
Porto Praya, in the island of Saint Jago, one of the Cape de Verde Islands, for
a supply. On October 29 the land of the Cape of Good Hope was made, but as the
ships were unable to get in before dark, they stood off and on during the
night. In the evening the phosphorescence of the sea became unusually
brilliant; and to convince Mr Forster, who differed from Mr Banks and Dr
Solander that it was caused by insects, some buckets of water were drawn up
from alongside. On examination he found that the water was full of globular
insects of the size of a pin’s head, and quite transparent.
The next day the ships anchored off Cape Town, where
Captain Cook and his officers were received by the Governor and other
authorities with attention and respect. The Governor informed Captain Cook that
a French ship had discovered land in the meridian of the Mauritius, in latitude
48 degrees South; and also that in the previous March two French ships, under
Monsieur Marion, had touched at the Cape on their way to explore the South
Pacific.
The expedition quitted the Cape of Good Hope on
November 22, and steered a course towards Cape Circumcision, which was the
first object for which they were directed to search. They soon found the
weather very cold, when warm clothing was issued; and having encountered a
heavy gale, with hail and rain, which drove them far to the eastward of their
course, all hope of reaching the looked-for cape was given up. Owing, also, to
the severity of the weather, and the sudden transition from dry heat to extreme
cold and wet, the ships’ companies suffered a severe misfortune in the loss of
nearly all the live-stock (consisting of sheep, hogs, and geese) which they had
brought with them from Cape Town. This weather continued for the greater part
of the time the ships remained in that high latitude. On December 10 an island
of ice was seen in latitude 50 degrees 40 minutes South and 2 degrees 0 minutes East of the Cape of Good Hope. After this thick, hazy
weather again came on, with sleet and snow. The ships continued their course,
the Resolution leading, when an iceberg, directly for which they were steering,
was discovered through the mist not a mile off. It was about fifty feet high,
flat at top, about half a mile in circumference, and its sides, against which
the sea broke furiously, rose perpendicularly from the ocean. Captain Furneaux,
who was astern, took this ice for land, and hauled off from it; and there is no
doubt that many navigators who have reported land in these latitudes have been
deceived in the same way.
Nothing could be more trying to the explorers than the
navigation in which they were now engaged, day after day tacking off and on
among large fields of ice, through which they in vain endeavoured to find a
passage to the southward, with the constant risk, in thick weather, of running
foul of icebergs, or of getting fast in the packed ice which might any moment
enclose them, while all the time they were exposed to storms of snow and sleet,
with a constant frost, although it was the middle of summer. Dangerous as it
was sailing among icebergs, or, as Captain Cook calls them, ice-rocks,
especially in thick weather, the ships were in still greater peril when
surrounded by packed ice, which consisted of huge slabs, of great thickness,
varying from thirty or forty feet down to three or four feet square, packed
close together, and often piled one on another. Stout as were the ships, it was
not expected that they could resist the enormous pressure to which they would
be subjected should they get caught in such frozen bonds. It was the opinion of
those on board that this sort of ice was formed only in bays and rivers, and
that therefore they must be near land, which was eagerly though vainly
looked-for. So severe was the cold that an iceberg examined by the master had
no water running down it, as is generally the case in summer.
Captain Cook now steered to the west, in the hope of
getting round the ice; but though he held on this course for some time, both to
the south and west of the supposed position of Cape Circumcision, he neither
fell in with it, nor did he observe any of the usual indications of land.
Various birds, however, were seen, and several of them were shot; but as they
would find roosting-places on the ice islands, they might have come a very
great distance from the land. Thus, the penguins, which were seen in great numbers
on some icebergs, and are supposed never to go far from land, might have come a
very great distance over the ice from their native haunts. Be that as it may,
no land was seen by either vessel, notwithstanding the diligent search made for
it.
On December 31, while the ships were still surrounded
by ice, a strong gale sprang up, with a heavy sea, which made it very dangerous
for them to remain in the position in which they then were. The peril was yet
further increased by an immense field of ice which appeared to the north,
extending from north-east by east to south-west by west, and between two and
three miles off. The ships received several severe blows from masses of ice of
the largest size. Providentially, they got clear by the afternoon, for at that
time the wind increased so much that it was necessary to haul the top-sails and
to strike topgallant masts. The next day the wind abated, but the weather
continued thick and hazy, with sleet and snow which froze on the rigging as it
fell, and ornamented the whole of it with icicles. At length the longitude in
which the looked-for cape was supposed to lie was reached, and as the ships
were far to the southward of the latitude in which Captain Bouvet stated he had
seen it, no doubt remained that he had mistaken lofty icebergs, surrounded by
loose or field ice, for land, as Captain Cook and his officers had already been
deceived on the first day they fell in with field ice.
When the weather became finer the ships were able to
fill up their water-casks with pure fresh water, by collecting masses of ice,
and then hanging them up to allow any salt which might have adhered to them to
run off. Whenever the weather permitted, the astronomers were employed in
making observations, and the naturalists in collecting birds, the only objects
they had the means of obtaining.
The antarctic circle was crossed on January 17, in
longitude 39 degrees 35 minutes East; and on the evening of that day the whole
sea to the south and west appeared covered with ice, though shortly before none
was in sight. In this space thirty-eight ice islands, great and small, were
counted, besides loose ice in abundance, so that the ships were obliged to luff
to avoid one piece, and to bear up to escape another, as they proceeded to the
south. At length a compact mass, from sixteen to eighteen feet high, appearing
to the south, without any opening, Captain Cook altered his course to the
north. A number of whales were now seen sporting about the ice, and several
flocks of antarctic petrels. The ships did not alter their course an hour too
soon, for that night a heavy gale sprang up which would have rendered their
position very dangerous. After this, search was in vain made for the land said
to have been seen by the French captain in the longitude of the Mauritius.
On February 8, during thick weather, the Adventure was
separated from the Resolution, and though, according to arrangement, Captain
Cook cruised for three days about the spot where his consort had last been
seen, and continued burning blue lights and firing guns, he was compelled at
last to give up the search. On the night of the 17th the aurora presented a
very beautiful appearance. It was first seen in the east, and, gradually
rising, formed a brilliant arch across the heavens, with a light sufficiently
strong to cast shadows on the deck, and at one time to allow a book to be read.
A description of the incidents met with during this part of the voyage would
not prove generally interesting. One, however, must not be omitted.
The Resolution being off a large ice island, round
which there was a quantity of loose ice, Captain Cook sent two boats to take
some on board. The island was not less than half a mile in circumference, and
its summit three or four hundred feet above the surface of the sea. While the
boats were thus engaged in its neighbourhood, it was seen to bend over till it
turned nearly bottom up, though it seemed by the change not to have lost either
in height or size. The boats escaped without damage from their dangerous
position.
During all the time, up to the separation of the two
ships, the crews had enjoyed generally excellent health. A few slight symptoms
of scurvy had appeared, but they were quickly subdued by a liberal use of the
remedies which had been supplied. The fresh wort made from malt seems to have
been very efficacious in arresting the malady. Occasionally, too, when the
weather allowed, the men’s bedding and clothes were spread on deck to air, and
the ship was smoked and cleaned between decks. This prevented the crews from contracting
those diseases which have proved so fatal on board ships where they have been
neglected.
At length, by the middle of March, the antarctic
summer being nearly over, and his crew requiring rest and his ship refitting,
Captain Cook shaped a course which would soon bring her into a more genial
clime. He had purposed visiting Van Diemen’s Land, but as the wind would not
allow him to shape a course for that country, he steered for New Zealand, which
was sighted on March 25. A heavy gale compelled him to keep at sea, but the
following day he entered Dusky Bay, at the south-west end of Tavai Poenammoo,
or the Middle Island, as it is now called. This was on Friday, March 26, after
having been one hundred and seventeen days at sea, and sailed over three thousand
six hundred and sixty leagues, or nearly ten thousand miles, without having
once sighted land. Only one man, and he of a naturally bad habit of body, had
been seriously ill; and Cook attributed the excellent health of his crew,
partly to the frequent airing and sweetening of the ship by fires, etcetera,
and partly to the portable broth, sweet-wort, pickled cabbage, and sour-krout.
Although no discovery, except of a negative character, was made during this
part of the voyage, we cannot but admire the hardihood and perseverance, the
skill and courage, exhibited by the great navigator during the whole of that
trying time.
A secure harbour having been found by Lieutenant
Pickersgill in Dasky Bay, where the ship could lie close to the shore, she was
warped into it and moored, her yards being locked in the branches of the trees;
there being also, a hundred yards from her stern, a fine stream of fresh water.
No place could have been better suited for refitting the ship and refreshing
the crew, and both officers and men enjoyed their stay at this healthy and
beautiful spot. Places were forthwith cleared of trees to set up the
observatory, the forge, and the tents for the sail-makers and coopers. At the captain’s
suggestion, wholesome beer was brewed from the leaves of a tree resembling the
American black spruce, mixed with the inspissated juice of wort and molasses.
The constant attention of the great navigator to the most
minute points calculated to maintain or improve the health of those
placed under his charge cannot be too strongly commended. Throughout his
journals notices constantly occur which show that whenever anti-scorbutic
vegetables, or herbs of any sort, were required, he did not entrust the search
to others, but went himself to look for them. It is sad to reflect how
indifferent to his example many other navigators have been, especially the
masters of merchantmen; and that even at the present day, notwithstanding all
the assistance which science is able to render, their crews often suffer
fearfully from scurvy.
Shooting and fishing parties now went out constantly,
and an ample supply of wild-fowl was obtained. The bay was also surveyed, and
found to contain several good harbours. Some exploring expeditions for short
distances into the exterior were also started, but very few natives were met
with. There appeared, indeed, to be only three or four families settled in the
neighbourhood, and it was not understood why they had separated themselves from
their countrymen; but it was conjectured that they were the remnant of a tribe
which, in one of the frequent native wars, had escaped massacre. Only one of
these families became intimate with the strangers, in whom they showed unusual
confidence by taking up their quarters very near to the watering-place.
These people evinced little astonishment at sight of a
few sheep and goats which, having escaped the effects of the cold, were taken
on shore, but stared at them with what appeared to be stupid insensibility; and
when various articles of European manufacture were offered to them they
received these gifts with indifference, except, indeed, hatchets and
spike-nails, the value of which they could comprehend.
After some further acquaintance, the head of this
family and his daughter were persuaded to visit the ship. Before venturing on
board, he presented to the captain a piece of cloth and a green talc hatchet;
he gave another to Mr Forster, and the girl gave one to Mr Hodges. This custom
of making presents had been found common with the natives of the South Sea
Islands, but had not before been observed among the New Zealanders. After these
propitiatory gifts were received, and before stepping on to the stage which led
to the deck, the native took a small green branch in his hand, with which he
several times struck the ship’s side, while he also repeated a speech or
prayer. When this ceremony was concluded he stepped on deck.
On taking leave of this New Zealander, Captain Cook
was presented by him with another piece of native cloth, with the expression of
a wish for a cloak in return. One of red baize was accordingly given to him,
and seemed to afford great satisfaction. Thus far, therefore, on this visit,
intercourse with these aborigines of the new country was pleasant and
successful.
Other natives were afterwards seen by some of the
explorers, who were on a shooting expedition. These set up a hideous noise, and
were with difficulty persuaded to approach and lay down their spears. At last
one of them came forward, with a plant in his hand, one end of which he
presented to Captain Cook, while he himself held the other. He then began a
long speech with frequent pauses, and as soon as the captain replied—of course,
not understanding a word that was said—the savage proceeded in his harangue.
This done, he took off his cloak, which he put on the captain’s shoulders, and
seemed to consider that their peace was established. The natives followed the
English to the boat, and seeing some muskets lying across the stern, desired
them to be taken away, having probably observed their effects on the wild
ducks. They then assisted to launch the boat, but it was necessary to keep a
watchful eye on them, for they wanted to take away everything in the boat on
which they could lay hands. No canoes were observed belonging to these people,
two or three logs of wood tied together serving them for crossing rivers;
indeed, fish and fowl were so plentiful that they had not far to go in order to
procure food.
In accordance with Cook’s desire to benefit the
countries he visited, he took five geese which he had brought from the Cape of
Good Hope, and left them in a retired cove (which was on that account called
Goose Cove), in hope that they might there multiply and be useful to future
inhabitants. A garden was also dug, and, with the same object in view, various
sorts of garden seeds were sown in it.
On April 28, the tents and other articles being taken
on board, the Resolution once more got under way, though, owing to light and
contrary winds, it was not till May 11 that she was fairly at sea. She then
proceeded along the west coast, towards Queen Charlotte’s Sound, in Cook’s
Straits, between the two islands. Nothing of importance occurred till the ship
was about three leagues to the westward of Cape Stephens, when just as it fell
calm six waterspouts appeared round her, four between her and the land, and one
outside; the sixth in the south-west, two or three miles off. Progressing in a
crooked line to the north-east, it passed within fifty yards of her stern. A
gun had been got ready to fire into it when it should come nearer. The diameter
of the base was about sixty feet, the sea within which was much agitated, and
foamed up to great height. From this the water appeared to be carried in a spiral
stream up to the clouds. Some of the seamen said that they saw a bird in it,
which was whirled round like the fly of a jack. During the time the waterspouts
were in sight there were light puffs of wind from all points of the compass,
while occasionally large drops of rain fell.
On the 18th the Resolution appeared off Queen
Charlotte’s Sound, where, greatly to the satisfaction of all on board, her
consort, the Adventure, was found to be awaiting her.
Her boats soon came out, and the Resolution was brought to an anchor in Ship
Cove, close to her. Captain Furneaux at once came on board, and gave Captain
Cook a narrative of his proceedings after being separated from him. Having in
vain looked-for the Resolution, he bore away to the north, till Van Diemen’s Land
was sighted. He sailed along the east coast for some distance, some parts of
which appeared fertile and thickly populated. The Adventure lay within Maria Island for five days, to take in wood and water, and then
proceeded to the north along shore. For some distance no land was seen, but as
the soundings were very regular, Captain Furneaux was of opinion that no
straits existed between New Holland and Van Diemen’s Land, but only a very deep
bay. Having come to this erroneous opinion, he bore away for New Zealand, and
had been five weeks in Ship Cove when the Resolution appeared. He had kept up a
friendly intercourse with the natives, who frequently asked for Tupia, and
seemed much concerned when told that he was dead.
While at Queen Charlotte’s Sound Captain Cook had a
garden planted, as before, and gave the natives some potatoes, explaining their
use and the mode of cultivating them. A pair of goats and a
boar and two sows were put on shore, in the hopes of their multiplying.
A ewe and ram, which had been brought with great trouble and care to the place,
were also landed, but the following day were found
dead, from having eaten some poisonous plant.
An idea had prevailed on board the Adventure that the
natives were ready to sell their children. This Captain Cook soon proved to be
incorrect. Their object in bringing them on board was to obtain presents for
them. A man brought his son, a boy of about ten years of age, and at first
Captain Cook fancied from what he had heard that the object of the father was to
sell him, but he soon found that it was merely to obtain a white shirt, which
was given. The boy was so proud of it that he went about showing it to
everybody he met, till he encountered old Will, the goat, who, making a butt at
him, knocked him over in some dirt, sadly soiling his shirt. The boy considered
the mischief irreparable, and was afraid of appearing before his father. At
last he was brought in by Mr Forster, when he told a lamentable story against
the great “dog”—nor was he comforted till his shirt was washed and dried.
Captain Cook justly remarks in his journal that this incident shows how easily
people can be deceived, when ignorant of the language, as to the customs and
habits of the natives of foreign countries.
While these friendly natives were on board, a strange
canoe full of people entered the harbour. The natives on seeing them said they
were enemies, and two of them mounted the arm chests on the poop, one armed
with a native hatchet, and the other with a spear, and, in bravado, bade their enemies defiance. The rest who were
on board, jumping into their canoe, went on shore, probably to secure their
women and children. The two who remained begged Captain Cook
to fire at the strangers. The latter, however, came on board, apparently
without having had any evil intentions, and peace was soon established among
all parties. The strangers at once asked for Tupia, and hearing that he was
dead, one or two expressed their sorrow in a way which appeared more formal
than real.
A brisk trade was soon established with the newcomers;
but the thoughtless seamen were so ready to give even the clothes off their
backs for the merest trifles, neither useful nor ornamental, that the captain
was compelled to dismiss the strangers. He afterwards crossed the harbour with
Mr Forster and one of the officers to a spot where a hundred natives—men,
women, and children—were collected, with six canoes, and apparently all their
utensils. These they seem always to carry with them when they go even a short
distance from home, lest they should be stolen by their enemies in their
absence.
The state of constant warfare and consequent distrust
in which they lived, especially in the Middle Island, was very evident, for
they were generally found on their guard, travelling or working with their
weapons in their hands; even the women were seen occasionally armed with
spears. Captain Cook had reason to believe that the entire population of the
Sound had changed since he was there in 1770, as he could not recognise the
face of a single person he then knew. Those who asked for Tupia had possibly
not seen him, but had only heard of him from their countrymen, among whom he
was very popular. The immorality of the natives met with during their visit to
New Zealand appears to have been very flagrant, and it is sad to reflect that
advantage was taken of it by the seamen, without the slightest rebuke or
censure from their superiors; indeed, it cannot be discovered from the journals
of the officers that they were at all aware of their duties as a Christian
people with regard to heathen savages whose shores they visited.
The king’s birthday was spent with the usual
festivities, the officers of the two ships dining together.
On June 7, 1773, the two ships put out to sea, with
the intention of exploring all the unknown parts of the ocean between the
meridian of New Zealand and Cape Horn. In case of separation they were to
rendezvous at Otaheite, where Captain Furneaux was to wait till August 20, and
then to proceed to Queen Charlotte’s Sound. If not joined at that place before
November 20 by Captain Cook, he was to put to sea, and carry out the
instructions he had received from the Admiralty. Cook’s object in attempting to
explore in so high a latitude during the winter season
was to get some of the work done which would otherwise have occupied the
precious months of summer; and besides, he wished to show future navigators
that it would be practicable to make discoveries even in the depths of winter.
After leaving New Zealand, the course steered was generally
about north-east, so that the ships soon got into a warm latitude, and the men once more put on their cool clothing. Sad news was
brought on board the Resolution at this time, June 29. It was that scurvy had
broken out on board the Adventure; that her cook had died, and that twenty men
were ill with that complaint and the flux. The Resolution had only three men on
the sick-list, and but one of these had the scurvy. A few others, showing
symptoms of it, were supplied with wort, marmalade of carrots, and thickened
juice of lemons. It appeared that the crew of the Adventure, during the six
weeks they were in Queen Charlotte’s Sound, had eaten no vegetables, partly
from not knowing what herbs to gather, and also from the inveterate dislike of
the seamen to a new diet. Captain Cook had, from the first, when he thought it
necessary, insisted on having wild celery, scurvy grass, and other herbs boiled
with the pease and wheat, both for officers and men; and though some refused to
eat it, he was firm, and would allow no other food to be served out, so that at
last the prejudice wore off. Captain Furneaux instantly made use of all the
remedies in his power, and his people improved in health. Still it was
necessary for their sakes to put into harbour where vegetables could be
procured, and a course was accordingly steered for Otaheite.
Several small low islands, clothed with cocoanut
trees, were seen, but the necessity of reaching a harbour without delay
prevented their examination.
On August 15, Osnaburg Island, or Maitea, was seen,
and the ships then steered for Oaiti-piha Bay, near the south-east end of
Otaheite, in order to procure there such refreshments as the place could
afford.
At daybreak they found themselves not half a league
from a reef, towards which the scud of the sea rapidly sent them, the wind
having completely fallen. The depth was too great to anchor, and the boats
failed to tow the ships off. A number of natives came off with provisions, but
seemed totally unconscious of the dangerous position of the ships. It was
curious that, though they recognised Captain Cook and those who had been there
before, no one asked for Tupia.
The position of the ships became more and more
critical; the captain had hoped to get round the end of the reef, but as they
drew nearer and nearer this hope vanished, and shipwreck seemed certain. Just
then a passage was discovered through the reef, but a boat being sent ahead to
sound, it was found that there was not water sufficient for the ships to pass
over: indeed, so strongly did the flood-tide set towards it, that the
Resolution seemed nearer than ever to destruction. The horrors of shipwreck
stared the explorers in the face; there was no wind to fill their sails; the
boats were powerless; the only means of saving the ships was to anchor; but
would the anchors hold? They were let go, and the Resolution was brought up in
less than three-fathom water, striking at every fall of the sea, while the
Adventure brought up close on her bow without striking. Kedge anchors and
hawsers were now carried out, and found ground; by hauling on these the ship
was got afloat, but there was a fear that these would come home or be cut by
the rocks, and nothing could then have saved the Resolution. Happily, they held
on till the tide turned, when a light breeze coming off the land both vessels
made sail, and got out of danger, though with the loss of several anchors and
cables.
The next day the ships anchored in Oaiti-piha Bay,
about two cables’ length from the shore. Both ships were crowded with natives,
who brought off cocoanuts, plantains, bananas, apples, yams, and other fruits
and vegetables, which they exchanged for nails and beads. Presents of shirts
and axes were made to several who called themselves chiefs, or earees,
and who promised to bring off hogs and fowls, which, however, they did not do.
These earees did not scruple to pilfer whatever came in their way, and one of
them, who pretended to be very friendly, was found handing articles which did
not belong to him out of the quarter-galley. As his companions on deck were
behaving in the same way, they were all turned out of the ship, and two muskets
were fired over the head of the chief offender to frighten him. On this, he
jumped out of his canoe, which, with two others, was brought on board, and a
gun was fired along shore, but so as not to hurt any one. This soon cleared the
coast. In one of the canoes was a little boy, who was at first very much
frightened, but beads were given to him, and he was sent in safety on shore.
This quickly restored the confidence of the natives, and all by the evening
were again good friends.
The intercourse with the natives now went on with
tolerable smoothness, though their thieving propensities frequently nearly
brought about a rupture. On one occasion, in Captain Cook’s presence, a native
seized the musket of one of the guards on shore, and made off with it. Some of
the seamen were sent after him, but he would have escaped had not the natives
also given chase, knocked down the thief, and brought back the musket. Although
fear may possibly have operated on this occasion with the natives more than a
sense of justice, Captain Cook was thankful to them, because he would certainly
have lost ten times the value of the weapon in endeavouring to recover it by
force.
The following day a thief brought on board a quantity
of fruit as a present, among which were a number of cocoanuts, which, after the
juice had been extracted, had been thrown away by the seamen. These had been so
artfully tied up in bundles that at first the cheat was not perceived. The
chief did not seem at all ashamed when the trick was discovered, but having
opened a few himself, acknowledged that they were empty. On going on shore,
however, he sent off a quantity of plantains and bananas.
A supply of water, fruit, and roots having been got on
board, Captain Cook was preparing to sail for Matavai, when it was announced
that Waheatoua was coming to meet him. He found the young chief seated in the
open air on a stool, surrounded by a large number of attendants, and at once
recollected him, having known him when a boy, under the name of Tearee. He had,
on the death of his father, Waheatoua, taken his name. The chief begged Captain
Cook to remain some months, promising hogs and provisions of all sorts. He insisted
on keeping the captain by his side, and whenever they moved about the stool was
carried after them, that they might again be seated in the same position.
Before the ships had come to an anchor in Matavai Bay,
the decks were covered with natives, many of whom Captain Cook recognised. The
king, Otoo, was among those on board, but he took fright without any apparent
reason, and landed again. The next day an encampment was made on shore for the
sail-makers, coopers, and the sick. This done, Captain Cook, accompanied by
Captain Furneaux, Mr Forster, and others, set off to visit Otoo. He was found
seated on the ground, under the shade of a tree, with a large crowd round him,
all standing uncovered, as a mark of respect; that is, not only their heads
bare, but their shoulders, and some wore no clothing above the breast—his
father not excepted. Presents were made by Captain Cook, and the king was told
that they were given in friendship, and that none would be received in return.
The king inquired for Tupia, and for all the officers who were on board the
Endeavour on the former voyage. Otoo, though a fine tall young man, was very
nervous, and acknowledged that he had left the ship because he was afraid of
the guns. On the 27th, however, he came to the camp with a large retinue,
having first sent on board a quantity of cloth, fruits, a hog, and two large
fish. He, a sister and younger brother, with several attendants, were persuaded
to visit the ship, and all received presents, Captain Cook afterwards taking
them to their home at Oparree in his boat.
On landing, the captain met a venerable old lady, the
mother of Toutaha. She seized him by the hands, and bursting into tears,
exclaimed, “Toutaha, the friend of Cook, is dead!” Captain Cook says that he
was so much affected that he should have wept also had not Otoo drawn him away.
Captain Furneaux made the king a present of a male and female goat, in the hope
that they might stock the island.
On another occasion, when Otoo came on board, as he
entered the cabin several chiefs who were there immediately uncovered their
shoulders, although they did not rise or show him any other mark of respect. He
was entertained with the bagpipes, which seemed to have especial charms for the
natives. The seamen also danced hornpipes and country dances. In return, the
king entertained the voyagers with a dramatic performance, in which his sister
took a part. The drama seemed to have reference to the circumstances of the
time, as Captain Cook’s name was frequently mentioned. The lady’s dress was
very elegant, being decorated with long tassels made of feathers, hanging from
the waist downwards. The performance lasted about two hours. So far as the
disposition of the natives was concerned, the visit seems to have been
satisfactory, though fewer hogs were obtained than were required. Mr
Pickersgill was sent about in all directions to obtain them, and in one of his
expeditions he saw Oberea, once the person of most importance in the island.
She had now become old, poor, and of little consequence.
Otoo was very unwilling that the ships should go, and
shed tears when he parted from Captain Cook. A young lad, called Boreo, was
taken on board the Resolution. Though he seemed tolerably satisfied, he could
not help weeping as he saw his native island left astern. Two days afterwards
the ships anchored in the harbour of Owharre, in the island of Huaheine. The
two captains, on landing, were received with the greatest cordiality by the
natives, who, after a few presents had been distributed amongst them, brought
hogs, fowls, dogs, and fruit, which they exchanged for hatchets, nails, and
beads; indeed, there seemed every prospect of an abundance of provisions being
obtained. The chief, Oree, who had, on Cook’s former visit, exchanged names
with him, was still living, and sent word that he was hastening to see him.
Before, however, the captain was allowed to leave his boat, five young plantain
trees—the emblem of peace employed by the natives—were brought on board separately, and with some ceremony. Three young pigs, their
ears ornamented with cocoanut fibre, accompanied the first three, and a dog the
fourth. Lastly, the chief sent the inscription engraved on a piece of pewter
which had been left with him in July 1769.
This ceremony ended, the guide who had come to conduct
the English to the shore requested them to decorate three young plantain trees
with looking-glasses, nails, medals, and beads. This being done, they landed
with the trees in their hands, and were conducted to the chief through a
multitude of people, who made a lane for them to pass. They were then made to
sit down a few paces from the chief, and the plantains were taken from them.
One was for their god, one for the king, and the third for friendship. Captain
Cook then wished to advance to the king, but he was told that the king would
come to him, which he did, falling on his neck and embracing him; the tears
flowing down his venerable cheeks, showing the affectionate feelings of his
heart. His friends were then introduced, and presents were made to them. Cook
speaks in the most affectionate terms of Oree; indeed, all his actions showed
him to have been an upright, kind-hearted man.
The trading expeditions sent out were so successful
that three hundred hogs, besides fowls and vegetables of all sorts, were
obtained. It was from this island that Captain Furneaux received on board a
young man, named Omai, a native of Ulietea, where he had some property, of
which he had been dispossessed by the people of Bolabola. Omai was not a chief,
and he was so inferior in figure, complexion, and manners to the chiefs, that
Captain Cook was surprised that Captain Furneaux should have selected him. He
was not, indeed, a favourable sample of the natives of the Pacific Isles as far
as appearance went. Ultimately, however, Omai, by his intelligence and good
conduct, won the regard of Captain Cook, who afterwards, in his journal, speaks
of him in warm terms of commendation.
Here, as elsewhere, there were thieves and rogues. Mr
Sparrman was attacked while wandering in the woods, beaten, and robbed of his
clothes and hanger. Oree, on hearing of it, shed tears, and set off in person
to recover the clothes, most of which he got back. Altogether, however, the
chief and his subjects were among the best disposed of all the people visited
during the voyage. He came on board the Resolution as she was leaving the
harbour, and did not quit her till he had taken an affectionate farewell of
Captain Cook, when nearly half a league out at sea. He then went away in a
small canoe, paddled by himself and another man, all the other natives having
long before left the ship.
The following morning the ships entered the harbour of
Ohamaneno, in the island of Ulietea, where they lay safely moored. The ships
were at once surrounded with canoes, and hogs and vegetables were offered in
abundance. At first, none of the former would be taken, as the ships were
already crowded; but as killing and salting went on, room was made for them;
and, in all, four hundred and fifty hogs were collected at this island. Most of
them were brought in canoes from different directions to the ship, so that
there was very little trading on shore. It was in consequence of the exertions
made by Captain Cook in collecting provisions, and the judicious means he
employed, that he was able to remain away from home so many years, and to make
so many important discoveries.
The chief of that part of the island was Oreo. Captain
Cook paid him a visit at his own house, and was cordially received. He, as
others had done, inquired after Tupia and the captain’s companions on his
former voyage, by name. A play was soon got up—the chiefs daughter and seven
men being the actors. The plot was as follows:—A theft
was committed in a masterly manner, but discovered before the thief had time to
carry off his plunder. He and his accomplice were attacked by those who had
charge of it; but the latter were beaten off, and the rogues escaped in
triumph. This incident gives a notion of the moral character of the people in
that respect. On another occasion Oreo entertained the strangers with a feast,
in the native fashion. The floor was strewed thick with leaves, on which hot
bread, fruit, and plantains were placed, with two pigs roasted whole—one of
about sixty, the other thirty pounds. They were admirably dressed, having been
baked in the native underground ovens, all parts being equally cooked.
Cocoanuts supplied the beverage, but the visitors had brought some bottles of
wine, which the chief seemed to like, as he both then and always filled his
glass whenever the bottle came to him, but seemed not to be affected by it.
Plays were got up every day for the amusement of the strangers; indeed, the
natives seemed anxious in every way to please them. The people of this island
appeared to be of a mild, amiable, and timid disposition.
A native lad about eighteen years of age, called
Oedidee, joined the Resolution at this island, in the place of Boreo, who,
falling in love with a damsel he met with, remained
that he might marry her. Oedidee was a native of Bolabola, and a near relation
of the great Opoony, chief of that island.
On this his second visit to these islands, Captain
Cook, knowing more of the language of the people, was able to gain a better
insight into their habits and customs. Among other points, he discovered,
without doubt, that human sacrifices were frequently offered up at their
morais. At first the natives would only acknowledge that criminals were killed,
but afterwards they confessed that any whom the priest chose to denounce were
offered up. Thus, a priest who had a dislike to a man might at any moment doom
him to death by pronouncing him a bad man. He then sent out his executioners,
who, with a couple of blows from their heavy clubs, struck the unsuspecting
victim dead at their feet. The corpse was forthwith carried to the morais, when
the chief, who was compelled to attend such sacrifices, had the eye offered to
him to eat! At some of the islands, the inhabitants of which Captain Cook
describes as the most happy on earth, the priests held this terrific power to a
fearful extent. At the time of his thus writing he was not aware of the fact
which is so strikingly illustrative of the declaration of holy writ, that “the
dark places of the earth are full of the habitations of cruelty.”
On September 17, 1773, the ships were again at sea. It
was the intention of Captain Cook to get into the latitude of Middleburg and
Amsterdam, in order to touch there before hauling up for New Zealand. At night
they generally lay to, lest any land might be passed in the dark. Some small
islets clothed with cocoanut trees were passed on the 23rd, and named Hervey’s
Islands, but no inhabitants were seen on shore.
Middleburg was reached on October 1, and the following
day, as the ships were beating up to an anchorage, two canoes came boldly off
to them. Directly the anchors were dropped, the ships were surrounded by
canoes, bringing cloth and other curiosities. Among the people who came on
board was a chief, whose good services were secured by the present of a
hatchet, spike-nails, and other articles. His name was Tioony. He piloted the
boats to a place where the landing was very easy, and where a large concourse
of people were assembled to receive them with commodities, which they pressed
on their visitors, scarcely expecting to receive anything in return. At last,
the chief, making the people open right and left, conducted his visitors to his
house, which was delightfully situated about three hundred yards from the sea,
at the head of a fine lawn under the shade of some shaddock trees. The floor
was covered with mats, on which the guests were invited to be seated, the
people arranging themselves on the ground in a circle outside. The piper having
landed, Captain Cook ordered the bagpipes to be played, and, in return, three
young women sang with a very good grace. A present being made to each of these,
all the other women commenced singing. Their songs were musical and harmonious,
and in no way harsh or disagreeable. The chief had another house in an
adjoining plantation, to which his guests were conducted, and where they were
entertained with bananas and cocoanuts, and bowls of cava; though, on
witnessing the mode of preparing that beverage, the thirst of the visitors was
sufficiently quenched. They were seated in an open space in front of the house,
which was surrounded with fruit and other trees, whose fragrance filled the
air.
The chief, Tioony, went on board and dined, and then,
at their request, conducted the strangers through part of the island. There
were numerous plantations of fir trees and edible roots, laid out with great judgment, and enclosed with neat fences made of reeds. The ships
were crowded the whole day with people trafficking, and perfect good order
prevailed. In the evening, on the return of the officers on board, they
expressed themselves highly delighted with the country and the very obliging
behaviour of the inhabitants, who seemed to vie with each other in doing what
they thought would please their visitors.
The group of islands, at one of which the ships now
were, was called the Tonga Islands; but Cook, from the treatment he received,
named them the Friendly Islands, by which name they are now generally known.
Tasman, who discovered them in 1642-3, named the two principal islands
Amsterdam and Middleburg. The former is called by the natives Tongatabu, or the
Great Tonga; the latter Ea-oo-we. There are other volcanic islands to the
north, belonging to the group, not then known.
Leaving Ea-oo-we, or Middleburg, the ships ran down to
Tongatabu, keeping about half a mile from the shore, on which the sea broke
with a heavy surf. With the aid of glasses it was seen that every part of the
shore was laid out in plantations, while the natives were observed running
along the shore waving small white flags, which were, of course, looked on as
an emblem of peace. They were answered by hoisting a Saint George’s ensign.
Several canoes paddled alongside, and the people in them, after presenting the
cava root, came boldly on board. The ships anchored in Van Diemen’s Road, just
outside the breakers, with a casting-anchor and cable to seaward in
forty-seven-fathom water, to prevent them from tailing on the rocks. Their
decks were quickly crowded with natives, who brought off only native cloths,
for which the seamen too readily gave them clothes. To put a stop to this
proceeding, Captain Cook ordered that no sort of curiosities should be
purchased by any person whatever. The good effect of this order was visible
next morning, when, instead of comparatively useless articles, the natives
brought off bananas and cocoanuts in abundance, and some pigs and fowls.
Proper arrangements having been made for conducting
the trade, the captains landed under the guidance of a chief, Attago, who had
at once singled out Captain Cook as the principal person, and offered him the
usual presents. Cook and Attago also exchanged names, the custom of so doing
being practised at the Friendly as well as at the Society Islands. The friendly
chief pointed out a creek into which the boats could run, and on landing the
visitors were seated under the shade of a tree, the people forming a circle
round them; but no one attempted to push forward, as was the habit of the
Otaheiteans. The officers then begged Attago to show them the country. This,
without hesitation, he at once signified his readiness to do.
The first visit was paid to a sort of temple in an
open green, raised on the top of an artificial mound, about seventeen feet
above the level ground. The mound was of an oblong form, enclosed by a wall,
and the building, which differed little from the ordinary dwelling-houses of
the people, was of the same shape. On approaching this temple the people seated
themselves on the grass, about fifty yards off, when three venerable-looking
priests appeared and addressed the strangers, with whom, as soon as their
speech was finished, they came and sat down, when some presents were made to
them. After this, Attago signified that the strangers were welcome to examine
the temple. In the interior were some images, but when Cook inquired if they
were Etuas, or gods, Attago kicked them over without any ceremony, to show that
he did not look upon them with reverence. Neither Omai nor Oedidee understood
the language spoken by the natives of Tonga, consequently it was difficult to ascertain the exact object of the building.
It appears extraordinary to us at the present day, and
it is painful to narrate, that Captain Cook should have conceived it right, as
he said he did, to make an offering at the altar. He and his companions,
therefore, laid down some blue pebbles, coins, nails, and other articles, as
presents to the gods of these poor heathens. Unhappily, this proceeding was in
accordance with the customs of our countrymen, and even of the English
Government in India, who, to a much later period, furnished a money grant to
the temple of Juggernaut (one of the principal gods of the Hindoos), and it was
only in comparatively modern times that this disgraceful grant was
discontinued. In the present instance, however, it did not appear that these
offerings were looked upon as particularly sacred, as the chief, Attago, took
them up, and placing them in the folds of his dress, appropriated them to
himself.
The green in which this temple stood was at the
junction of several roads, two or three of which were very much frequented. The
high road along which the chief led the strangers was perfectly level, and
sixteen feet broad; many others led into it, and all were enclosed on each side
with neat fences made of reeds, and shaded from the scorching sun by fruit
trees. Not an inch of ground was waste; the roads occupied no more space than
was necessary, while the fences did not take up above four inches on each side,
and even this was not wholly lost, for many of them were composed of useful
trees or shrubs. Numbers of people were met, some travelling down to the ships
with their burdens of fruits and other articles for barter. All
courteously got out of the road, sitting down or standing with their backs to
the fences as their visitors passed.
At most of the cross roads the temples just described
were seen standing on mounds, but were surrounded by palisades instead of stone
walls. After walking several miles a larger temple than usual was reached, and
near it was a house, at which the party stopped, and were treated with fruit
and other provisions, while an old priest made a long speech. These temples at
the cross roads remind us of the shrines set up to legendary saints in Roman
Catholic countries.
The party returned on board with Attago, and while at
dinner they received a visit from an old chief of superior rank, in whose
presence the former would not sit down or eat. As soon, however, as the old man
was gone, Attago took his place, finished his dinner, and drank two glasses of
wine.
Here, as at most places, the natives of inferior rank
showed a disposition to thieve. Poor Mr Wales was found seated on the shore,
unable to move, for having, when landing, in order to wade to the shore, taken
off his shoes and stockings, a native had run off with them, and it was
impossible for him to follow over the sharp coral rocks. Attago, however, soon
discovered the thief, and had the stolen garments returned. On two or three
other occasions the boats were pillaged, and a man, having run off with a
seaman’s jacket, though hotly pursued and fired at, would not abandon his prize
till intercepted by some of the English on shore. A native also got into the
master’s cabin, and had stolen some articles, when, as he was leaping through
the port into his canoe to escape, he was discovered. He was pursued by one of
the boats, when, taking to the water, he dived under her several times, just as
the men thought they were about to catch hold of him. Finally, he contrived to
unship the rudder, and thus rendering the boat unmanageable, made his escape.
Just as the explorers were about to sail, it was
discovered that there was a much greater person in the island than any one they
had yet seen. Mr Pickersgill, who had met him, said that the people paid him extraordinary
respect; that some, when they approached him, fell on their faces, and put
their heads between their feet, and that no one presumed to pass him without
permission. When, however, Captain Cook saw the monarch, he took him for an
idiot, from his stolid or sullen manner. On being spoken to, he neither
answered nor altered a feature of his countenance, and even when a shirt was
put on him, and other articles were placed by his side, he neither lifted an
arm of his own accord, nor put out his hand to receive them. Probably, however,
this manner was assumed, as adding, in his opinion, to his dignity, as he was
afterwards caught laughing at something Attago said to him.
During the whole time of their stay at this island,
Attago had proved himself of great use to Captain Cook and his companions. He
had presented himself on board the captain’s ship every morning, and did not
quit his side till dark. On the departure of the ships he earnestly pressed the
captain to return, and to bring cloth and axes, promising hogs, fowls, fruit,
and roots in abundance. He asked also, for himself, a uniform similar to that
worn by the captain. Among other presents made by Cook to this friendly chief
were two dogs, as there were none at that time in the island; indeed, pigs
appear to have been the only four-footed animals in the possession of the
inhabitants, although they knew of the existence of dogs. Besides fowls, there
were pigeons, doves, parrots, and other birds. The whole island was thoroughly cultivated, and produced bread-fruit, cocoanut trees,
plantains, bananas, shaddocks, yams, and other roots, the sugar-cane, and a
fruit like a nectarine. The roads also were so well laid out that there was an
easy communication from one part of the island to the other in every direction.
There were no towns or villages, but most of the houses stood in the midst of
plantations. They were neatly constructed, but not much superior to those of
the Society Islands. The floor, however, was slightly raised, and covered with
thick mats; the same sort of matting serving to enclose them on the weather
side, while on the opposite they were left open.
The ingenuity of this people was more especially
exhibited in the construction of their canoes, which were superior to any that
had been seen in the Pacific, though their tools were made of stone, bone, or
shells, like those of the other islanders. The canoes are built of several
pieces, sewed together in so neat a manner that on the outside no join could be
seen. They were of two kinds, double and single. The single were from twenty to
thirty feet long, and twenty-two inches broad in the middle, with wedge-shaped
heads and sterns, and decked over at both ends, leaving only a third part open.
They had outriggers, and some few carried sails, but were generally impelled by
short paddles, the blades of which were broadest in the middle. The double
canoes were composed of two vessels, each from sixty to seventy feet long, and
four or five broad in the middle, and sharp at each end. They were fastened
together by strong beams placed across their gunwales, which were raised for
that purpose, and they were kept about seven feet apart. A platform of boards
was placed on these beams, and served as a deck. They were very strongly built,
and as the canoes themselves were also decked over, they might be immersed to
the very platform without sinking. On the platform was a hut, serving as a
cabin for the crew, and there was a hatchway through the platform into the
hulls by which the water was baled out. The canoes also carried, as a movable
fire-hearth, a square, shallow trough of wood, filled with stones. They were
rigged with one mast, which could be easily lowered, and had a lateen sail of
matting, stretched on a long, slightly-bent yard, which could be quickly
shifted round when beating to windward. These vessels were capable of making
long voyages, and the Tonga islanders were in the habit of going to Fejee,
where they built canoes for the natives, and had probably extended their
voyages to the Navigators’ Group, and possibly to New Zealand itself. Indeed,
when these vessels are seen, there is no difficulty in understanding the means
by which so large a number of the islands of the Pacific have been peopled by
the same race, some retaining a portion of the civilisation their ancestors
possessed, others losing it altogether.
The natives of Tonga were slightly tattooed, and their
natural complexion was of a light copper colour. The size of both men and women
was that of ordinary Europeans. The dress of both sexes consisted of a piece of
cloth or matting, wrapped round the waist and hanging below the knees, while
their shoulders and arms were uncovered, and usually anointed. They wore their
hair short, and had ornaments in the form of necklaces, bracelets, and
finger-rings, made of bone, shells, or mother-of-pearl. Their cloth was of the
same material as that of Otaheite, but coarser and more durable, because glazed
so as to resist the rain. They used vegetable dyes of various colours—brown,
purple, yellow, red, and black. Their baskets, made of the same material as
their mats, were very beautiful. They had different kinds of musical
instruments: one of these was a sort of flute, which was made resonant by the
breath of the nostril; another was similar to Pandean pipes, and composed of
reeds; and a third was a drum made out of a heavy log. Their mode of saluting
was like that of the New Zealanders, by rubbing noses together; and when
anything was presented to them, they put it on their heads as a sign of its
being accepted.
The government of the country was vested in a great
chief or king, called the Areeke; and there were other chiefs under him, as
governors of districts. It seemed pretty evident to the voyagers that the land
of the island was apportioned among certain dignitaries, for whom the rest of
the community worked, either as free labourers or slaves. When purchases were made
by the English, although the collected goods were brought to market by a number
of natives, one person uniformly received payment, and no bargain was struck
without his consent.
Captain Cook was unable to obtain information
respecting the religion of the people, excepting that he saw their temples and
tombs in his excursions through the island. It was observed, however, that
nearly all the adults had lost the little finger of one hand, some of both
hands, and it was conjectured that the amputation was made at the death of
parents or other relations. The people also burnt incisions in their cheeks,
near the cheek-bone, probably also as a sign of mourning for the dead.
The expedition sailed from Tongatabu on October 7,
Captain Cook’s last act being to send off by a canoe, to his friend Attago,
some wheat, peas, and beans, which he had neglected to give him with other
seeds. A course was then shaped for Queen Charlotte’s Sound, in New Zealand,
there to take in wood and water; the commander intending afterwards to continue
his discoveries to the south and east. The next day the lofty island of
Pilstart was seen. It lies thirty-two leagues south by
west from the south end of Eua. On the 21st the north end of New Zealand was
made, and the ships ran down the east coast for the purpose of communicating
with the natives, Captain Cook being very anxious to give them seeds and animals with which to stock the country. He had, however, no
opportunity of doing this till he reached Cape Kidnappers, when a canoe came
off with two men, who, by their dress and behaviour, appeared to be chiefs. To
the principal of these, pigs, fowls, seeds, and roots were given, and a promise
exacted that he would not kill the animals. He seemed more delighted with a
long spike-nail which was offered him than with the animals. It was evident
that the people on the coast had not forgotten what occurred on the previous
voyage, as the first words they uttered on coming on board were, “We are afraid
of the guns;” yet they seemed to understand that if they behaved properly they
would be well treated.
Soon after this a heavy gale sprang up, which lasted
several days. During its continuance the Adventure was separated from the
Resolution, and no more was seen or heard of her during the remainder of the
voyage. The stormy weather continued for some time, and the Resolution had all
her sails split before she at length came to an anchor in an inlet discovered
on the east side of Cape Teerawhitte. While she lay at anchor, some natives
came off who were tempted on board with the offer of nails, which they highly
valued. To one of the men two cocks and two hens were given, but it was feared
from his manner, on receiving the present, that he would not take proper care
of them.
The next day, the gale having abated, the Resolution
proceeded to Ship Cove, in Queen Charlotte’s Sound. Here the sails were unbent
to be repaired, and tents were set up on shore. It was now discovered that the
bread, which was in casks, was greatly damaged. It was therefore examined, the
copper oven was set up, and the better portions re-baked. The natives at once
visited the ship, several of whom Captain Cook remembered, especially an old
man, Goubiah by name. Some of them appropriated whatever they could find on
shore unguarded, and, among other things, a seaman’s bag of clothes. These
were, however, recovered by the captain, who made, he says, a “friendly
application for them,” a mode of proceeding which,
with a due exhibition of power, might possibly have succeeded on other
occasions under similar circumstances. The youngest of
the two sows which Captain Furneaux had put on shore in Cannibal Cove was seen
with these people, but lame of a leg and very tame. It was said that the other
had been killed, but this was afterwards found not to be the case. The people
proved to be adepts in thieving, and one chief, pretending to keep his
countrymen at a proper distance, with furious actions, was discovered putting a
handkerchief into his bosom which he had just picked out of Captain Cook’s pocket.
A fresh party, after bartering fish for cloth very fairly, stole six small
water-casks, and then made off in a fright, leaving a boar, which had been
given them, and some of their own dogs. It is pleasant to have to describe the
persevering endeavours of Captain Cook to stock the country with animals likely
to prove useful to the inhabitants, little thinking how largely his own
countrymen would benefit by his labours, and that, before a century would have
passed by, vast flocks of sheep, and horned cattle, and horses would be feeding
on the widely extended pastures of those fertile islands.
Before sailing, when at length one day his visitors
had left him, he took on shore three sows and a boar, two cocks and two hens,
carrying them some little way into the woods, where they were left with a
supply of food to last them for ten or twelve days. The food
was left that the animals might remain in the woods, and not roam down
to the shore, where they might be discovered by the natives. Some cocks and
hens were also left in Ship Cove, but as the natives occasionally went there,
there was a risk of the birds falling into their hands. Two more goats were
landed, but the he-goat was seized with a sort of fit, and was supposed to have
rushed into the sea and been drowned, as his mate, who followed him when he
started off on his mad career, came back without him. The vegetables which had
been planted on the former visit had thriven, and most of the potatoes had been
dug up.
All the time of the ship’s stay a friendly intercourse
was kept up with the natives. The best way of securing peace with savages,
Captain Cook observes, is by first convincing them of your superiority, and
then by being always on your guard. A regard for their own safety will then
prevent them from being unanimous in forming any plan to attack you, while
strict honesty and kindly treatment will gain their friendship. These
principles mainly guided the great navigator in his intercourse with the
savages he visited, and it was owing to this that he was so long able to pursue
his useful discoveries.
He had ample evidence on this occasion of the savage
character of the people by whom he was surrounded. A party of them had gone
away on a war expedition, and returned with the body of a youth whom they had
killed. Most of the body had been eaten, when one of the officers brought the
head and a portion of the flesh on board. This latter was boiled and eaten by
one of the natives with avidity, in the presence of Captain Cook and most of
the officers and ship’s company. This horrid proceeding had such an effect on
some of the men, as well as on the captain, as to make them sick. It had a still greater effect on the native of
Otaheite, Oedidee. He at first became perfectly motionless, and looked the
personification of horror. When aroused from this state he burst into tears,
and continued to weep and scold by turns, telling the New Zealanders that they
were vile men, and that he would no longer be their friend. He would not suffer
them to touch him. He used the same language to one of the crew who tasted the
flesh, and refused to accept or to touch the knife with which it had been cut.
It would be difficult to paint more perfectly than Captain Cook has done, in the
above description, the natural horror felt by human beings when first becoming
aware of the existence of cannibalism. It must be remembered that the people of
Otaheite and those of New Zealand evidently sprang from the same race; and it
is remarkable that the latter should have become addicted to such an abominable
practice, while the former viewed it with unmitigated horror. Captain Cook says
that he did not suppose the New Zealanders to have commenced the practice for
want of food, as their coasts supplied a vast quantity of fish and wild-fowl,
and they had also numerous dogs which they ate. They had also some vegetables
and many land birds. He was not aware that at the distance of a few days’ sail
there was a race of men equal, if not superior, in intelligence to the New
Zealanders, still more addicted to the horrible practice, the accounts of
which, thoroughly authenticated as they are, make the heart sicken at the
thought of the depths of depravity to which human nature can sink.
In vain the Adventure was looked-for. The unanimous
opinion was that she was not stranded, nor likely to be in any neighbouring
harbour; and as no actual rendezvous had been appointed, all hopes of seeing
her again during the voyage were abandoned. This, however, did not discourage
Cook from pursuing his researches in the South Pacific, in which he intended to
occupy the whole of the ensuing summer; while his officers and crew expressed
themselves willing to accompany him even without their consort, wherever he
might think fit to go.
On the morning of November 26 the Resolution took her
departure from Cape Palliser, and steered south, inclining to the east. Heavy
gales were soon met with, and on the morning of December 12, in latitude 62
degrees 10 minutes South and longitude 172 degrees West, the first iceberg was
seen, as also were many antarctic birds; while the explorers were greeted with
a fresh gale and thick haze and snow, a great sea, rolling up from the
north-west and south-west, at the same time showing that there was no continent
in that direction, unless at a great distance. Two days afterwards more large
ice islands and loose ice were encountered; and with strong gales of wind, a
heavy sea, dense snow-storms and fogs, surrounded by masses of floating ice,
the ship pursued her course to the east. Christmas Day was calm, and, with a
hundred ice islands in sight, the ship was allowed to drift quietly on.
Providentially, the weather was clear, with a light air, and as there was
continued daylight she was prevented from falling aboard any of the masses of
ice. Had it been blowing, and as foggy as on the preceding days, a miracle
alone could have saved her from being dashed to pieces. A full description of this part of the voyage would be tedious. Especially so
must the reality have been to the voyagers; and before long all began to feel
the effects of the bitter weather to which they were exposed. Cook himself was
dangerously ill, though he concealed his malady from the crew.
On January 30, at four in the morning, the clouds over
the horizon were perceived to be of an unusual snow-white brightness, denoting
a wide extent of ice. By eight the ship was close to its edge, when, from the
mast-head, it was seen to extend to the brink of the southern horizon, as well
as to the east and west; while ninety-seven ice mountains were counted rising
out of it. To penetrate this field was hopeless, and at length the captain, to
the satisfaction of all on board, announced his intention of proceeding in
search of the island of Juan Fernandez, said to have been discovered a century
before, in latitude 38 degrees, and failing to find it, to look for Easter
Island, or Davis Land, which had been unsuccessfully sought for by Byron,
Carteret, and Bougainville. After this he purposed getting within the tropic,
and had thoughts of running as far west as the Tierra Austral del Spiritu Santo
of Quiros. In vain the island of Juan Fernandez was looked-for in the latitude in which it was supposed to lie, and the conclusion
arrived at was, that though such an island might be in existence, it could
occupy but a small space in the ocean.
The captain was now again taken ill of what he calls a
bilious colic, which was so severe as to confine him to his bed, the charge of
the ship devolving on Mr Cooper. Mr Patten, the surgeon, proved not only a
skilful physician, but an affectionate friend. A favourite dog belonging to Mr
Forster fell a sacrifice, it being killed and made into soup for the captain,
there being no other fresh meat in the ship. A few fish were afterwards caught,
which were very acceptable to him.
Early on the morning of March 11, 1774, land was seen
about twelve leagues distant, which, to the joy of all on board, ultimately
proved to be the long-sought-for Easter Island. On getting near the coast, off
a sandy beach, two men in a canoe came off, and after sending up, by a rope, a
bunch of plantains, they returned to shore. This showed the good disposition of
the islanders, and gave the voyagers hopes of obtaining refreshments. A better
anchorage than this part of the coast afforded having been found, the ship
brought up here. On the English landing, a few potatoes, plantains, and
sugar-canes were brought to them; but the natives were such expert thieves that those on board could scarcely keep their hats on their
heads or anything in their pockets. A supply of potatoes was obtained; indeed,
this appeared to be the chief production of the island. The natives had been
digging them up as fast as they could from a field close to the landing-place,
till a person arrived who appeared to be the rightful owner, and who drove all
the rest away.
As Captain Cook was unable to walk any distance, he
sent Lieutenants Pickersgill and Edgecombe, with a party of men armed, to
explore the country. They were at first pressed on by a crowd of the natives,
till a man appeared, tattooed and painted, who drove them away, and then,
hoisting a piece of white cloth on a spear, marched forward at the head of the
party. A considerable portion of the island was barren and stony, but in other
parts were plantations of potatoes, plantains, and sugar-canes. Water was very
scarce, and hardly drinkable. Some huts were found, the owners of which came
out with roasted potatoes and sugar-canes, and as the party marched in single
file on account of the narrow path, gave some to each man as he passed by. They
distributed water in the same manner. On the east side, near the sea, three
ruinous platforms of stone were met with, on each of which had stood four large
statues; but most of them had fallen down and been broken. Mr Wales measured an
entire one, and found it to be fifteen feet in length and six feet across the
shoulders. On the head of each statue was a large cylinder of a red-coloured
stone. One of these cylinders, which was measured, was
fifty-two inches high, and sixty-six in diameter. There were others, however,
very much larger. Some of them were perfectly round, others had a cavity worked out, in the upper edge, for a quarter of the way
round.
The opposite side of the island to this, to which
their guide conducted them, was full of these gigantic statues, some placed in
groups, on masonry, others single, fixed only in the earth. The latter were
much larger than the others. One which had fallen down was twenty-seven feet
high and eight feet across the shoulders; and yet this was much shorter than
one they found standing—its shade being sufficient to shelter their party of
nearly thirty persons from the rays of the sun at about two o’clock. Near this
place was a hill, from which a view of the whole island was obtained. Not a
creek large enough even for a boat was seen, nor any indication of fresh water.
In a small hollow on the highest part of the island several cylinders were
found, and Mr Wales was of opinion that the quarry had been at that spot, and
that after the cylinders had been formed they were rolled down the hill. There
must have been great difficulty in raising them to the heads of the statues. It
was conjectured that this was done by raising a mound round each statue and
rolling up the stone on it, the mound being afterwards removed. It must have
required a considerable amount of mechanical knowledge to bring the statues
from the quarry, and to place them upright. The natives knew nothing whatever
as to the origin of the statues, nor did they look on them with any respect,
nor, indeed, seem interested in any way in them. No quadrupeds were seen on the
island, but few birds, and only two sorts of low shrubs.
The party were greatly
inconvenienced in their walk by the attempts of the natives to steal from them,
and at length one man, who ran off with a bagful of provisions, was fired upon
with small shot and wounded slightly. He dropped the bag, and seemed in no way
offended at the treatment he received. The people carried short clubs and also
spears with flint heads. The dress of the chiefs consisted of two pieces of
cloth, one round the waist and the other thrown over the shoulders; but many
were almost naked. The men wore their hair and beards short, with a fillet
ornamented with feathers round the head; while the women wore the hair long,
and had straw caps, shaped like a Scotch bonnet, on their heads. Their
habitations were low huts, built with sticks bent overhead, and joined together
so as to form an arch. The longest seen was sixty feet long, and only four or
five wide. Their canoes were very poor, owing to the want of materials, and
very few were seen. Captain Cook considered that there were about six or seven
hundred inhabitants on the island. In colour, features, and language they were
similar to the inhabitants of the islands to the west, so that it was evident
they had sprung from the same race.
The Resolution left Easter Island on March 16, and
stood north-west-by-north, and north-north-west, for the Marquesas, with a fine
easterly gale. Having reached the latitude of the group, the course was changed
to west. On April 5 first one island and then others in succession were seen;
and the explorers were satisfied that they had reached the Marquesas,
discovered by the Spaniards in 1595. The first island seen was called Hood’s
Island, after the midshipman who discovered it, and the others were Saint
Pedro, Dominica, and Saint Christina. The ship, after being nearly driven on
the rocks, brought up in port in the last-mentioned island. Directly
afterwards, thirty or forty natives came off in ten or twelve canoes, in the
bow of each of which a heap of stones was observed, while all the men had
slings fastened to their hands. It required some address to get them alongside,
but at last a hatchet and some spike-nails induced the people in one canoe to
venture under the quarter-galley. The rest then followed, exchanging
bread-fruit and fish for small nails. At sunset they all returned to the shore.
The next morning the natives returned in greater numbers, with plantains,
bread-fruit, and a pig, but soon showed themselves ready to cheat, and to be
expert thieves. Captain Cook was going into the boat to look for a convenient
place to moor the ship, when, seeing too many natives on board, he warned one
of the officers on deck, saying that something would be stolen. Just then he
was told that an iron stanchion had been carried off from the opposite gangway.
He therefore ordered the officer to fire over the canoe till he could get round
in the boat, but to be careful not to kill any one. But the noise made by the
natives prevented this last warning from being heard, and at the third shot the
unhappy thief was killed. Two other natives who were in the canoe leaped
overboard, but soon got in again, and threw away the stanchion. One of them sat
baling the blood and water out of the canoe, uttering a kind of hysteric laugh,
while the other, a youth of fifteen, looked at the dead body with a serious and
dejected countenance. The latter was found to be the son of the man who had been
killed. Immediately on this, the natives took to flight, but on being followed
by the captain into the bay the people in one canoe were persuaded to come
alongside the boat, and to receive some nails. This restored their confidence
in some degree, but soon afterwards they attempted to carry off the buoy of the
kedge anchor. A musket-shot on this was fired at them, but it fell short, and
they took no notice of it; but a second bullet passing over them, they
immediately let go the buoy and made for the shore.
The natives undoubtedly were bold fellows, for,
notwithstanding the effects of the firearms which they had witnessed, before
long some more ventured off. One of them appeared to be a person of
consequence. His dress was similar to that of the chiefs of Otaheite. Bound his
head was a fillet with the tail feathers of birds fixed in it, and standing
upright. He also wore ornaments of feathers round his legs and arms. The women
wore a petticoat of native cloth, and a broad fillet made of the fibre of the
cocoanut husk, with a piece of mother-of-pearl shell the size of a tea-saucer
in front. On either side were other ornaments of tortoiseshell and
mother-of-pearl, with feathers in the upper part. The chief brought a pig, and
was persuaded to come up to the side, but soon went away.
The party from the Resolution who went on shore were received with courtesy by the natives; the captain was
disappointed in not obtaining the number of pigs he had expected. Some of the
young officers, it seemed, gave away thoughtlessly several articles which the
natives valued more than the nails, and thus spoilt the trade. Among those
highly coveted objects were some of the red feathers obtained at Tonga.
The productions of the Marquesas Islands were similar
to those of Otaheite; the habitations were of a like character, but not so well
built, and the habits of the people were not so cleanly. The people were
considered the handsomest that had been met with during the whole voyage. The
men were generally tattooed, but the women and children, who were not so, were thought to be as fair as many Europeans. Hogs
were the only quadrupeds, and cocks and hens the only tame fowls seen, and
these were not procured in any great number. Notwithstanding the length of time
the crew had been at sea previous to their arrival at the Marquesas, yet, owing
to the abundant supply of anti-scorbutic food, and the watchful care of the
surgeon, there was not a man seriously ill on board. Captain Cook therefore
determined to proceed on his voyage without further delay.
The Resolution therefore left the Marquesas on April
12, 1774; and ten days afterwards she reached Otaheite, and anchored once more
in Matavai Bay. In the course of this passage several low coral islands or
islets had been passed, and one of them had been visited. This was the Island
of Tioakea, first of all discovered by Captain Byron, and formed one of a
group, called Saint George’s Islands. After passing these, the Resolution had
fallen in with four other smaller islands, not set down in any chart; and these
Captain Cook had named Palliser’s Isles, in honour of his particular friend,
Sir Hugh Palliser.
Captain Cook’s object in visiting Matavai Bay was that
Mr Wales, the astronomer, might correct the chronometers of the ship by a known
longitude. The first thing done, therefore, was to erect tents, and to land the
instruments required in this operation.
As soon as the arrival of the voyagers was known, many
of their old friends paid them a visit, expressing great joy at seeing them.
Among others came Otoo, the king, with several chiefs, and a train of
attendants, who brought with them a dozen large hogs and a quantity of fruit,
which made them very welcome. A supply of red parrots’ feathers having been
collected at Tonga, these were shown to the natives, and took their fancy to
such a degree that the principal people of both sexes brought hogs, fruit, and
everything the island afforded, in order to obtain them. So exhausted was his
stock-in-trade that, had it not been for these feathers, Cook says he should
have found it difficult to supply his ship with the necessary refreshments. He
had intended remaining here only long enough to allow Mr Wales to take the
observations he desired, but he found so great an improvement in the state of
the country, and provisions so abundant, that he resolved at once to repair and
refit his ship.
When Captain Cook on one occasion went to Opparree to
pay King Otoo a visit, a formidable fleet of three hundred double war canoes
was found drawn up along the beach, while a number of armed men were seen on
the shore. What could be the object of this armament it was difficult to conjecture. The Englishmen, however, on landing, were
received with great courtesy; but Otoo was not to be found, and, greatly
disappointed, they returned on board. At length they were told that this fleet
was part of an armament intended to be sent against Eimeo, whose chief had
declared himself independent of Otaheite.
The chief next in consequence to Otoo was Towha, who
seemed to be a very sensible man, and most friendly to the English. He showed
it on a trying occasion. A native had been caught stealing a water-cask, and
having been kept in irons on board, was returned on shore to be flogged. Otoo,
his sister, and others, begged that the man might be set at liberty; but Cook
explained that as he flogged any of his people who stole from them, or behaved
ill in any way, so in justice, and to preserve peace between them, he must
punish any natives who behaved ill to him. The sentence was carried out, the natives
looking on. On the culprit being set at liberty, the people were going away,
when Towha called them back and addressed them, recapitulating what had been
said to Otoo, condemning their present bad habits, and advising a reformation
in future. The gracefulness of action and the attention with which he was heard
showed that he was no mean orator. After this the marines went through their
exercises and loaded and fired in volleys, to the utter amazement of the
natives, especially to those who had seen nothing of the kind before.
The next morning a small portion of the fleet of war
canoes was observed exercising, and Mr Hodges had the opportunity of sketching
them. The largest had about thirty rowers, the smaller only eighteen. The
warriors stood on the stage, and encouraged the rowers, or paddlers rather, to exert themselves. Some youths were seated high up on the
carved stem above the steersman, with white wands in their hands, apparently to
look out and give notice of what they saw. The warriors were completely
equipped for war, and the quantity and weight of cloth they had on them made it
difficult to conceive how they could stand up under it when fighting. A large
quantity was wrapped round their heads as turbans of helmets, to guard them
from the blows of their enemies. The turbans of some of the warriors were
surmounted by small bunches of shrubs covered with white feathers, intended as
ornaments. On returning to the shore all the rowers leaped out the moment the
canoe touched the ground, and, with the assistance of those on shore, hauled it
up on the beach. Each man then walked off with his paddle, and so rapidly was
everything done, that in less than five minutes there was no sign of the canoes
having been lately afloat. Afterwards, at the dockyard of King Otoo, among many
large canoes, two were seen in the course of building a hundred and eight feet
long. They were to be united so as to form one double canoe; the largest, Cook
says, he had seen in those seas.
On another occasion an example was given of the way
the warriors, in attacking a place, are thrown on shore. Four or more canoes
were lashed side by side, and then each division paddled in so judiciously that
they formed one unbroken line along the shore. To do this they were directed by
a man who stood in the fore part of the centre vessel, with a long wand in his
hand, directing all their movements. The fleet was attended by some small
double canoes, called marias. On the fore part of each
was a sort of bed place with one division, capable of holding the body of a
man, intended for the reception of any chief who might be killed in battle.
Cook estimated, from the number of canoes he saw furnished by each district,
that the whole island could raise and equip one thousand seven hundred and
twenty war canoes, requiring sixty-eight thousand men, calculating forty for
each canoe. As these would not amount to a third of the number of people in the
island, he considered that it could not contain less than two hundred and four
thousand inhabitants. He was convinced, from the vast swarms of people he met
wherever he went, that this estimate was not too great. This is possible; but
war, disease, and vicious habits had fearfully decreased the population before
Christianity was established among them.
Otoo and his chiefs at first appeared very anxious
that Captain Cook should accompany them in their proposed expedition, and they
begged him to help them against their enemies. This he very properly declined
doing, but would have been glad to have accompanied them to witness the mode in
which they carried on their naval operations. It would have been more in
accordance with the character of a Christian people had the English tried to
reconcile the contending parties, and to prove to them the advantages and blessings
of peace. But such a thought does not appear to have entered the mind of the
sagacious navigator, or of his companions.
Cook’s endeavours to benefit the islanders in other
respects appeared likely to be successful. Two goats had been left by Captain
Furneaux. They had had two kids, now nearly full grown, and the mother was also
again with kid. The animals were in excellent condition, and the people seemed
very fond of them. One of two sheep had, however, died, but twenty cats were
given to the natives, though it is difficult to understand how they were likely
to prove useful, unless mice had threatened to overrun the island.
During this visit a man from a distant part of the
island made off with a musket and effected his escape.
The dread of the consequences to themselves caused Otoo and several other
chiefs to run away and hide themselves, and the people were afraid to bring
down provisions to the ship. After a considerable amount of negotiations, and
the delay of nine days, the musket and some other articles which had been
stolen were, by the intervention of the chiefs, brought back to the tents, and
confidence was restored.
Preparations were now made for leaving Otaheite. On
May 11 a large supply of fruit arrived from all parts, some of it sent by
Towha, the admiral of the fleet, with orders to his servants to receive nothing
in return. However, the captain thought fit to send an equivalent present by
Oedidee. That young native had come to the resolution of remaining at Otaheite,
but was persuaded to go on in the ship to Ulietea, his native island. Nothing
but Captain Cook’s warning that it was very probable he would be unable to
return to the Pacific would have induced him to leave the ship, so great was
his affection for the English, and his desire to visit their country.
On the 12th old Oberea, who had been supposed by
Captain Wallis to be the queen of the island, came on board, and brought a
present of pigs and fruit, and soon afterwards Otoo appeared with a retinue and
a large quantity of provisions. Handsome presents were made in return, and the
visitors were entertained in the evening with fireworks. A succession of
broadsides from the great guns on another occasion must have still more
astonished the natives.
Captain Cook waited in vain for the sailing of the
fleet on the proposed warlike expedition. It was evident that the chiefs
considered, since they could not obtain the assistance of the English, that
they should be more at liberty to act if left alone, and therefore, as long as
the Resolution remained, they continued to make excuses for not setting out.
Otoo’s large canoe had been called, at Cook’s request, the Britannia, and he
had presented to the king a grappling-iron, a rope, and an English Jack and
pendant for her.
Several natives were anxious to accompany Captain
Cook, but he firmly resisted all their solicitations, from motives of humanity,
knowing the great probability that they would never return to their native
land. At length, on May 14, 1774, the anchor was hove up, and the ship proceeded
out of the harbour, Otoo remaining in his canoe alongside till the ship was
under sail. At that juncture, all the boats being hoisted in, a gunner’s mate,
a good swimmer, slipped overboard, hoping to reach the shore and remain behind.
He was, however, seen before he got clear of the ship; a boat was lowered, and
he was brought back. He was an Irishman by birth, but he had been long-absent
from home, and he was without any tie of kindred; Captain Cook says that he
could not be surprised at his wish to remain where he could enjoy not only all
the necessaries, but all the luxuries of life, in ease and plenty; and that had
he asked permission to remain it might, perhaps, have been granted. He had
formerly been in the Dutch service, and had come on board the Endeavour at
Batavia during the former voyage.
On the 15th the Resolution anchored in O’Wharre
Harbour, in the island of Huaheine, and immediately old Oree, the chief, and
several natives came on board, when the former presented a hog and some other
articles with the usual forms. A friendly intercourse was kept up with Oree the
whole time of the visit, but several of the officers and men were robbed on
shore. There appeared to exist a gang of banditti who
set their chief at defiance, and robbed every one they met. Captain Cook,
however, landed and quietly took possession of a house with two chiefs in it,
who were kept as hostages till the articles were returned. On another occasion,
at the request of Oree, he, with a strong party of armed men, landed, and went
in pursuit of the thieves; but Oedidee, who was with them, became alarmed, and
warned the captain that they were being led into an ambush to be destroyed.
From the strict discipline, however, kept up by the party, this (even should
the natives have intended treachery) was rendered impossible. In spite of these
drawbacks the people brought cocoanuts and other fruits, and two young chiefs
presented to the captain a pig, a dog, and some young plantain trees, the usual
peace offerings. Notwithstanding this good feeling, he caused several volleys
to be fired to show the natives the power and effect of musketry, for the young
officers and others who went on shore shooting with muskets were so very
inexpert in their use that they had brought firearms somewhat into contempt.
On the 21st a fleet of sixty canoes was seen steering
for Ulietea. The people on board them were Eareeoies, going to visit their
brethren in the neighbouring islands. They formed a secret society, and seemed
to have customs which they would not explain. Infanticide appeared to be almost
universal among them, and they had many other practices of a most abominable
character. Cava-drinking and acting plays seemed to be the principal amusements
of the chiefs of this island.
Early on the morning of the 23rd the ship put to sea.
The good old chief Oree was the last man who left her. When told by the captain
that he should see him no more, he wept, and said, “Let your sons come; we will
treat them well.”
The next day, it having been calm all night, the
Resolution reached Ulietea. While warping into a secure berth, the captain’s
old friend, Oreo, with several other persons, came off, bringing presents. On
returning the visit, the captain and his companions were met at the door of the
house by five old women, who had been cutting their heads with sharks’ teeth,
and now, while the blood was streaming down their faces, insisted on saluting
their visitors. Directly afterwards they went out, washed themselves,
and returned, appearing as cheerful as any of the company. A large number of
people had collected on shore near the ship; they were said to be Eareeoies,
and they continued feasting for several days. There, as at the other islands,
plays were acted for the amusement of the visitors.
Ulietea was Oedidee’s native island, and here he took
leave of his English friends, whom he left “with a regret fully demonstrative
of his esteem and affection; nor could anything have torn him from them but the
fear of never returning.” The captain declares that he had not words to
describe the anguish of this young man when he went away. “He looked up at the
ship, burst into tears, and then sank down into the canoe.”
This young South Sea Islander is described as “a youth
of good parts, and of a docile, gentle, and humane disposition,” and as one who
would have been—physically at least—a better specimen of the people than Omai.
It is to be feared that he returned to his home, after his lengthened cruise
with his English patrons, without having received any real benefit from the
intercourse. So far as can be learned, “no man had cared for his soul.”
After leaving Ulietea, the Resolution proceeded
westward on her voyage, being cautiously navigated at night, and having all
sails set in the daytime. The first land seen was Howe Island, previously
discovered by Captain Wallis; the next was an island before unknown, to which
was given the name of Palmerston.
On June 20 more land was in sight. This proved to be
an island about eleven leagues in circuit, and standing well out of the sea,
having deep water close into its shores. As this island was perceived to be
inhabited, Captain Cook was induced to go on shore with a party of explorers,
and endeavoured to open communication with the natives. They were found,
however, to be fierce and intractable, furiously attacking the visitors with
stones and darts. Two or three muskets discharged in the air did not hinder
them from advancing still nearer, and one of them threw a long dart or spear
which narrowly missed the captain, passing close over his shoulder. The
boldness and fury of this man nearly cost him his life, for, aroused by the
instinct of self-preservation, and probably also by, momentary anger, Captain
Cook raised a musket he carried, and pointing it at his assailant, who was only
a few paces off, he pulled the trigger. Happily, the weapon missed fire, and
the English commander was spared the after-remorse of needless bloodshed, for
the explorers, or the invaders and intruders, as the natives considered them,
reached their boat, and afterwards their ship, unharmed.
In consequence of the apparent disposition and the
behaviour of the people, the island received from Cook the name of Savage
Island, a name it still bears, although the inhabitants no longer merit the
appellation of Savage Islanders.
After leaving this island, the ship’s course was
west-south-west, and on June 25 a string of islands was seen ahead when the
wind dropped. The next morning more islands were seen and soundings found. The
islands in sight proved to be those of the Tonga group to which Cook had given
the name of the Friendly Islands. A canoe came boldly off, and the people in
her pointed out Anamocka, or Rotterdam, towards which the ship proceeded, and
anchored on the north side of the island. The natives came off in their canoes
in great numbers, and exchanged yams and shaddocks for nails and old rags; but,
as usual, some began to pilfer, and one man got hold of the lead-line, which he
would not relinquish till fired at.
On the captain and some of the officers going on
shore, they were received with great courtesy by the natives, who assisted in
filling the water-casks and rolling them down to the beach, contented with a
few nails as payment. When, however, the surgeon was afterwards out shooting by
himself, having been left on shore, a fellow seized his fowling-piece and made
off with it. Afterwards, when the watering party were on shore, Mr Gierke’s gun was snatched from him, and several of the cooper’s
tools were carried off. This style of proceeding, if allowed, would have
hazarded the safety of all on board; the captain, therefore, who had been
summoned, sent off for the marines, while two or three guns were fired from the
ship to alarm Mr Forster, who was on shore. Several of the natives remained,
who acted with their usual courtesy, and long before the marines arrived Mr
Clerke’s gun was brought back. As the other was not restored, two large double
sailing-canoes were seized by the marines on their landing; and one man, making
resistance, was fired at with small shot. This showed the natives that the
English were in earnest, and the musket was returned; but an adze had also been
carried off, and it was insisted that this also should be brought back. The
chiefs thought that the captain wanted the man who had been wounded, and whom
they said was dead. Soon afterwards he was brought up, stretched out on a
board, and apparently lifeless. Captain Cook was very much shocked at first,
till, examining the body, he found that the man was
alive and only slightly hurt. His wounds were dressed by the surgeon, who soon
afterwards arrived, and a poultice of sugar-cane was applied to prevent
inflammation. A present recompensed to some extent what the poor man suffered.
No person of any consequence was seen by the voyagers while they remained here.
Several lofty islands were seen in the group—among them Amattagoa, whose summit
was veiled in clouds, and was rightly supposed to be a volcano. Many of the
islands in the South Seas are volcanic, and in some of them the volcanoes are
in full activity. That of Kilanea, in the Sandwich Islands, often presents a
spectacle of awful fury and grandeur.
After leaving the Friendly Islands, and calling, on
July 1, at Turtle Island, a brisk gale carried the ship on for some distance,
till, on the 15th, high land was seen to the south-west. This was the Australia
del Espirito Santo of Quiros; it also went by the name of the great
Cyclades. After exploring the coast for some days, the captain came to an
anchor in a harbour in the island of Mallicollo, where one of his objects was
to open friendly communication with the natives.
A number of these came off, some in canoes, others
swimming. They exchanged arrows tipped with bone for pieces of cloth, while two
who ventured on deck received presents. The next morning so many made their
appearance, and with such increased confidence, that after a large number had
boarded the ship it was found necessary to refuse admittance to others. Upon
this one of the repulsed natives threatened to shoot a boat-keeper in one of
the boats. In the confusion that ensued Captain Cook came on deck, when the
savage turned his arrow toward him. Upon this the captain, who had a gun in his
hand loaded with small shot, fired at his assailant, who, being but slightly
wounded, still kept his bow bent in a threatening attitude. Receiving the
contents of a second musket, however, he dropped his bow and paddled off with
all speed.
By this time others of the natives had begun to
discharge their arrows; neither did a musket fired over their heads frighten
them. It was not till they heard the thunder of a four-pounder that they were
seriously alarmed; then the natives on deck and in the cabin leaped overboard,
and, with those in the canoes, made their escape as fast as they could. Directly
after the gun was fired drums were heard beating on shore, probably to summon
the people to arms.
The next day the captain landed with a green branch in
his hand, and was met by a chief who also carried one, and these being
exchanged a friendly intercourse was established. The English made signs that
they wished to cut down wood, and permission was granted to them by the natives
to do so. These people, however, set no value on nails or anything their
visitors possessed. They seemed unwilling that any one should advance beyond
the beach, and were only anxious to get rid of the strangers. When the English
left the shore the natives retired in different directions. In the afternoon a
man was seen to bring to the beach a buoy which had been taken in the night from
the kedge anchor. On a boat being sent it was at once put on board, the man
walking off without saying a word, and this was the only thing which was stolen
while the ship lay there. Some houses, similar to those of the Friendly
Islands, were seen, with plantations of cocoanuts, plantains, yams, and bread-fruit, and a number of pigs were running about.
Other parts of the shore were visited, but the people
kept aloof; and not till the ship was under way did they come off, showing then
every disposition to trade, and acting with scrupulous honesty. Sometimes, for
instance, they had received articles, and not having given anything in return,
their canoes being shoved off by their companions, they used every exertion to
get back to the ship. They were the most ugly, ill-proportioned people the
explorers had yet seen; dark-coloured and rather diminutive, with long heads,
flat faces, and monkey-like countenances. Their hair was black or brown, short
and curly, but not so soft or woolly as that of a
negro. Their beards were strong, crisp, and bushy. A belt round the middle
curiously contracted that part of the body, while, with the exception of a
wrapper between the legs, they went naked. The women wore a petticoat, and a
bag over their shoulders in which the children were carried; but none came near
the ship. A piece of white stone, an inch and a half long, with a slight curve
in it, was worn in a hole made through the nose. Their arms were clubs, spears,
and bows and arrows. Some of the officers were very nearly poisoned by eating
portions of two reddish fish, the size of large bream, caught with hook and
line. They were seized with violent pains in the head and bones, attended by a
scorching heat all over the body, and a numbness of the joints. A pig and dog
died from eating the remainder. It was a week or ten days before the officers
quite recovered. The crews of Quiros had suffered in the same way. He had named
the fish Porgos.
A number of islands were now passed, to which the
names of Montagu, Sandwich, Hitchinbrook, and Shepherd were given; the ship
continuing along the coast to the south-east.
On August 3 the Resolution approached another island,
and anchored about a mile from the shore, when several natives attempted to
swim off to her, but a boat being lowered they returned. The next morning the
captain went off to the shore in search of wood and water, with presents which
he distributed among some people who appeared on the rocks which line the
coast. In return, they offered, as he supposed with a friendly feeling, to drag
the boat through the surf on shore; but he declined the offer, wishing to have
a better place to land at. This he found on a sandy beach, in a bay where he
could land without wetting his feet. To this spot crowds followed him, headed by a chief, who made them form a semicircle, while with
only a green branch in his hand Cook stepped on shore. The chief was loaded
with presents, which he received courteously; and when, by signs, water and
fruit were asked for, he immediately sent for some. Still, as all the people
were armed with clubs, spears, bows and arrows, the captain was suspicious of
their intentions, and kept his eye on the chief. Again signs were made by the
natives that they would haul the boat up, and just then the chief disappeared
among the crowd. On this, Cook stepped back into the boat, making signs that he
would soon return. The islanders, however, had no intention of allowing him to
depart, so while some of them laid hold of the gang-board, and attempted to
drag up the boat on to the beach, others snatched at the oars, and tried to
wrest them away from the sailors. In this predicament, and seeing that neither
expostulations nor menaces were of any avail, the captain raised his musket,
pointed it at the chief, who had again made his appearance, and pulled the
trigger; but, as on a former occasion, the piece missed fire, or only flashed
in the pan. The savages then began throwing stones and darts, and shooting
their arrows. The captain now felt compelled to order his men to fire. The
first discharge threw the savages into confusion, but even a second was hardly
sufficient to drive them off the beach, and they then retired behind trees and
bushes, popping out every now and then to throw a dart. Four lay to all
appearances dead; but two managed to crawl behind the bushes. Happily, half the
muskets missed fire, or more would have been wounded. One of the boat’s crew
was badly wounded in the cheek by a dart, and an arrow shot from a distance
struck Mr Gilbert. The skirmish ended by the English making good their retreat.
On the arrival of the party on board, the ship was got
under way and stood closer in shore; and presently two of the natives appeared
with two oars which had been lost in the scuffle. In a fit of exasperation,
probably on account of the treatment he had received, and of mortification at
his partial defeat, Captain Cook ordered a round shot to be fired at the men,
which, though it proved harmless, had the effect of driving the men away. They
left the oars, however, leaning against some bushes.
The whole of this unhappy affair seems to have been a
series of misunderstandings. At least, it is not difficult to conceive that the
natives were, at first, friendly disposed; that their offer to haul the boat
upon the beach may have been dictated by kind motives, and that their
subsequent conduct arose from what they might have conceived to be the
suspicious actions of their strange and uninvited visitors. As to their being
armed, and declining to lay down their arms, it is to be remembered that the
English had arms also, which they did not lay down. It certainly does not seem
improbable that if the chief of these poor barbarians and the English captain
could have interchanged a few words, intelligible on both sides, and so
convinced each other of their honest intentions and wishes, the subsequent
fracas might have been prevented; but this, of course, was out of the question.
It is to be feared, too, that the superiority over all uncivilised nations
which the English voyagers proudly felt themselves to possess gave an air of
contemptuous defiance to their actions which the natives might resent. The
firing of that last shot was not unlikely (together with the previous scuffle)
to provoke feelings of deep enmity, and not only to rankle in the minds and
memories of those present, but to be handed down by tradition to the next
generation, and the next after that, so as to keep up both detestation of all
white men, and dread of their future visits.
These remarks are not uncalled for, nor will they be
considered as without point when the name of the island is given—Erromanga; a
name full of painful associations to all who take an interest in missionary
enterprise, and in the advancement, by human instrumentality, of the kingdom of
the Redeemer. It was here that, sixty-six years afterwards, the valuable life
of one of the foremost in the ranks of modern Christian missionaries, John
Williams, was sacrificed to the hatred of the whites of which we have just
spoken. The proximate incentive to the murder was revenge for some
ill-treatment the natives had shortly before received from a white man, a
sandal-wood trader; but it is probable that the commencement of their strong
dislike to strangers may be traced to the visit of the Resolution to their native
island in 1774.
After leaving Erromanga, the ship steered for another
island, which proved to be Tanna, being directed at night by a great light
which was seen at the east end of it, and which, in the morning, was discovered
to be that of a volcano in full activity. A harbour was found, and two boats,
well armed, were sent in to sound. Here the ship anchored. A number of armed
natives were seen on shore, and soon they began to come off, some swimming,
others in canoes. Some cocoanuts were thrown into one of the boats, and cloths
and other articles were given in return. This induced more to venture
alongside, when they proved themselves to be most daring thieves; some
attempted to knock off the rings from the rudder, others tried to tear away the
fly of the ensign, and a bold effort was made to run away with the buoys. A
musketoon fired over their heads had the effect of driving them off. Even here
there was an exception to the rule. An old man continually came off to the ship
with fruit, evidently trying to ingratiate himself with the strangers. Although
a very strong party landed in the evening, it was clear to the voyagers that
the natives would have attacked them, had they not, to avoid bloodshed, quickly
embarked. As it was necessary to take in a fresh supply of wood and water, the
ship was warped in close to the shore, both to overawe the natives, and more
easily to get on board what was wanted. The natives again quickly manifested
their thievish propensities. For instance, a man came off with a club, with
which he struck the ship’s side in defiance, and then offered to exchange the
weapon for beads. No sooner, however, did he get them, than he made off without
giving up the club.
Captain Cook had wished for an opportunity of showing
the natives the effect of firearms; some small shot were therefore sent after
the thief, and several musketoons were discharged. As this did not seem to
produce the desired effect, the Resolution was moored with her broadside to the
shore, with her guns placed so as to command the whole harbour. The captain
then landed, with a guard of marines and sailors, all well armed, hoping by
this means to overawe the natives, who assembled in vast numbers on each side
of the landing-place. Instead of being frightened by the display of strength,
they began to use such threatening gestures that it was thought necessary to
file upon them. This was the signal for the guns to open from the ship. The
savages at once dispersed, but soon came back greatly humbled in manner. The
old man, whose name was Paowang, was the only one who stood his ground, and was
rewarded with gifts. Cook then drew a line on the ground, and signified to the
natives that they must not pass it.
The captain had now every reason to believe that the
natives were induced to be submissive, and taking old Paowang into the forest,
he explained that he wanted wood, and asked permission to cut some down. This
was readily granted, the old man begging only that he would not cut down any
cocoanut trees.
The watering party meanwhile filled the casks; but
still the lower orders were very troublesome. Some buckshot, fired at a man, at
last brought them to order, and now everything seemed to go on pleasantly.
Paowang even brought an axe and several other articles which had been left on
shore; indeed, Cook’s demeanour seemed to have won the respect of the savages,
and it was no longer necessary to mark a barrier line, as they did not press
near the tents nor incommode the English when at work. Yet, savages they were,
for they acknowledged voluntarily that they were cannibals, and asked their
visitors if they also did not eat the flesh of their enemies. Yet they could
have no excuse for the practice, as their island abounded with pigs, and fruit
of all sorts.
All this time the English were constantly on their
guard; still they ran no little risk, as they made some excursions up the
country, when they were threatened by parties of natives, who, however, retired
when they turned towards the harbour. It is manifest, however, that the natives
were not badly disposed, but were influenced by the very natural feeling of
jealousy at seeing strangers, whose object they could not comprehend,
attempting to penetrate their country. It would have been difficult to convince
untutored savages, who had been peppered with buckshot, and fired at with
bullets and cannon-balls, that their white visitors were influenced by the
purest feelings of philanthropy, and a disinterested desire to do them good.
Fortunately, the muskets supplied to the Resolution must have been kept in very
bad order, as they missed fire as often as they went off, or more lives of
savages would have been sacrificed. There is no doubt, as has already been
intimated, that Captain Cook had no delight in exercising cruelty towards the
natives of the places he visited, and believed that he acted in self-defence
when he, as he would have said, was unfortunately called upon to wound and
perhaps to slay them. It may be added, also, that he frequently had great
trouble in restraining the ardour of his officers, who were not troubled with
so nice a conscience as the captain’s regarding the lives of the savages.
On one occasion, for instance, some native boys
(little mischievous urchins, no doubt) who had got into a thicket near where a
party were cutting wood, and had thrown stones, were fired at by some of the
petty officers. The captain was very much displeased at so wanton a use being
made of firearms, and took measures, as he thought, to prevent it for the
future; but not long afterwards, to his horror, he saw a sentry level his
musket, and before he could cry out, the soldier had fired and shot a native
dead. The marine’s only excuse was that he saw a native bending his bow, an act
they often performed without intending to shoot. After all, the sentry did not
kill the man who bent the bow, but another who was standing near.
Among the excursions made by the officers was one
towards the volcano, which, however, they could not reach. It was in such
furious eruption that the air was filled with dust and ashes, and when it
rained they were covered with mud. On their way they passed a
spot emitting columns of smoke, and near the harbour hot springs were
discovered; a thermometer placed in one of them rose to 170 degrees.
Although the people of this island had no notion of
the use of iron, they were not so savage as at first
appeared; their plantations were carefully cultivated, and produced sugar-canes
and yams, bread-fruit, plantains, and cocoanuts. They had, however, one of the
chief characteristics of savages—the women carried all the burdens, and were
compelled to do every description of hard work. Though dark, they had not the
peculiarities of the negro race, but they made
themselves darker than they were by painting their skins. They differed in many
respects from the inhabitants of the neighbouring islands, both in appearance
and language. Their dwellings were of some size, but had no walls, being merely
roofs—looking like those of English barns taken off their walls and placed on
the ground. Their canoes were tolerably well constructed, but though their
shores abounded with fish, they had no notion of catching them with nets or
lines, the only way being to spear them as they swam by.
On the morning of August 20 the ship left Resolution
Harbour, (so-called by Captain Cook, because the Resolution had anchored
there,) in Tanna, and continued the survey along the coasts of this extensive
group of islands. A large number of natives were seen at the south-west side of
Mallicollo, and on the opposite shore a brief communication was held with
apparently another race of people, who came off in numerous small outrigger
canoes. Though gifts were handed to them, they could not be induced to come up
the side, or even to take hold of a rope.
The scenery of the coast in all directions was much
admired; the vegetation was most luxuriant; every hill was chequered with
plantations, and every valley was watered by a sparkling stream. The survey of
the group being at length completed, the Resolution stood away towards New
Zealand. The supposed continent of Quiros had dwindled into a small island, and,
as Captain Cook took his departure from the south-west point in latitude 15
degrees 40 minutes, longitude 165 degrees 59 minutes, he named it Cape
Lisbourne. The Resolution continued her course to the south-west, from
September 1 till the 4th, when land was discovered bearing south-south-west,
and extending round for some leagues. Breakers were seen half-way between the
ship and the shore, and inside them were several canoes, evidently coming off,
but as night fell they returned. The night was spent in standing off and on the
land, and the next morning, the boats having discovered a channel through the
reef, the ship stood in and came to anchor. She was immediately surrounded by a
number of natives, who came off in eighteen canoes. They were entirely unarmed,
and apparently well disposed. Some presents were thrown to them, for which they
offered two stale fish in return, and, confidence being established, numbers
crowded on board. Some were asked into the cabin to dinner. They showed,
however, no curiosity to taste the pea-soup, salt beef, or pork, but ate some
yams.
Except a curious wrapper generally in use these people
were entirely naked. They seemed intelligent, and examined with considerable
interest the goats, hogs, dogs, and cats on board, which, it was evident, they
had never before seen. They valued spike-nails and cloth of all colours, but
red cloth they preferred. A young chief was seen in one of the canoes, but did
not come on board. After dinner, Captain Cook, accompanied by a native, landed
with two armed boats’ crews. The beach was thronged with people, and the native
pointed out those to whom presents should be given, mostly old men; among them
was the chief, Teabooma, who soon calling for silence addressed the people,
apparently in favour of the strangers. All the chiefs in succession made
speeches, the old men giving a grunt and a nod of approbation at the end of
each sentence. The captain kept his eyes on the people all the time, and was
completely convinced of their good intentions. Having made signs that water was
wanting, his native friend conducted them along the coast, lined with
mangroves, to a creek, on going up which, above the mangroves, a straggling
village appeared; the ground around being laid out in well cultivated
plantations of sugar-canes, plantains, yams, and other roots, watered by rills
conducted from the main stream, whose source was in the hills. Here was an
abundance of fresh water. Among other things, some roots were seen baking in an
earthen jar, holding from six to eight gallons, apparently manufactured by the
natives. On their way Mr Forster shot a duck, which the native begged to have,
that he might explain to his countrymen how it was killed. The party returned
on board at sunset, convinced that they were not likely to obtain provisions at
the place, as it did not appear to produce more than the inhabitants themselves
required, although it was clear that they were ready to give what they could,
for a more obliging, civil, pleasant people had not been met with during the voyage.
Hundreds came on board the ship, but not a theft was committed. One of them,
who had attached himself to Captain Cook, brought some roots; a few of the
others had weapons, such as clubs and darts, which they willingly exchanged for
nails and pieces of cloth. A present had been made up for Teabooma, who,
however, slipped out of the ship, and lost it. A good watering-place was found,
not far off, up a creek; but as only a small boat could enter it the casks were
rolled over the beach, and put on board the launch. Plenty of fuel could also
be procured.
An excursion on shore gave the explorers a better idea
of the island than they could otherwise have possessed. They were accompanied
by several natives, the numbers increasing as they advanced, till they had a
large cortège. Reaching the summit of a rocky hill, the sea was observed
in two places on the opposite side between the heights, thus enabling them to
calculate the width of the island. Below them was a large valley, through which
ran a river, on whose banks were several villages and plantations, while the
flat land which lay along the shore appeared to great advantage; the winding
streams running through it, the plantations, the little straggling villages,
the variety in the woods, the shoals on the coast, with the blue sea and the
white breakers, made up a very beautiful and picturesque scene. The country in
general bore a strong resemblance to parts of New Holland, under the same
latitude; several of its natural productions appeared to be the same; while the
forests, as in that country, were without underwood. The general aspect of the
island was, however, that of a dreary waste; the sides of the mountains and
other places being of hard rock, or of a thin soil baked by the sun. Even these
unpromising spots were, however, covered with a coarse grass, which though of
no use, as there were no cattle to feed on it, would afford pasture to
numberless sheep if they were to be introduced into the island. There was a
good supply of fish on the coast; but one day a somewhat ugly-looking one being
dressed for supper, the captain and the two Mr Forsters, though they did but
taste the liver and roe, were seized with a numbness and weakness over their
limbs. An emetic and a sudorific considerably relieved them by the morning, but
a pig which ate the fish died. A native who had sold the fish did not warn the
buyer, though its poisonous character seems to have been known to the people,
for, on seeing the skin hanging up the next morning, they expressed their
utmost abhorrence of it, and intimated that it was not fit to eat. The captain
was anxious to benefit the people as far as his short stay would allow; he,
therefore, presented a dog and a bitch to Teabooma, who seemed delighted with
the gift; indeed, he could scarcely suppose that the animals were for him. A
boar and a sow were also intended for him, but as he was not then to be found
they were given to another chief, or head man, and his family, who promised to
take care of them. These people had made some advance out of the purely savage
state. Their dwellings were circular, very thickly thatched, something like a
beehive, and very close and warm. Many had two fireplaces, and some had two
storeys, spread with mats and grass. As the entrance was very small, and there
was no other outlet for the smoke, the heat was intolerable. It was strange
that natives of so hot a climate should delight in all the extra heat they
could get. Outside the huts were little pyramids, five together. On the point
of the pyramids the clay pots in which they cooked their food were placed, not
upright, but on the sides, the fire being lighted beneath. The canoes of the
islanders were large, but rude and clumsy in build; and they constructed double
canoes formed of the trunks of two trees fastened together, much in the fashion
of the other double canoes of the Pacific. They had sometimes one, and
sometimes two, lateen sails, composed of pieces of matting, the ropes being
made of the coarse filaments of the plantain tree. When they could not sail
they were propelled by sculls, the handles of which rose, nearly upright, four feet above the deck.
On standing down the coast, some objects were seen
which the scientific gentlemen insisted were basaltic pillars, like those of
the Giant’s Causeway in Ireland, contrary to the opinion of the captain, who
held that they were trees of a peculiar growth. An island was discovered to the
south of the large island, and the name of the Isle of Pines was given to it,
on account of the number of tall trees growing thereon, and which the
philosophers still maintained were basaltic pillars. It was not without some
difficulty that, at length, the ship got near enough to the Isle of Pines to
enable the captain, with a party of officers, to land on one of the islets connected
with it. The objects observed were found to be a species of spruce pine,
admirably fitted for masts and spars. After dinner, therefore, two boats went
on shore with the carpenter and his crew, and as many spars as were required
were cut down. It was of this tree that the natives made their canoes. The
island on which the party landed was called Botany Island.
The Resolution got under way on October 1. Soon
afterwards a gale sprang up, which, in spite of all the exertions which could
be made, rendered the further survey of the group impossible. She therefore
bore away for New Zealand.
New Caledonia, thus discovered, Captain Cook
considered to be, with the exception of New Zealand, the largest island in the
South Pacific Ocean, being about eighty-seven leagues long, extending from the
north-west to south-east, that is, from latitude 19 degrees 37 minutes to 22
degrees 30 minutes South, and from longitude 163 degrees 37 minutes to 167
degrees 14 minutes East, although its width is nowhere very considerable.
The ship stood on about west-south-west till October
10, when land was discovered—an island of good height, five leagues in circuit,
to which, as a compliment to the family of Howard, the name of Norfolk Island
was given. The ship stood in, when after dinner two boats landed without
difficulty behind some large rocks. The island was found to be uninhabited, and
probably no human being had ever before set foot on its shore. Many trees and
plants common in New Zealand were observed, especially the flax plant, which
here appeared to be more luxuriant than in any part of that country. A spruce pine also grew in abundance, and to a great size, and
there were also found a number of cabbage palms. They had large pinnated
leaves, and the cabbage is, properly speaking, the bad of the tree. Each tree
produces but one crown, which grows out of the stem, and by cutting this out
the tree is destroyed. As many as could be collected were carried on board, and
proved very welcome. The voyage to New Zealand was then continued.
On October 17 Mount Egmont was seen, and the next day
the ship anchored at the entrance of Ship Cove, a strong wind preventing her
getting in. The day after she warped up, and being moored, the usual
preparations were made for carrying on operations on shore. The forge was set
up, and coopers’ and sail-makers’ tents were erected. For several days no
natives appeared. The gardens were visited, and several of the plants were in a
flourishing condition. When the natives did appear their conduct was very strange.
At first they kept at a distance, with their weapons in their hands; but when
they recognised Captain Cook and his officers, they danced and skipped about
like madmen, though even then they would not let any of their women come near.
Several of them talked about killing, but their
language was so imperfectly understood that no meaning could at first be
gathered from what they said. The following story was made out, however, before
long:—The natives said that a ship like the Resolution had been lost in the
strait, and that some of the people got on shore, when the natives stole their
clothes, for which several were shot; that afterwards, when the sailors could
fire no longer, the natives rushed in and killed them with their clubs and
spears, and ate them. The narrators declared that they themselves had no hand
in the matter, which occurred at some distance along the coast.
Friendly relations were at once established with the
natives the English had first met, who brought a good supply of fish, which they
willingly exchanged for Otaheite cloth. Cook’s training in the merchant service
had given him some useful notions with regard to mercantile principles, and in
many other cases, as well as in this, he purchased
articles with the view of taking them to another market, where their value
would be increased. Still, though Cook was trying to do the natives all the
good in his power, it was evident that they were shy of the English. Their more
intimate friends at last acknowledged that the Adventure had been there, and
though the captain’s mind was relieved with regard to her, he still feared that
some disaster had occurred to another vessel along the coast. He probably was,
as usual, on his guard, and careful in preventing any causes of dispute between
his people and the natives, or he himself might have had to experience the
effects of New Zealand treachery.
On November 10 the Resolution left Queen Charlotte’s
Sound for the last time, and steered south-by-east, with a fine wind, Cook’s
intention being to get into latitude 54 degrees or 55 degrees, and to cross the
ocean nearly in those parallels, thus to pass over those parts which were left
unexplored the previous summer.
On the evening of December 17 the west coast of Tierra
del Fuego, near the entrance of the Straits of Magalhaens, was made; and now
Captain Cook says that he had done with the South Pacific, but he had a sound
ship and a healthy crew, and he resolved to accomplish some more work before
returning home. Among other things, he made a survey of the coasts he was now
on. Nothing could be more desolate than those shores. They seemed entirely
composed of rocky mountains, without the least appearance of vegetation, the
mountains terminating in horrible precipices, while their craggy summits shot
up to a vast height. The mountains seen inland were covered with snow, but
those nearer the sea coasts were free from it. The former were supposed to
belong to the mainland of Tierra del Fuego, while the latter were probably
islands.
The ship at length was brought to an anchor, on
December 20, in one of the numerous harbours in which the otherwise
inhospitable-looking coast abounds. This was called Christmas Sound, as the
ship remained at anchor during Christmas Day. An abundance of wild-fowl were
shot here, so that the Christmas fare consisted of roast and boiled geese,
goose pie, goose stew, and goose in every form which could be thought of,
accompanied, in the cabin, by some Madeira, the only article of their
provisions which had improved by keeping.
Some natives made their appearance here in nine
canoes. They were a little, ugly, half-starved, beardless race. They were
almost naked, their clothing being merely two or three seal-skins, sewed
together to form a cloak reaching to the knee. Most of them had only one seal-skin,
and the women had a sort of apron, but in other respects were clothed like the
men. Some young children were seen entirely naked, so that they must be inured
to cold and hardships from their infancy. They had with them bows and arrows,
and darts, or rather harpoons, made of bone, fitted to a staff. These were
probably intended to kill fish and seals, or perhaps whales, as the Esquimaux
do. That they were accustomed to the use of train oil the noses of the officers
had powerful evidence; indeed, it was far from pleasant to approach them. Their
canoes were made of bark, and in each was a fire, round which the women and
children huddled. There was also a large seal-skin, perhaps to form a covering
to a hut on shore. As these people seemed well acquainted with Europeans, it
was considered probable that they moved during the winter more to the
northward. They called themselves Pecheras, at least
that word was continually in their mouths. “Of all the people I have ever seen,
these Pecheras are the most wretched,” says Cook; “they are doomed to live in
one of the most inhospitable climates in the world, without having sagacity
enough to provide themselves with such conveniences as might render life in
some measure more comfortable.” Yet, unattractive as were these people, they
had souls as precious in the sight of a loving Saviour as those of the more
intelligent and attractive inhabitants of Otaheite. It was in the attempt to
carry the glad tidings of salvation to people such as these that the noble-minded
Captain Allan Gardiner lost his life; and it is for the sake of people sunk as
low as were these in the scale of humanity that missionaries are labouring in
many other parts of the earth.
A good supply of wood and water having been obtained
at Christmas Sound, the Resolution got under way again on the 28th, and steered
towards Cape Horn, which she rounded the next morning. She now steered East by
North a half East for the Straits of Le Maire, with a view of looking into
Success Bay, to ascertain if the Adventure had been there. A boat, commanded by
Lieutenant Pickersgill, was sent on shore, but no traces of her were found. A
notice, however, was left nailed to a tree, in case Captain Furneaux should
afterwards touch there. Some natives appeared who behaved very courteously to
Lieutenant Pickersgill, and made signs to him to bring in the ship. The bay was
full of whales and seals; indeed, great numbers had been seen in the straits.
At last, the Resolution came to an anchor near an island, on which seals had been
observed. After dinner three boats were hoisted out and landed with a large
party of men, some to kill seals or sea-lions, and others to kill or catch
birds, fish, or whatever came in their way. The sea-lions, with which the
island was covered, were so unaccustomed to the sight of man that they did not
attempt to escape, and were knocked on the head with sticks and clubs. The only
danger was by getting between them and the water, when, as they came
floundering on, they were likely to knock down and rush over any one thus
placed. A large supply of sea-lions, bears, geese, and ducks was soon obtained.
The old lions were killed solely for the sake of their blubber, from which oil
was extracted, for their flesh was abominable, but that of the cubs was considered
very good, and even that of the lionesses was not
amiss.
Once more, on January 3, 1775, the Resolution was at
sea, steering an easterly course, in search of land said to exist in about the
latitude 53 degrees or 54 degrees. At nine o’clock on the morning of the 13th
land was seen by a man named Willis. At first it was taken for an iceberg, but
on their drawing nearer the appearance changed, and soundings being found, with
a muddy bottom, at one hundred and seventy-five fathoms, there was no doubt that
it was really land, and the name of the discoverer was given to it. Passing
between Willis Island and another islet, called Bird Island, land was seen
extending for a considerable distance. The ship ranged along it, about a league
from the shore, for part of two days, till an inlet appeared, towards which the
ship steered. Instead, however, of the ship going in, a boat was hoisted out,
and the captain, with Mr Forster and others, embarked in her to survey the bay.
They landed in three different places, displayed the British flag, and took
possession of the country in his Majesty’s name, under a discharge of small
arms.
The appearance of the territory thus added to the
dominion of Great Britain was not attractive. The head of the bay, as well as
two portions on either side, consisted of perpendicular ice cliffs of
considerable height. Pieces were continually breaking off and floating out to
sea, and even while they were in the bay huge masses fell which made a noise
like the discharge of a cannon. The inner parts of the country were not less
savage and horrible. Wild rocks raised their lofty summits till they were lost
in the clouds, and even the valleys were covered with everlasting snow. Not a
tree was to be seen, nor even a shrub big enough to
make a toothpick. The only vegetation met with was a coarse, strong-bladed
grass, growing in tufts, wild burnet, and a plant like moss, which sprang from
the rocks.
Seals or sea-bears were pretty numerous, and so were
penguins; some very large, weighing from twenty-nine to thirty-eight pounds,
were brought on board. At first it was hoped that the land now discovered was
part of a great continent, but by going partly round it it was discovered to be
an island of about seventy leagues in circuit, and the name of the Isle of
Georgia was given to it. It seemed to answer very little purpose, for though
the island lies between the latitudes of 54 degrees and 55 degrees, the whole
coast was a mass of ice and snow even in the middle of summer. “The
disappointment I felt did not, I must confess, affect me much,” says Cook, “for
to judge of the bulk by the sample, it would not be worth the discovery.”
Various other islets and rocks were seen, when, believing that no other
discovery of importance would be made thereabouts, on January 25 the Resolution
continued her course, steering east-south-east.
On the 31st several islands and a considerable extent
of land were discovered, to which the name of Sandwich Land, or Southern Thule,
was given, as it was the most southern land then known. It showed a surface of great height, everywhere covered with snow. While the
Resolution was close in with this coast, the wind fell, and left her to the
mercy of a great westerly swell, which set right upon the shore. A line of two
hundred fathoms found no bottom. The weather became hazy; the coast could not
be seen. A most fearful wreck now seemed inevitable, when the fog cleared away,
and a point (Cape Bristol) appeared, bearing east-south-east, beyond which no
land could be seen. This discovery relieved the explorers from the dread of
being carried by the swell on to one of the most horrible coasts in the world.
After undergoing this and similar fearful risks, it was scarcely necessary for
Cook to make any apology for leaving this inhospitable region, and proceeding
in search of the long-sought-for Cape Circumcision. He sailed over and round
the spot where it was said to lie, and became thoroughly convinced that no
cape, indeed no land, lies thereabouts. He was soon sure that if there was land
it would only be a small island, from the long southerly swell which was found
in that latitude.
What we are most struck with is the hardihood and fine
seamanship displayed by Captain Cook and his officers in this run across the
Antarctic Ocean. It was the summer season, and the nights were short; but they
had to encounter storms and bitter cold, ice, and snow, and hail, with the
risk, at any moment, of running on an iceberg or some hidden rock; but still
greater was the risk when such inhospitable shores as those of Tierra del
Fuego, or Staten Island, or the Isle of Georgia, or Southern Thule were to be
explored.
A course was now steered for the Cape of Good Hope,
greatly to the delight of all on board. On March 16 two sails were seen in the
north-west, standing westward, one of them under Dutch colours, a sign that
they were once more approaching civilised regions. In the evening land was
seen. In pursuance of his instructions, the captain now demanded of the
officers and petty officers the log-books and journals which they had kept, and
which were sealed up for the inspection of the Admiralty. The officers and men
were also especially charged not to say where they had been until they had
received the permission of the Lords of the Admiralty.
Several other ships were now met with, one of which
proved to be the True Briton, Captain Broadly, from
China, bound direct home. With that liberality for which commanders of East
India Company’s ships were famed, Captain Broadly sent on board the Resolution
a present of a supply of fresh provisions, tea, and other articles, which were
most acceptable. A heavy gale kept the Resolution from entering the harbour. At
length, however, on Wednesday, March 22, according to the ship’s reckoning, but
with the people on shore Tuesday, the 21st, she anchored in Table Bay. Finding
an East India Company’s ship homeward bound, Captain Cook sent by her a copy of
his journal, charts, and other drawings, to reduce the risk of the result of
his enterprise being lost. He also found here a letter from Captain Furneaux,
from which the mysterious conduct of the natives of Queen Charlotte’s Sound was
completely explained. It was as follows:—On December 17, 1773, the large
cutter, with ten men under charge of Mr Rowe, a midshipman, had been sent on
shore to gather greens for the ship’s company, with orders to return that
evening. On their non-appearance another boat was sent, under the command of
Lieutenant Barney, when the mutilated remains of the cutter’s crew were
discovered, some parts scattered about on the beach, and others carefully
packed with fern leaves, in baskets, evidently intended for the oven. It was
clear that some quarrel had arisen, and that after the unfortunate men had
discharged their muskets they had been clubbed by the natives. It was afterwards
discovered, by the acknowledgment of the natives, that they themselves had been
the aggressors, having stolen some of the seamen’s clothes, and that then they
pretended to make up the quarrel, but that finding the party seated at dinner,
and utterly unsuspicious of evil, they had rushed down on them and killed them
all. After this misfortune the Adventure sailed for the Cape of Good Hope, and
thence returned to England.
Captain Cook speaks of the great courtesy and kindness
he received from the Dutch authorities, as well as from the residents, and of
the abundance of good provisions which he obtained. On April 27, the repairs of
the ship being completed, the Resolution sailed in company with the Dutton,
East Indiaman, for Saint Helena, and was saluted with thirteen guns. She was
also saluted by a Spanish and Danish Indiaman as she passed them—she, of
course, returning the salutes.
At daylight on May 15 the island of Saint Helena was
sighted. It, at that time, belonged to the East India Company, and was laid out
chiefly in pasture, in order that their ships might here obtain supplies of
fresh meat.
The Resolution anchored off Ascension on May 28, and
found some vessels from America come to load with turtle. A good supply was
taken on board, and on the 31st she again sailed. On June 9 the island of
Fernando de Moronha was sighted, and was found to be in possession of the
Portuguese. Without anchoring, the Resolution continued her course for the
Azores, at one of which, Fayal, she anchored on July 13. Among several vessels
there was one belonging to the place, which had taken in a cargo of provisions
at the Amazon, for the Cape de Verde Islands, but had been unable to find
them—a specimen of Portuguese navigation not at all singular even in later
days. The Resolution sailed on the 19th, passing the island of Terceira, and on
the 29th made the land near Plymouth, and the next morning anchored at
Spithead. The same day Captain Cook landed at Portsmouth, with Messrs Wales,
Forster, and Hodges, and set off for London. He had been absent from England
three years and eighteen days, and during that time had lost but four men, and
only one of them by sickness. This was owing, under
Providence, to the very great care taken of the health of the people. All means
were used to induce the crew to keep their persons, hammocks, bedding, and
clothes clean and dry. The ship, once or twice a week, was aired with fires,
and when this could not be done she was smoked with gunpowder mixed with
vinegar and water. There was frequently a fire in an iron pot at the bottom of
the well. The ship’s coppers were kept carefully clean, fresh water being taken
on board whenever practicable. Of remedies against scurvy the sweet-wort was
proved to be most valuable. At the slightest appearance of the disease two or
three pints a day were given to each man. A pound of sour-krout was supplied to
each man, twice a week, at sea. Preparations of potatoes, lemons, and oranges
were served out with good effect. Sugar was found useful, as was wheaten flour,
while oatmeal and oil were considered to promote the scurvy—such oil, at least,
as was served to the Navy. Olive oil would probably have had a different
effect. Captain Cook thus concludes his journal of the voyage:—“But whatever
may be the public judgment about other matters, it is with real satisfaction,
and without claiming any merit but that of attention to my duty, that I can
conclude this account with an observation which facts enable me to make, that
our having discovered the possibility of preserving health amongst a numerous
ship’s company for such a length of time, in such varieties of climate, and
amidst such continued hardships and fatigues, will make this voyage remarkable
in the opinion of every benevolent person, when the disputes about a southern
continent shall have ceased to engage the attention and to divide the judgment
of philosophers.”
In concluding this account of Captain Cook’s second
voyage round the world it is well, while admitting the value of the discoveries
made, and admiring the perseverance and general prudence and kindness of the
discoverer, to express deep regret that the scrupulous and unremitting care
exercised over the physical health of the crew was not, with equal assiduity
and anxiety, manifested in respect of their spiritual health. Those were not
the days in which the souls of sailors were much cared for; but it may be
supposed that the character of this expedition, together with the unusual
number of educated gentlemen on board, furnished facilities for Christian exertion
which certainly were not improved. So far, indeed, as the existing records of
this voyage inform us, we are led to the conclusion that instead of setting an
example of morality and virtue to the ignorant heathen they visited, it would,
in many instances, have been better for the heathen had they never known these
so-called Christians.
Chapter Four.
Third Voyage of
Discovery, from July 1776 to October 1778.
It will be remembered that Captain Cook landed in
England on July 30, 1775. He at once received well-merited acknowledgments of
the services he had rendered to his country. On August 9 he received post rank,
and three days afterwards was nominated a Captain in Greenwich Hospital, an
appointment that would have enabled him to spend the remainder of his days in
honourable retirement. In February of the following year he was elected a
Fellow of the Royal Society; and on the evening of his admission, March 7, a
paper was read, in which he gave a full account of the various means he had
adopted for the preservation of the health of his crew.
The importance of this paper, and the way in which it
was received, will be best understood by those who have read accounts of Lord
Anson’s and other voyages, where the scurvy made fearful havoc among the ship’s
companies. In consequence of this paper, it was resolved by Sir John Pringle,
the President of the Council of the Society, to bestow on Captain Cook the gold
medal known as the Copley Annual Medal, for the best experimental paper of the
year. Cook was already on his third voyage before the medal was bestowed,
though he was aware of the honour intended him; and his wife had the pleasure
of receiving it.
Sir John Pringle’s words are worthy of repetition.
Having pointed out the means by which Captain Cook, with a company of a hundred
and eighteen men, performed a voyage of three years and eighteen days, in all
climates, with the loss of only one man from sickness, he proceeds! “I would
now inquire of those most conversant with the study of the bills of mortality,
whether, in the most healthful climate, and in the best conditions of life,
they have ever found so small a number of deaths within that space of time. How
great and agreeable, then, must our surprise be, after perusing the histories
of long navigations in former days, when so many perished by marine diseases,
to find the air of the sea acquitted of all malignity; and, in fine, that a
voyage round the world may be undertaken with less danger, perhaps, to health,
than a common tour in Europe.” He concludes: “For if Rome decreed the civic
crown to him who saved the life of a single citizen, what wreaths are due to
that man who, having himself saved many, perpetuates in your Transactions the
means by which Britain may now, on the most distant voyages, preserve numbers
of her intrepid sons—her mariners, who, braving every danger, have so liberally
contributed to the fame, to the opulence, and to the maritime empire of their
country?”
This address ought to be read by all British
shipowners and ship-masters. They possess ample means of preventing the
approach of the scurvy, and yet numerous vessels, even at the present day,
return home with a portion of their crews suffering from that fearful scourge.
The masters must exert themselves, must take some trouble in the matter, no doubt;
but if they will not do so, if they will not take an interest in the welfare of
their men, they are unfit to command ships; they are a disgrace to their
honourable profession.
Among those who reached England in the Adventure, with
Captain Furneaux, was Omai, the native of Ulietea. Captain Cook did not approve
at the time of the selection Captain Furneaux had made, as Omai did not belong
to the chiefs, nor to the priestly class, while in
appearance and intelligence he was inferior to many of his countrymen. Oedidee,
who had been received on board the Resolution, had, it will be remembered, been
left behind at Ulietea, Cook fearing that he might have no other opportunity of
restoring the youth to his native island. Both seem to have been inferior to
Tupia, who died at Batavia. However, Omai, as the first native of the South Sea
Islands who had been seen in England, was made a great deal of by people of all
ranks. He was introduced to George the Third, who settled on him a pension
while he remained in England. He had his portrait painted by Sir Joshua
Reynolds, and Cowper mentions him in one of his poems, while he was constantly
in the society of Dr Johnson, Madame d’Arblay, Sir Joseph Banks, Dr Burney,
Lord Sandwich, Lord Mulgrave, Granville Sharpe, and many other illustrious
persons. The power of imitation is strong among his people, and he, therefore,
very quickly copied the manners of the people with whom he associated, and
became, in appearance, a polished gentleman.
He very slowly acquired a knowledge of English; indeed, he always required the aid of signs and gestures to express
himself.
In vain was much trouble expended in trying to teach
him to write, by Mr Sharpe, who also endeavoured, with no better success, to
instruct him in the principles of Christianity. Such
was Omai, a dark-minded savage, amidst civilisation and enlightenment. His
great desire seems to have been to obtain the means of successfully waging war
with the men of Bolabola, of expelling them from Ulietea, and of regaining
possession of his hereditary property. It is with regret that we read this
account of the miserable Omai, when we reflect how eagerly and how thoroughly
many of his fellow-islanders in after years imbibed the principles of the
Christian faith, and how steadfastly they have held to them, in all simplicity
and purity. Had Omai—like the Ethiopian eunuch of other days—but embraced with
all his heart the truths of the Gospel, and returned to his native land,
carrying with him the glad tidings of salvation to his benighted countrymen,
the light of the knowledge of the glory of God might have been spread
throughout the islands of the Pacific even then.
For two centuries a strong desire had existed in
England, among people interested in navigation, to discover a passage by the north-west,
round the coast of North America into the Pacific, so that China and Japan and
the East Indies might be reached by a route shorter than that by the Cape of
Good Hope. All the early expeditions had been undertaken by private enterprise,
to encourage which, an Act of Parliament was passed in 1745, securing a reward
of 20,000 pounds to any ship belonging to any of his Majesty’s subjects, which
should discover the passage. Often was the attempt made by numerous bold
adventurers, from Frobisher, in 1576, onwards to the time of which we are writing. In the middle of the century public interest was
again awakened by the exertions of Mr Dobbs, who was strongly impressed with
the belief that a north-west passage could be found. Captain Middleton was sent
out by Government in 1741, and Captains Smith and Moore in 1746. In 1773, at
the instigation of the Hon. Daines Barrington, an influential member of the
Royal Society, Lord Sandwich sent out Captain Phipps (afterwards Lord Mulgrave)
with the Racehorse and Carcase. Captain Lutwidge commanded the latter vessel,
and had on board a young boy—Nelson, the future naval hero. Captain Phipps
returned, unable to penetrate the wall of ice which barred his progress.
Still, that a passage existed, and might be found, was
the belief of many enlightened men, and the Admiralty came to the resolution of
sending out another expedition, better prepared than former ones to encounter
the difficulties to be met with. Lord Sandwich very naturally desired to have
Captain Cook’s opinion on the subject, and his lordship accordingly invited him
to meet Sir Hugh Palliser, Mr Stephens, and others at dinner, where it might
freely be discussed.
The importance and grandeur of the undertaking, and,
should it be successful, the great advantage it would be to navigation and
science, thus completing the circuit of discoveries made by Cook, were
particularly dwelt on. When it came to the point of fixing on a fit person to
recommend to his Majesty to command the proposed expedition, Captain Cook started
to his feet, and declared that he himself was ready to take the command.
This was probably what Lord Sandwich desired. Cook’s
offer was eagerly accepted, and he was appointed to the command of the
expedition on February 10, 1776. It was arranged that on his return to England
he should be restored to his post at Greenwich. An Act was also at once passed,
by which the officers and ship’s company of any of his Majesty’s ships
discovering the north-west passage would be able to claim the reward of 20,000
pounds offered in 1745 only to persons not in the Royal Navy. The usual plan of
search was to be reversed, and instead of commencing on the Atlantic side of
America, and endeavouring to penetrate into the Pacific, the expedition was to
proceed round Cape Horn, and then sailing north, attempt to work its way
through Behring’s Straits eastward into the Atlantic.
Two vessels were fixed on for the intended service,
the Resolution and the Discovery. The command of the former was given to
Captain Cook, with Mr Gore as his first lieutenant, and of the other to Captain
Clerke, while Lieutenant King went out again as second lieutenant of the
Resolution. He had undertaken to make the necessary astronomical and nautical
observations during the voyage, in conjunction with his captain, and for this
purpose various instruments were entrusted to him.
Mr Bayley was again appointed as astronomer, to sail
on board Captain Clerke’s ship, while Mr Anderson, the surgeon of the
Resolution, took charge of the department of natural history. An artist, Mr
Webber, was selected to sail on board the Resolution, and to make sketches of
any scenes of interest which might be met with.
Every care and attention was paid to the fitting-out
of the ships, and some months passed before they were ready for sea. The
officers of the Resolution were John Gore, James King, and John Williamson,
lieutenants; William Bligh, Master; William Anderson, surgeon; Molesworth
Philips, lieutenant Royal Marines: those of the Discovery were James Burney,
John Rickham, lieutenants; Thomas Edgar, master; John Law, surgeon. The latter
vessel, which had been purchased into the service, was of three hundred tons
burden.
An ample supply of all the articles which past
experience had shown were likely to preserve the health of the crews was put on
board these vessels, as well as an abundance of warm clothing. By desire of the
King, several useful animals, which were to be left at the Society or other
islands, for the benefit of the natives, were embarked, with fodder for their
support. There were two cows and their calves, a bull, and several sheep.
Others were to be purchased at the Cape. The captain was also furnished with a
large variety of European garden seeds, for distribution among the inhabitants
of newly-discovered islands. He received, besides, by order of the Board of
Admiralty, many articles calculated to improve the condition of the natives of
the islands of the Pacific, while, for the purposes of traffic, a large
assortment of iron tools, trinkets, and other articles were sent on board.
Nothing, indeed, was omitted which it was thought likely would benefit the
people to be visited, or would promote the success of the voyage. As it was not
probable that another opportunity would occur of restoring Omai to his native
island, it was settled that he should return in the Resolution. It was supposed
that this semi-civilised, and still heathen, savage had become so impressed
with the grandeur and power of England, and so grateful for the patronage he
had enjoyed and the presents he had received, that he would (as a writer of the
day expresses it) “be rendered an instrument of conveying to the inhabitants of
the Pacific Ocean the most exalted ideas of the greatness and generosity of the
British nation.” How completely these hopes were disappointed the following
narrative will show; nor should we be surprised at
this, when we recollect how entirely superficial were all poor Omai’s
accomplishments. He appears to have learned to play very well at chess; but
that seems to have been the only science in which he attained anything like
proficiency. The truth is, he had been made a lion of, and had been courted and
petted by the rank and fashion of the day. It would not have been surprising if
his head had been turned. Possibly, a man of superior mind or quicker
sensibilities might have been powerfully affected by the same amount of
flattery. On being told that he was to go, he could scarcely refrain from tears
when he spoke of parting from his English friends, but his eyes immediately
sparkled with pleasure when his native islands were mentioned.
Captain Cook received the secret instructions for his
guidance on July 6, 1776. His chief object was to find a passage from the
Pacific into the Atlantic. He was to leave the Cape of Good Hope early in
November, and first to search for certain islands said to have been seen by the
French, south of the Mauritius. He was not to spend much time in looking for
them, nor in examining them if found, but to proceed to Otaheite, touching at
New Zealand, should he consider it necessary to refresh his crews. Thence he
was to proceed direct to the coast of New Albion, avoiding, if possible, any
Spanish settlements; or should it be necessary to touch at any, to take great
care not to excite the jealousy or ill-will of the Spaniards. Arrived in the
Frozen Ocean, he was to examine all channels and inlets likely to lead
eastward, and to take possession of any territory on which he might land, not
before discovered, with the consent of the natives, in the name of the King of
Great Britain. He was to winter at the Russian settlement of Saint Peter and
Saint Paul in Kamtschatka, and to return in the spring to the north. Each ship
was supplied with a small vessel in frame, which was to be set up, if
necessary, to prosecute the search for a passage along the northern coast of
America.
Although numerous expeditions have since been sent
out, they have mostly commenced their operations on the Atlantic side of
America; and it is remarkable that the only successful one, that of Captain
McClure, in the Investigator, and Captain Collinson, in the Enterprise, in the
years 1850-53, entered the Frozen Sea on the Pacific side. Captain McClure had, however, to abandon his ship, and to make the
voyage over the ice, till he could join one of the ships sent up Baffin’s Bay
to his relief; while Captain Collinson, getting his ship free from the ice,
returned westward by the way he had come. The question of a north-west passage
was thus solved in the affirmative; but, unless in some very exceptional case,
it is shown to be impracticable and useless for all commercial purposes. It is
easy to conceive what would have been the fate of Cook’s ships had they
proceeded eastward, and there become beset by the ice.
Captain Cook, with Omai in his company, joined his
ship on June 24, 1776, at Sheerness, and immediately sailed for Plymouth. He
did not leave that port till July 11, and, owing to contrary winds, did not
take his departure from the Scilly Isles till the 16th.
The Discovery remained at Plymouth, Captain Clerke not
having yet arrived on board. He was directed to proceed, as soon as he was
ready for sea, to the Cape of Good Hope, there to join the Resolution. Captain
Cook touched at Teneriffe, where he found an abundance of supplies, and sailed
again on August 4. On the evening of the 10th, Bonavista, one of the Cape de
Verde Islands, was seen bearing south, little more than a league off, though at
the time it was supposed that the ship was at a much greater distance from the
land. Just then breakers were discovered directly under her lee, and for a few
minutes she was in great danger. She happily just weathered them, and stood for
Porto Praya, where it was expected the Discovery might be. As she was not
there, the Resolution did not go in, but continued her course to the Cape. On
September 1 the line was crossed, and the usual ceremonies were observed; on
October 18 the ship anchored in Table Bay. Here arrangements were at once made
to obtain a supply of fresh bread and other provisions, which, as soon as
ready, were conveyed on board, while the tents were set up on shore, and
astronomical observations diligently carried on. Meantime, the ship was
caulked, which she much required. On the evening of the 31st a fearful gale
tore the tents to pieces, and some of the instruments narrowly escaped serious
injury. No communication with the Resolution was possible for those on shore.
She was the only ship in the harbour which rode out
the gale without dragging her anchors.
On November 10 the Discovery entered the bay. She had
sailed on August 1, and would have come in a week sooner but had been blown off
the coast by the late gale. She also required caulking, which detained the
expedition some time.
On November 30 the two ships sailed together. The
Resolution had now on board, in addition to her former stock of animals, two
bulls and two heifers, two horses and two mares, two rams, several ewes and
goats, and some rabbits and poultry—all of them intended for New Zealand,
Otaheite, and the neighbouring islands, or other places where there might be a
prospect of their proving useful. The course steered was about south-east.
Before long a heavy squall carried away the Resolution’s mizzen-topmast; and a
mountainous sea made the ship roll so much that it was with difficulty the
animals on board could be preserved. Owing to this, and to the cold, several
goats and sheep died.
On December 12 two islands were seen about five
leagues apart. These, with four others which lie in the same latitude, about nine
degrees of longitude more to the east, were discovered by two French navigators
in 1772. Cook now bestowed the name of Prince Edward’s Island on the two he had
just discovered, and those of the French officers on the four others. They were
mostly covered with snow, and where the ground seemed free from it lichen or a
coarse grass was the only herbage.
On leaving Prince Edward’s Island a course was shaped
to fall in with Kerguelen’s Land. On the evening of the 24th an island of
considerable height and the next day other islands were seen. As the ships
ranged along the coast a terrific sea rolled in on the shore, placing them in
great danger, and both had considerable difficulty in weathering the points and
reefs they met with. Though it was midsummer the weather was as cold as it is
generally during the winter in the British Channel. At last a harbour was
discovered, into which the ships beat and found good anchorage, an abundance of
water, innumerable penguins and other birds, as also seals, which were so
unacquainted with human beings that they allowed themselves to be knocked on
the head without attempting to escape. The casks were immediately landed to be
filled up with water, while a supply of seals was secured for the sake of their
oil. Not a tree nor shrub was to be found in this
inhospitable region. A bottle was brought to Captain Cook, containing a
document left by Kerguelen, who had discovered this land at the end of 1773,
and had taken possession of it in the name of the King of France. The harbour
in which the ships lay was called Christmas Harbour, in commemoration of the
day on which they entered it. The ships left this harbour on the morning of the
28th, and continued to range along the coast, in order to discover its position
and extent. They brought up in another harbour just in time to escape a heavy
gale, and then proceeded to the south, towards Cape George, to determine the
shape of the land. On finally leaving it, on December 30, the ships steered
east-by-north for New Zealand. Captain Cook came to the conclusion that the
land he had just left was a large island, seventy or eighty miles from north to
south, and a much greater distance from east to west. Captain Furneaux had, in
1773, passed across the meridian of this land, only seventeen leagues to the
south of Cape George, thus settling the point of its being an island.
It seems to have been a mistake to send the ships into
these inclement regions with cattle on board, as many died, among them two
young bulls and a heifer, two rams, and several more of the goats.
The weather continued so thick that for many days
together the ships did not see each other, though by constantly firing guns
they managed to keep in company. At length Captain Cook determined to put into
Adventure Bay, in Van Diemen’s Land, where Captain Furneaux had touched on the
former voyage. The land was made on January 24, and on the 26th the ships
brought up in the bay. They expected to obtain a supply of wood for fuel, and
of grass for the cattle, of which they stood greatly in need. A supply of fish
was caught, and plenty of grass brought on board. While the party
on shore were cutting wood some natives appeared. They came forward with
perfect confidence, only one having a lance in his hand. They were entirely
without clothes, their skin and hair black, their stature about the ordinary
height, their figures rather slender. Their features were not disagreeable, as
they had neither very thick lips nor flat noses, while their eyes and teeth
were good. Most of them had their heads and beards smeared with a red ointment,
while some had their faces painted with the same composition. They seemed
indifferent to all the presents offered them; even bread and fish they threw
away, till some birds were given them, at which they expressed their
satisfaction.
A boar and sow had been landed for the purpose of
being left in the woods, but no sooner did the natives see them than they
seized them by the ears, evidently with the intention of carrying them off and
killing them. Captain Cook, wishing to know the use of the stick one of them
carried, the native set up a mark and threw his stick at it. He missed it,
however, so often, that Omai, to show the superiority of the white men’s arms,
fired his musket. This very naturally made the whole party
ran off, and drop some axes and other things which had been given to
them. They ran towards where the Adventure’s people were cutting wood, when the
officer, not knowing their intention, fired a musket over their heads, which
sent them off altogether. The boar and sow were carried to a thick wood at the
head of the bay, where it was hoped that they would conceal themselves and
escape the natives; but some cattle which it had been intended to leave there
were returned on board, as it was clear that the natives would immediately kill
them.
A calm kept the ships in
harbour, and the next day, notwithstanding the fright which the natives had
received, a party of twenty or more, men and boys, made their appearance. Among
them was one terribly deformed, who seemed to be the acknowledged wit of the
party, as he and his friends laughed heartily at the remarks he made, and
seemed surprised that the English did not do the same. Their language was
different from that of the tribes met with in the north. Some of these people
had bands of fur passed several times round their necks, and others of
kangaroo-skin round their ankles. They seemed to be unacquainted with fishing,
by the way they looked at the English fish-hooks, and their rejection of the
fish offered them; though near their fires quantities of mussel shells were
found, showing that they lived partly on shell-fish. Their habitations were
mere sheds of sticks covered with bark, and there were indications of their
taking up their abodes in trees hollowed out by fire or decay. From the marks
of fires it was evident that they cooked their food, but they did not appear to
have the slightest notion of cultivating the land. The people here described
have disappeared from the face of the earth. The last remnant, who had become
exceedingly ferocious and mischievous, were collected and carried to an island
in Bass’s Straits, where they were allowed to roam at large, it having been
found impossible to tame them. It is believed that they finally died out. Mr
Anderson records the beauty of the scenery and of the climate, though he
remarks that not one single natural production could be found fit for the food
of man.
The ships left Adventure Bay on January 30, when soon
afterwards the mercury in the barometer fell, and a furious gale began to blow
from the south. At the same time the heat became almost insupportable, the
mercury in the thermometer rising from 70 degrees to near 90 degrees. This high
temperature, however, did not last long.
On February 12 the ships anchored in Queen Charlotte’s
Sound. That no time might be lost, the tents for the observatory, with the
usual guard and the water-casks, were landed, and operations were immediately
commenced. Before long several canoes came alongside, but few of the people in
them would venture on board, the greater part being evidently afraid that the
English would punish them for their murder of the Adventure’s people. Captain
Cook recognised several of those with whom he was well acquainted during his
former visits. They must also have seen Omai, and remembered that he was on
board the Adventure at the time, and thus known that Captain Cook could no
longer have been ignorant of what had occurred. He, however, did his best to
make them understand that he was not come to punish them for that act, and that
he wished to be friends with them as before. In consequence of this the natives
very soon laid aside restraint and distrust. After the fearful experience he
had had of their treachery, however, the captain took extra precautions to
prevent a surprise. While the people were engaged in their various occupations
on shore, a guard was posted for their protection, while all the men worked
with their arms by their sides, Mr King and two or three petty officers being
constantly with them. No boat was sent to a distance unless well armed, and
under charge of an officer who could be depended on. Captain Cook thinks that
the precautions were probably unnecessary though he felt it his duty to take
them. The natives showed no fear, and came and built their huts close to the
ship, and many employed themselves in fishing, exchanging the fish they caught
for the usual articles of barter.
Besides the natives who settled near them, chiefs from
other parts frequently visited the ship. Among them came a chief called
Kahoora, who was pointed out as the leader of those who attacked the crew of
the Adventure’s boat, and was said actually to have killed Mr Rowe, the officer
in command. Greatly to the surprise of the natives, as also to that of Omai,
who entreated that he might at once be killed, Captain Cook declined seizing
him, saying that he had granted an amnesty, and that no one should be punished.
Kahoora, trusting to the captain’s promise, came frequently on board, though by thus doing he placed himself entirely in
the hands of the English. Once only, when Omai accused him in the cabin of
having killed Mr Rowe, he hung down his head and folded his arms, expecting
instant death, but was soon reassured by the captain, who told him that he
wished to forget the circumstance, though should a similar one occur the
natives must expect the fearful vengeance of the English. He says that had he
listened to the suggestions and requests of the chiefs and others to kill their
enemies, he should soon have extirpated the whole race. In no country could
life be much more insecure. Tribes, and even families living in the same
neighbourhood, were constantly fighting with each other, and war was carried on
with the utmost cruelty and ferocity. If a man was unable to revenge an injury
inflicted on himself or any member of his family, it was the duty of his son to
take up the quarrel, and often many years elapsed before an opportunity
occurred of wreaking his long-delayed vengeance. When such an opportunity arrived
he and his companions stole on their unsuspecting enemies in the night, and if
they found them unguarded they killed every one indiscriminately, not even
sparing women or children. When the massacre was completed they either made a
horrid banquet of the slain on the spot, or carried off as many dead bodies as
they could, and devoured them at home, with acts of brutality too shocking to
be described. As they never gave quarter nor took prisoners the defeated party
could only save their lives by flight. More powerful chiefs made war in the
same barbarous way, on a larger scale, and depopulated whole districts if the
people offended them. On the introduction of firearms the bloody work went on
with still greater rapidity. In the time of George the Fourth a chief who was
taken to England and received at Buckingham Palace, and was looked upon as a
highly civilised person, on his return exchanged at Sydney all the articles
which had been given him for firearms and ammunition, and immediately commenced
a war of extermination against all the surrounding tribes, and feasted without
scruple on the bodies of his foes. It is not surprising that, under such
circumstances, two-thirds of the inhabitants of New Zealand have been, within
the last century, swept away by warfare. The process of extermination had,
indeed, commenced long before Cook visited those shores, and it would probably
ere now have completed its ravages had not the Christian Church been roused to
a sense of its responsibilities, and conveyed to New Zealand, as to other
lands, the knowledge of Him who teaches us by His Word and Spirit to love our
enemies, to bless those who curse us, and to do good to those who despitefully
use us and persecute us.
The wandering propensities of the New Zealanders were
shown by the desire expressed by several youths of embarking on board the
ships. One, named Taweiharooa, eighteen years of age, the son of a dead chief,
was selected to accompany Omai, who had been desirous of having a companion.
That Taweiharooa might be sent off in a way becoming his rank, a boy, Kokoa, of
about ten years of age, to act as his servant, was presented by his own father
with as much indifference as he would have parted with a dog. It was clearly
explained to the youths that they would probably never return to their native
country, but, as Cook observes, so great was the insecurity of life in New
Zealand at that time, that he felt no compunction in the matter, as the lads
could scarcely fail to improve their lot by the change.
The ships left Queen Charlotte’s Sound on February 25.
No sooner had they lost sight of land than the New Zealand adventurers were
seized with sea-sickness, which, giving a turn to their thoughts, made them
bitterly lament what they had done, while they expressed their feelings in a
sort of song which they continued to sing till they got better. By degrees
their lamentations ceased, and in a short time their native country and friends
seemed to be forgotten, and they appeared as firmly attached to their new
friends as if they had been born among them.
On March 29, 1777, the Discovery made the signal of
land in the north-east. It was soon found to be an island of no great extent,
and the night was spent standing off and on, in the hope that the next day a
landing-place might be found. No landing nor anchorage, however, appeared practicable, on account of the heavy surf which
broke everywhere, either against the island or the reef which surrounded it.
Before long a number of people appeared on the shore or wading to the reef, most
of them nearly naked, except the usual girdle, brandishing spears and clubs.
Some of them had mantles of native cloth over their shoulders, and turbans or
wrappers round their heads. After a time a canoe was launched, and came off
with two natives to the ship. When presents were offered, they asked for some
for their Eatooa before they would accept any for themselves. Omai spoke to
them in the tongue of Otaheite, which they perfectly understood. The principal
man said that his name was Monrooa, and that the island was called Mangaia. His
colour was that of most southern Europeans; he was stout and well made, and his
features were agreeable. The other man was not so good-looking. Both of them
had strong, straight black hair, tied at the crown of the head. They wore
sandals, to protect their feet from the coral rocks.
The men would not venture on board, but when the boats were lowered and stood towards the shore to find a landing-place, Monrooa stepped into Captain Cook’s of his own accord, and took his seat by his side. No landing could be found without the risk of swamping the boats; they therefore returned, and Monrooa came on board. He was, evidently, too anxious about his safety to ask questions. At last he stumbled over one of the goats, when he inquired eagerly of Omai what strange bird that was! The boat conveyed him just outside the surf, when he leaped overboard and swam through it, his countrymen being seen eagerly gathering round him to receive accounts of what he had seen. Cook says he left that fine island with regret, as it seemed capable of supplying all their wants. Mangaia was left on March 30, and the next day, at
noon, two islands were seen—a large and a small one. The following day the
shore of the larger island was reached, and boats at once put off to try and
find a landing-place. At the same time several canoes came from the shore, with
one man in each. The natives stepped on board without showing fear, but seemed
to value very little any of the gifts bestowed on them. After the first party
had gone, a man arrived in a canoe, bringing a bunch of plantains as a present
to Captain Cook, whose name he had learned from Omai. This present had been
sent by the principal chief. The bearer went away, well contented, with an axe
and a piece of red cloth. Not long after a double canoe approached the
Resolution, with twelve men in her, who chanted in chorus, and when their song
was finished they came alongside and asked for the chief. On the captain’s
showing himself a pig and some cocoanuts were handed up the side, and the
natives coming on board presented some pieces of matting in addition. Though
the natives expressed surprise at some of the things they saw, nothing seemed
to fix their attention. They were afraid of the horses and cows, and inquired,
when they saw the goats, as the native of Mangaia had done, what sort of birds
they were.
The following day Mr Gore and Mr Barney, with Mr
Anderson and Omai, went on shore in hope of obtaining food for the cattle. The
boats approached the surf, when some canoes came off and took the party through
it. The day passed on, and as they did not return Captain Cook became somewhat
uneasy; his only comfort being that the natives continued to come off to the
ship as before, bringing cocoanuts, and taking anything given them in return.
Late in the day the boats returned; it then appeared that the party had been
conducted, amid a vast crowd, up an avenue of cocoa palms, till they reached a
body of men drawn up in two rows, armed with clubs resting on their shoulders.
In the middle row was a chief, sitting cross-legged on the ground, and having
bunches of red feathers in his ears. They were then introduced to two other
chiefs, one, though a young man, excessively corpulent, also distinguished by
the red feathers, and they were then entertained by a dance, performed by
twenty girls, all of whom wore red feathers. The dancers did not leave the spot
where they stood, for though their feet moved up and down the dance consisted
of various motions of the body and hands. The visitors were next entertained by
a sham fight between the men armed with clubs. They now found themselves
separated from each other, and pressed on by the crowd, while they had their
pockets picked of every article they possessed, the chiefs not interfering.
Their position was sufficiently embarrassing, for whenever they tried to get
back to the boats they were stopped. Omai, meantime, who was by himself,
surrounded by a crowd of natives, and equally anxious with the rest, described,
in exaggerated terms, the power of the English guns, which, he affirmed, could
blow the whole island to pieces. He had some cartridges in his pocket, and to
prove his assertion he let several of them off together. The sudden flash and
report seem to have produced a great effect on the minds of the natives, as the party were sent off with a large supply of cooked
plantains as a gift; and a bag containing a pistol, which Mr Anderson
particularly required, was restored.
Omai found on this island three of his own countrymen
who had arrived there, eleven years before, in a canoe. They were the survivors
of a party of twenty persons who had been driven before the wind from Otaheite,
distant at least two hundred leagues. They declined a passage offered to them
to return to their native island. The circumstance was interesting as giving an
example of the way the islands of the Pacific have been peopled. The name of
this island was Wateeoo. The language was equally well understood by Omai and
the two New Zealanders.
Though the visit was an interesting one, the chief
object in calling off the island (that of procuring provender for the cattle)
was not attained, as nothing was sent off. From the small island which had been seen three days before, and to which the
ships now steered, all that was required was obtained, consisting of grass and
leaves of young cocoanut trees and of the pandanus. Though the island, called
Ota Kootaia, was uninhabited, still, as it was occasionally visited by the
natives of the neighbouring island, Mr King left an axe and some nails in
payment for what he took away.
Captain Cook next sailed for Hervey Island, which he
had supposed, when he discovered it in 1773, to be uninhabited. As he now
approached, however, a number of canoes came off, but the people on board
behaved in a very wild and disorderly manner. They were of a darker colour than
the neighbouring islanders, and of a fiercer expression of countenance. As no
anchorage was found for the ships they stood away for Palmerston’s Island,
which was found to be thickly covered with cocoanut trees, pandanus, cabbage
palm, and grass. The ships stood off and on for three days, while four or five
boats’ crews were busily employed in cutting food for the cattle, and in
collecting two thousand cocoanuts for the crews of the two ships. On leaving
Palmerston’s Island a course was steered for Annamook, and on the night between
April 24 and 25, Savage Island was passed.
On the evening of the 28th the ships anchored off
Komango, and the next morning canoes came off with all sorts of provisions. Mr
King, who went on shore, was treated very civilly by the inhabitants, and by
two chiefs, Taipa and Toobou. As it was important to find a good harbour, and
no other, after two days’ search, having been discovered, Captain Cook came to
anchor in the spot where he had been three years before. Here the chief Toobou
received him, and offered a boat, and also a house to serve as a tent; at the
same time he promptly selected a spot where the observatories might be set up
and other arrangements made. He conducted the captain and Omai to his house.
Round it was a fine grass-plot, which he explained was for the purpose of
enabling people to clean their feet before entering the house. The floor was
covered with mats, and no carpet in an English drawing-room could be kept
cleaner. Taipa, the chief, who had been among the first to introduce himself,
that he might be close to his new friends, had a house brought on men’s
shoulders, full a quarter of a mile, and placed near the shed they occupied.
The greatest man, however, had not as yet appeared, and on May 6 a chief
arrived, it was understood, from Tongataboo, who was introduced by Taipa as
Feenou, King of all the Friendly Islands. That he was of great power there
could be no doubt, as the natives ordered out to meet him bowed their heads as
low as his feet, the soles of which they touched, first with the palm, and then
with the back of each hand. He appeared to be about thirty years of age, tall,
but thin, and had more of the European features than any native of the South
Seas yet met with. He showed his power by recovering a large axe which had been
stolen out of the ship. The people of these islands were great thieves; even
the chiefs stole. One was caught, when he was sentenced to receive a dozen
lashes, and was not set free till he had paid a hog for his liberty. This put a
stop to the practice among the chiefs.
At Feenou’s invitation Captain Cook agreed to go to
Hapaee. During the passage the great chief came on board and remained all day,
but in the evening took his departure with Omai, while the ship remained under
sail in a somewhat perilous position, no anchorage having been found. Several
times during the day the smoke from the burning mountain of Toofoa was seen; at
night the flames were observed bursting forth, but to no great height.
Hapaee consists of four islands, of inconsiderable
elevation. Immediately the ships came to an anchor, on the 17th, they were
crowded with natives, who brought off all sorts of provisions. A house had been
brought down to the beach, and on Captain Cook’s going on shore, he and Omai,
with Feenou, took their seats within it, the other chiefs and people forming a
circle outside. Feenou then directed Taipa to proclaim to the people that the
strangers were going to remain five days, and that they were to bring hogs,
fowls, and fruit to the ships; that they were not to steal, but to behave in
every way politely and courteously. After this, it was suggested by Taipa that
a present should be made to Earoupa, the chief of the island.
Omai seems to have been greatly taken with Feenou, and
scarcely ever quitted him. The next day this chief came off, requesting the
captain’s presence on shore, when a hundred men appeared, laden with
bread-fruit, plantains, yams, cocoanuts, and sugar-canes, with several pigs and
fowls, and two turtles, which were deposited in two heaps, Earoupa seating
himself near one heap, and another chief near the other. A number of men then
appeared, armed with clubs made out of the green branches of the cocoanut tree.
They formed two parties, and numerous single combats took place, the victors
being highly applauded by the spectators. These were succeeded by wrestling and
boxing matches, much in the English fashion. In the latter several young women
took part. One of the first pair gave in within a minute, but the second fought
on till separated by two old women. The greatest good humour prevailed,
however, though many severe blows were received. Feenou now explained that
one-third of the presents were for Omai, and the others for Captain Cook, who
made the handsomest returns he could. There was enough to fill four boats;
indeed, no chief in any part had ever made a present at all equal to it.
At the desire of the chief the marines were exercised
on shore, and in return a sort of dance was performed by a hundred and five
men, who had each a paddle in his hand. Nothing could exceed the beautiful
precision and the variety of graceful movements of the performers. When it grew
dark their visitors greatly pleased the natives by a display of fireworks.
After this the people collected in an open space among the trees, where a
circle was formed by lights, and just outside the circle a number of dances
were performed, some by men, and others by women, many of the principal people
taking a part. The performances appear to have been very graceful and perfect
in every way, the natives evidently priding themselves on them.
Making an excursion on shore, Captain Cook formed a
high opinion of the state of cultivation of Lifooga. On his return on board he
found a large double canoe, with the silent chief who had been met with at
Tongataboo, and was supposed to be the king of the island. Feenou was on board,
but neither great man took the slightest notice of the other. Feenou now
announced that business required his absence, and begged Captain Cook to await
his return. He had not been gone long when a large sailing-canoe arrived, in
which was a person named Poulaho, and whom the natives
on board affirmed to be the real King of Tongataboo and of all the neighbouring
islands. He was a sensible, sedate man, enormously fat, and about forty years
of age. He was, of course, invited into the cabin, but his attendants observed
that that could not be. On this the captain sent Omai to say that he would give
directions that no one should approach the part of the deck above the cabin.
The king, however, settled the question by going below without making any
stipulation. Omai seemed much disappointed at discovering that the chief he had
taken to be king was no king after all. Feenou was, however, a very powerful
chief, generalissimo of the army, and head of the police of all the islands, so
that he was held in general awe.
The king was much pleased with the presents he
received, and when he went on shore ordered two more hogs to be sent off, in
addition to two he had brought with him. On landing he was taken up to the
house erected for his accommodation, on a board resembling a hand-barrow. On
Feenou’s return he looked rather confused on finding that the king had paid the
voyagers a visit; and he then acknowledged who and what he really was. After
this, on one occasion, Poulaho and Feenou accompanied the captain on board.
Feenou, however, did not presume to sit with the king, but, saluting his foot
with head and hands, retired out of the cabin. It appeared, indeed, that he
declined to eat and drink in the royal presence, though there were persons of
much inferior rank who did so.
At the request of Poulaho the captain paid a visit to
Tongataboo, where the ships were in considerable danger of driving on a low,
sandy island, but escaped. At Tongataboo the English were entertained much in
the same way that they had been at Hapaee.
The king had a son, Fattafaihe, to whom great respect
was paid. His mother was the daughter of an old chief, of large possessions and
great influence, called Mareewagee, and Feenou was his son. That chief was,
therefore, brother-in-law to the king, and uncle to the heir-apparent.
On June 19 Captain Cook invited the chiefs and others
to a meeting, that he might present them with the
animals he proposed to leave on the island. To the king, Poulaho, he gave a
young English bull and cow; to Mareewagee, a Cape ram and two ewes; and to
Feenou, a horse and mare; and he instructed Omai to explain their use, and that
they must be careful not to injure them, but to let them increase till they had
stocked the island. Some goats and rabbits were also added. It soon appeared,
however, that the chiefs were dissatisfied with this allotment, and early next
morning it was found that a kid and two turkey-cocks were missing. On this the
captain put a guard over the king, Feenou, and some other chiefs, whom he found
in the house which the English occupied on shore, and told them that they should
not be liberated till the animals and other articles lately stolen had been
restored. On the captain inviting them to go on board to dinner they readily
consented. Some objected to the king’s going, but he jumped up and said that he
would be the first to go. They were kept on board till four, and on their
return on shore the kid and one of the turkey-cocks were brought back, and the
other was promised the next day. After this a party of officers from both ships
made an excursion into the interior, with muskets and ammunition, and a number
of articles for barter, but the natives stripped them of everything. The
officers made application, through Omai, for restitution, and this caused the
king, Feenou, and other chiefs hastily to go off. Omai, however, persuaded
Feenou that nothing would be done to them, when he, and afterwards the king,
returned, and were apparently on as good terms as ever.
Captain Cook even ventured to attend a grand ceremony,
held for the purpose of introducing the young prince to certain royal
privileges, the principal of which was to be that of eating in the society of
his father. There seemed to be great distinctions of rank among the people.
There were some who had greater honour shown to them than even to the king
himself. His father had an elder sister, of equal rank to himself, and she
married a chief who came from Fejee. By him she had a son, the silent chief
Latoolibooloo, who was looked upon as a madman, and two daughters. The king met
one of these women on board the Resolution, and would not venture to eat in her
presence. On afterwards encountering Latoolibooloo, the king bent down and
touched the silent prince’s feet with the back and palms of his hand, as he was
accustomed to be treated by his subjects.
Captain Cook here observed the taboo system. If
applied to places, they may not be entered or approached; if to persons, they
may not be touched, or may not feed themselves; if to things, they may not be
touched. The system, however, did not appear to be so rigidly observed in Tonga
as in some other groups of the Pacific.
With regard to the religion of the people, Captain
Cook gained very little information, and Omai, who seems to have been
especially dull of apprehension, and never to have made inquiries of his own
accord, was very little able to help him. That great cruelty was exercised by
those in authority was evident by two or three occurrences witnessed by the
English. On one occasion, when Feenou was on board the Resolution, an inferior
chief ordered all the people to retire from the post occupied on shore by the
English. Some ventured to return, when the chief took up a stick and beat them
most unmercifully. He struck one man with so much violence on the side of the
face that the blood gushed out of his month and nostrils, and after lying for
some time motionless he was removed in convulsions. The chief laughed when told
that he had killed the man, and seemed perfectly indifferent to the matter.
All classes, from the highest to the lowest, were
found to be thieves; and when the chiefs themselves did not steal they employed
their servants to pilfer for them. To check this propensity Captain Clerke
suggested a plan, which was adopted with good effect. Whenever any of the lower
orders were caught stealing he had their heads completely shaved, so that they
became objects of ridicule to their countrymen, and did not again venture on
board the ships.
It appeared that the larger portion of the land
belonged to certain great chiefs, and that the inferior chiefs held their
estates under them, while the mass of the population were mere serfs, who
tilled the soil for their masters, and received but a scanty remuneration for
their labour.
Captain Cook heard of the Fejee Islands, distant about
three days’ sail, and of the savage and cannibal propensities of the
inhabitants, some of whom he saw at Tonga. The inhabitants of Tonga held them
in great dread, on account of their prowess in war, and always endeavoured to
keep on friendly terms with them. He concluded that the Friendly Islanders had
not, till lately, kept up any intercourse with those of Fejee, because dogs,
which are very common in the latter group, had only been introduced into Tonga
since his last visit, and to none of the other islands.
All was ready for sailing, when the king invited
Captain Cook and his officers to the ceremony which has already been mentioned,
and which took place at Mooa, where the king resided. During its performance
they had to sit, as did the natives, with their shoulders bare, their hair
hanging down loose, their eyes cast down, and their hands locked together. None
but the principal people, and those who assisted at the celebration, were
allowed to be present. These circumstances, Captain Cook says, were sufficient
evidence to him that the people considered themselves as acting under the
immediate inspection of a Supreme Being. He was told that in about three months
there would be performed, on the same account, a far grander solemnity, on
which occasion not only the tribute of Tongataboo, but that of Hapaee, Vavaoo,
and of all the other islands, would be brought to the chief, and ten human
beings from among the inferior sort of people would be sacrificed to add to its
dignity: “a significant instance,” Captain Cook remarks, “of the influence of
gloomy and ignorant superstition over the minds of one of the most benevolent
and humane nations upon earth.” King Poulaho warmly pressed his guests to
remain, that they might witness a funeral ceremony, which was to take place the
next day.
During their stay in the island they had suffered from
a succession of violent storms. The wind raged fearfully amongst the forest
trees, the rain fell in torrents, the lightning flashed, and the thunder pealed
with an awful fury of which we, in these more temperate regions, have little
idea. Now, however, the wind had become fair and moderate; Captain Cook and his
officers, therefore, hurried on board, and as soon as possible the ships got
under way. As, however, they could not get to sea before it was dark, they had
to bring up for the night under Tongataboo. The next day they reached Eooa,
where the English were well received by Captain Cook’s former acquaintance, the
chief of the island, Taoofa, or, as he then called him, Tioony. An abundant
supply of yams and a few hogs were obtained, and the ram and two ewes of the
Cape of Good Hope breed of sheep were entrusted to the chief, who seemed proud
of his charge.
Captain Cook made an excursion into the interior, and
as he surveyed, from an elevation to which he had ascended, the delightful
prospect before him, “I could not,” he says, “help flattering myself with the
pleasing idea that some future navigator may, from the same station, behold
these meadows stocked with cattle, brought to these islands by the ships of
England; and that the completion of this high benevolent purpose, independently
of all other considerations, would sufficiently mark to posterity that our
voyages had not been useless to the general interests of humanity.” The great
navigator here gives utterance to the genuine feelings of his heart, for such
were undoubtedly the principles which animated him. He little dreamed that
those friendly natives, of whom he had thought so highly, and whom he had
praised as among the most humane people on earth, had, headed by Feenou, laid a
plot for his destruction, and that of all his followers. Providentially, the
conspirators could not agree as to the mode of proceeding; but all were equally
eager to possess themselves of the stores of wealth the ships were supposed to
contain. Probably Feenou’s pretended friendship for the foolish Omai was in the
hope that he would thus have a ready tool in his hands. He had offered to make
Omai a great chief if he would remain in Tonga, but Cook advised him not to
accept the offer.
Captain Cook had settled to sail on July 15, but,
pressed by Taoofa, who promised more presents, he consented to remain a couple
of days. During this period a seaman was surrounded by a number of people, and,
being knocked down, had every particle of clothing torn from his back; but, by
seizing on a couple of canoes and a fat hog, the English obtained the
restoration of some of the articles.
The captain kept to his purpose of sailing, but when
still not far from the land a canoe with four men came off, saying that orders
had been sent to the people of Eooa to supply the ships with fat hogs, and that
if they would return to their former station the king and a number of chiefs
would, in a couple of days, be with them. As, however, there was an abundant
supply of provisions on board, Captain Cook declined the offer, and continued
his coarse.
It is scarcely necessary to remind the reader that
more fearful massacres of the crews of various ships were perpetrated by the
inhabitants of these islands than by any other natives of the Pacific, from the
time of the visit just recorded till they were formed into a civilised
community under their present government.
After the ships had left the Tonga group they did not
see land till August 8, when they fell in with a small island, having on it
hills of considerable elevation, covered with grass; tall trees, and numerous
plantations on a border of flat land, ran quite round it, edged with a white
sandy beach. A number of people were on the shore, and two canoes came off with
a dozen men in them, but could not be persuaded, by all Omai’s eloquence, to
venture alongside. They spoke the language of Otaheite, and called their island
Toobouai. It was at this island that Christian and the mutineers of the Bounty
tried to form a settlement, in 1789. It is the scene, also, of Lord Byron’s
poem of “The Island,” though he altered the name to Toobouia. Some of the
people were dressed in native cloth, but the great mass had only girdles. One
continued to blow a conch-shell most of the time the ships lay off their
island, while his companions made signs, inviting the strangers to land. It is
worthy of remark that no weapons were seen among them.
On the 12th Maitea was seen, and soon after Otaheite
hove in sight, and the next day the ships anchored in the Bay of Oheitepeha.
Some common people came off in canoes, but Omai took no notice of them, and
they did not seem to recognise him as a countryman. At length his
brother-in-law, Ootee, appeared, but there was no exhibition of regard or
affection till Omai took the other into the cabin and showed him the drawers in
which he kept his red feathers. This instantly changed the face of affairs, and
Ootee begged that they might be tayos, and change names.
Soon after the ships anchored Omai’s sister came on
board, and the meeting was marked with expressions of the most
tender affection, evidently not feigned. Afterwards, on going ashore
with Captain Cook, Omai met a sister of his mother. “She threw herself at his
feet, and bedewed them plentifully with tears of joy,” says the captain,
adding, “I left him with the old lady, in the midst of a number of people who
had gathered round him.”
Cook found that since his last visit two Spanish ships
had twice visited the bay; that a house had been built, and that several persons
had been left in the interval, of whom some had died, and the rest went away
when the ships came back. They had presented the islanders with a bull, some
hogs, goats, and dogs, and had taken away four people, two of whom died, and
two came back from a place which Cook conjectured to be Lima. The house, which
stood close to the beach, was made of planks, and as these were all numbered
they had evidently been brought ready to be set up. It was divided into two
small rooms, and in the inner one were a bedstead, a table, a bench, some old
hats, and other trifles, of which the natives seemed to be very careful, as
also of the house itself, which had suffered no hurt from the weather, a shed
having been built over it. There were scuttles all round which served as
air-holes, and perhaps they were intended to fire from with musketry, should it
have become necessary. At a little distance from the front stood a wooden
cross, on the transverse part of which was only the inscription Christus
vincit, and on the perpendicular part Carolus Tertius, imperat 1774.
On the other side of the post Cook preserved the memory of the prior visits of
the English by inscribing, Georgius Tertius, Rex, Annis 1767, 1769,
1773, 1774, and 1777. The natives pointed out the grave of the commodore of the
two ships who died there during their first visit.
The expeditions of the Spaniards to Otaheite and the
neighbouring islands had been undertaken in consequence of the jealousy of the
Spanish Government at the visits of the English to the South Seas. The first
was under the command of Don Domingo Bonechea, in the Aguila frigate, in 1772.
He gave so favourable a report of the islands that he was again sent out in
1774, having on board two monks of the order of Saint Francis, a linguist, a portable
house, sheep, cattle, and implements. Having landed them at Oheitepeha Bay, as
soon as the house was up he set sail to make further discoveries. He then
returned to the bay, and six days afterwards died, and was buried, with
becoming ceremonies, at the foot of the cross, which was erected with great
pomp, amid the chanting of masses and the discharge of musketry.
In 1775 a third visit was paid by the Aguila, sent
from Callao, to ascertain the fate of the missionaries. They were found to be
utterly disappointed, and determined to abandon their task, having made no
progress in the conversion of the natives, and were so alarmed at the human
sacrifices constantly taking place that they would only consent to remain under
the protection of a Spanish garrison.
In God’s providence, the people of Otaheite were
destined to receive, from Protestant missionaries, a simpler and purer faith
than that taught by the priests of Rome. To that faith they have held fast, in
spite of all the efforts and machinations of the Romanists.
While in this bay, as an abundant supply of cocoanuts
could be obtained, Captain Cook proposed to his crew that, as it was important
they should economise their spirits, they should give up their grog, except on
Saturday nights, and drink cocoanut milk instead. To this, without a moment’s
hesitation, they consented, as did Captain Clerke’s crew. On their first
arrival in this place red feathers were looked on as of great value, but as
everybody had them on board they soon became a drug in the market. Poor Omai
began very soon to exhibit his want of judgment. He had prepared a crown or cap
of yellow and red feathers for Otoo, the king of all the islands, which the
captain recommended him to present himself. Instead of so doing, his vanity
induced him to exhibit it before Waheiadooa, the chief of that part, who
thereupon kept the crown himself and sent only a few tufts to the king.
On August 23 the ships moved to Matavai Bay. The
following morning the captain landed with Omai and several officers, to pay his
respects to the king, who was attended by his father, his two brothers, three
sisters, and a large number of people. Omai, who was becomingly dressed,
kneeled and embraced the king’s legs, but very little notice was taken of him.
He made the king a present of some red feathers and three yards of gold cloth;
and the captain gave him a suit of fine linen, a gold-laced hat, some more red
feathers, and some tools. Captain Cook’s wish had been to leave Omai with Otoo,
as he thought of landing all his animals here, and supposed that Omai would
assist in looking after them, and show their various uses. He therefore
encouraged the friendship of Omai with the chiefs, even though it might have
depended much on his supposed wealth. Omai, however, rejecting his kind
friend’s advice, conducted himself in so imprudent a manner that he soon lost
the friendship of Otoo, and of every other person of note in Otaheite. He
associated with none but vagabonds and strangers, whose sole object was to
plunder him; and had not the captain interfered they would not have left him a
single article worth carrying from the island. Of course, this drew on him the
ill-will of the chiefs, who found that they could not procure such valuable
presents as Omai bestowed on the lowest of the people, his companions.
After dinner the captain and a party of officers
accompanied Otoo to Oparree, taking with them the poultry with which they were
to stock the island. They consisted of a peacock and hen, a turkey-cock and
hen, one gander and three geese, and a drake and four ducks; all left with the
king. A gander was found there, left by Captain Wallis, several goats, and a
fine Spanish bull, which was kept tied to a tree near
Otoo’s house. Three cows and a bull, some sheep, and the horse and mare were
also landed, greatly to the captain’s satisfaction, and to that of everybody
else on board, probably, when it is considered what care and attention it must
have required to keep them alive for so many months. A piece of ground was also
cleared for a garden, and in it, among other things, were planted several
shaddock trees, which had been brought from the Friendly Islands, two
pine-apple plants, some melons and potatoes. The Spaniards had left a vine,
which flourished, but before the grapes were ripe the natives tasted them, and
finding them sour, nearly destroyed it. It was, however, pruned, and cuttings
were taken from it, and the natives were advised to wait till the fruit was
ripe another season.
The youth called Oedidee, whose real name was Heeteheete,
who had been seven months with Captain Cook, was here met with. The captain
gave him a chest of tools, and some clothes had been sent out for his use; but
after a few days he declined wearing them. One of the natives who had been on
board one of the Spanish ships had also resumed his native garments, and
“perhaps,” Captain Cook observes, “Omai, who has almost entirely assumed
English manners, will do the same.”
While the ships lay at Matavai news was brought that
the people of Eimeo had revolted, and it was resolved to send Towha, with a
fleet, against them. Before the fleet could sail it was necessary that a grand
human sacrifice should be offered. The unhappy victim—one of the common
people—had already been knocked on the head for the purpose. Captain Cook,
wishing to ascertain the truth of the accounts he had received, accompanied
Otoo to witness the ceremony, and with him Mr Anderson and Mr Webber, followed
by Omai in a canoe. Every facility was given them for witnessing the barbarous
and disgusting rite. The English were allowed to examine the victim, who was a
man of middle age, and had been killed by a blow on the right temple.
Forty-nine skulls were counted in one heap, which, as they had suffered little
change by the weather, had belonged to people evidently not long killed.
On the captain’s return he met Towha, who became very
angry because he positively refused to assist him in his proposed expedition.
Omai gave an entertainment on shore about this time,
at which the king condescended to attend; and the following day a party dined
with their old shipmate Oedidee; among other dishes, admirably dressed, was a
hog weighing about thirty pounds, which an hour or two before was alive. Some fireworks, let off before a large concourse of people,
frightened some of them so much that they could scarcely be kept together. On
the return of Otoo, on September 13, from assisting at another human sacrifice,
the two captains mounted the two horses, and took a ride round the plains of
Matavai, to the astonishment of a large number of people. The ride was repeated
every day, and seemed to convey to the natives a better idea of the greatness
of the English than any of the other novelties brought to them by their
European visitors.
Most of the chiefs and other people of importance who
were known to the English during their former visit were still alive, and as
the island had enjoyed the blessings of peace, it seemed to be in a very
flourishing condition. Omai received here one present from Towha in return for
the many he had given away; this was a handsome double canoe, ready for sea;
but when he exhibited himself on board in a suit of chain armour, so unpopular
had he become that the people would not look at him. He had all along
entertained the idea that Captain Cook would take him back to Ulietea, and
reinstate him by force of arms on his father’s property. This made him refuse
to remain at Otaheite.
On leaving that island, on September 30, the ships
proceeded to Eimeo. Omai, in his canoe, had arrived some time before. An
excellent harbour was found, in which the ships lay close to the shore. The
Resolution was much infested by rats, and, as an expedient to get rid of them,
she was hauled as close in with the shore as the depth of water would allow,
and some stout hawsers were fastened to the trees to afford them a bridge to
cross over. The natives would scarcely have thanked their visitors for the
gifts intended for them, but whether any rats were thus got rid of is not
known. The natives managed, however, to carry off a goat, which, as it was of
value for the purpose of stocking other islands, it was necessary to recover.
This, however, was not done till several canoes and some houses had been
burned.
The island is described as rising in one hill, with
very little level ground, and the people, especially the women, were said to be
inferior in appearance to those of the neighbouring islands. Another day’s sail
brought the ships to the entrance of the harbour of Owharre, on the west side
of the island of Huaheine. As Omai refused to attempt the recovery of his
property in Ulietea, except by force of arms, Captain Cook determined to leave
him here, making the best terms with the chief that he could. The English were
received on shore by a large concourse of people, many of whom appeared to be
people of consequence; the king was, however, only a child. It is painful to
read the following account given of the meeting:—“Omai began with making his
offering to the gods, consisting of red feathers, cloth, etcetera. Then followed
another offering, which was to be given to the gods by the chief: each article
was laid before a priest, who presented it with a prayer dictated by Omai, who
did not forget his friends in England, nor those who
had brought him safely back. The King of England, Lord Sandwich, Cook, and
Clerke were mentioned in every one of them.”
Finally, the chief agreed to give Omai a piece of
ground extending about two hundred yards along the shore of the harbour, and
reaching to the foot of the hill. Here observatories were set up, and the
carpenters of both ships were set to work to build a house for Omai, in which
he might secure his European commodities. At the same time some hands were
employed on shore, making a garden for his use, planting shaddocks, vines,
pine-apples melons, and other seeds, many of which were in a flourishing state
before the English left the island. Omai here found a brother, a sister, and a
brother-in-law, but they were not people capable of affording him any
protection. Cook, therefore, advised him to make handsome presents to some of
the chiefs, that they might be induced to protect him. To increase his
security, Captain Cook took every opportunity of impressing on the inhabitants
that he purposed returning, and that should he not find Omai in the state of
security in which he left him, his enemies might expect to feel the weight of
his resentment.
On the 22nd a man found means of carrying off a
sextant from Mr Bayley’s observatory. Omai fixed on the culprit, who was a
Bolabola man, a hardened scoundrel. He confessed that he had taken the
instrument, and would show where it was. This did not save him, however, from
having his head and beard shaved, and both his ears cut off, as a terror to the
rest.
Omai’s house being nearly finished on the 26th, many of his movables were carried on shore. Among a
variety of other useless articles was a box of toys, which seemed greatly to
please the multitude; but his plates, dishes, mugs, and glasses he saw would be
of no use to him, and he therefore exchanged them with the crew for hatchets
and other iron tools. He is said to have had an electrical machine, a portable
organ, a coat of mail, and a helmet. He had also a musket and bayonet, a
fowling-piece, two pairs of pistols, and two or three swords or cutlasses. The
possession of these made him quite happy, though Cook was of opinion that he
would have been better without them. A horse and mare, a boar and two sows, and
a goat with kid were likewise given to him.
The following inscription was cut on the outside of
Omai’s house:—
Georgius Tertius, Rex, 2 Novembris, 1777.
Naves Resolution, Jacobus Cook, Pr. Discovery, Carolus
Clerke, Pr.
On bidding his friends farewell Omai sustained himself
with firmness, till he came to Captain Cook, when his utmost efforts failed to
conceal his tears, and he wept all the time of going on shore. Even at last he
would have remained on board the Resolution. The two New Zealand youths were
very anxious to remain with the English, and the younger, who was a witty, smart boy, and consequently much noticed, had to be carried on
shore by force.
Deep interest was often expressed in England as to the
fate of the “gentle savage” who had been brought from the South Seas, and so
soon learned the manners of civilised life. Had he devoted his talents to the
instruction of his countrymen, and raised their condition to a state somewhat
resembling what he had seen existing in England?
Many years passed before the truth was known, and yet
who that has read the account given of him by Cook, and remembers that he
remained to the last a dark idolater, could have expected otherwise from him?
Mr Ellis, in his Polynesian Researches, gives the account:—
“Soon after the departure of his friends he assumed
the native dress, and at the same time gave himself up to the vices, indolence,
and barbarism of his countrymen. The only use he made of the horses left with
him was to ride about the country for the purpose of astonishing or frightening
the more ignorant natives; and so far from lamenting the barbarous condition of
the people, and endeavouring to raise them in the social scale, his great
delight consisted in exhibiting the superiority which his English weapons
enabled him to assume. As his firearms, especially, had rendered him a powerful
subject, he married the daughter of a chief who made himself king, and was
invested with the high title of Patiri (wise and instructed). He had now
gained the position his philosophical friends in England had desired for him, and
had a favourable opportunity of acquiring the title of his country’s
benefactor, which they had hoped he would deserve. But how did he employ his
advantages?
“From thenceforth,” adds the narrator, “he continued
the inglorious tool of the king’s cruel and wanton humour, assisting him with
his musket in time of war, and in peace frequently amusing the monarch by
shooting at his subjects at a distance, or gratifying his revenge by
despatching, with a pistol, those who had incurred his wrath.
“He died within three years after his celebrated
voyage, and the New Zealanders did not long survive him. His name is now rarely
mentioned, except with contempt or execration. The site of his dwelling is, by
the natives, still called Beritain (Britain); and amid the ruins of the garden
they show a dark and glossy-leaved shaddock tree, which they love to tell was
planted by the hands of Cook. The horses which he left did not long survive;
but the breeds of goats and pigs yet remain; many of the trinkets, part of the
armour, and some of the cutlasses are also preserved; and the numerous coloured
engravings of a large quarto Bible are objects of general attraction.
“There is, perhaps, no place in the island to which
greater interest is attached; for besides its association with the name just
mentioned, on this spot was reared the first building in which the true God was
publicly worshipped in Huaheine; and here, also, was erected the first school
for the instruction of the benighted inhabitants in the knowledge of letters and
the principles of Christianity.”
On leaving Huaheine the ships stood over to Ulietea,
and the following day, November 3, entered the harbour of Ohamaneno. Here they
hauled close in with the shore, and made another attempt to get rid of their
troublesome guests the rats. The captain’s old friend, Oreo, chief of the
island, and his son-in-law, Pootoe, at once came off to visit him; the visit
was returned, and amicable relations were soon established. In spite of this,
however, thefts were continually committed; and other circumstances arose which
seemed to threaten a rupture of this friendship.
One of these events was the desertion of a marine,
who, being on duty, went off, carrying his arms with
him. Captain Cook, with a few of his people, instantly pursued the man, fearing
that he would have escaped to the mountains. He was soon discovered, however,
among the natives, who readily delivered him up to the captain. But a more
serious case of desertion took place a few days afterwards—that of a midshipman
and a seaman. The captain, thereupon, set off with two armed boats, but could
not find the fugitives, hearing only that they had gone over to the
neighbouring island of Bolabola.
The next morning, the chief, his son and daughter, and
his son-in-law came on board the Resolution, and the three last-mentioned were
invited to the Discovery, with a view to their detention there till the
deserters should be brought back—an act of high-handed injustice of which, one
would suppose, no amount of condescension and familiarity on the part of the
English was likely to efface the remembrance.
At any rate, the step thus taken caused great
consternation among the natives, many of whom, including many women, came off
in canoes under the stern of the ship, and bewailed the captivity of the king’s
daughter. Oreo, on his part, quickly aroused himself, and sent
off canoes to Bolabola and elsewhere to find the fugitives. The natives, in the
meantime, in a spirit of natural retaliation, formed a plan for seizing Captain
Cook while bathing, as was his custom every morning. Failing in this, they
attempted to make prisoners of Captain Clerke and Mr Gore. News, indeed, was
brought off to the ships that they had been captured; and Mr King, with several
armed boats, was immediately despatched to rescue them, when it was found that
they had escaped the plot, probably owing their safety to the fact that Captain
Clerke carried a pistol in his hand. Oreo must have been aware of the plot, for
he more than once asked Captain Cook why he did not go and bathe as usual.
The chief at length set out for Bolabola, it being
arranged that the ships should follow; but a strong wind kept them in harbour,
and the next day he returned with the two deserters, who had gone from Bolabola
to the small island of Toobaee, where they were taken by the father of Pootoe.
The three captives were then released. Before leaving the island, Captain Cook
presented Oreo with an English boar and sow and two goats. Oreo and several
chiefs took a passage on board the English ships to Bolabola, which was reached
the day after they left Ulietea. A large concourse of people, with the great
chief Opoony in their midst, were ready to receive the English.
One object Captain Cook had in putting in here was to
obtain one of the anchors which Monsieur Bougainville had lost at Otaheite, and
which, having been taken up by the people there, had been sent as a present to
Opoony. That chief, with remarkable honesty, positively refused to accept any
present till the anchor had been seen, not believing it worth what was offered.
Cook’s object was to manufacture it into tools and nails, of which he had run
short. He insisted on his presents being taken, and was glad to get the old
iron for the object he had in view. Very many years afterwards the missionary
Williams was, in the same manner, thankful to find an old anchor, out of which
he manufactured the ironwork required for the missionary vessel he was
building, the Messenger of Peace.
As a ram had before been conveyed to the island, the
captain made a present of a ewe to Opoony, hoping thus that the island might be
stocked in time with a breed of sheep.
He now prepared to take his departure for the north;
and as this was the last visit paid by Cook to these islands his opinion may be
quoted,—that it would have been better for the people of the Pacific Islands
had they never been discovered by Europeans, than once having become acquainted
with them and their goods to be afterwards left to their own resources. “When
their iron tools are worn out, and the use of their stone ones is forgotten,
how are they to get others?” he asks; and adds, “it is
incumbent, therefore, on Europeans, to visit them once in three or four years,
in order to supply them with those conveniences which we have introduced to
them.”
The minds of those enlightened and civilised visitors
were occupied with the glory of their achievements as discoverers of hitherto
unknown lands; their remaining thoughts, which they would have called
patriotic, were principally occupied with the question how these discoveries
might be turned to account for the profit and honour of England; and if a nook
remained for a benevolent wish for “the savages,” the wish was limited to the
improvement of their material condition. Otherwise, as the English discoverer
found them, so he was willing that they should remain, satisfied with the idea that he had increased the productive powers of the
different lands he visited.
Thus, also, in the case of the wretched Omai, whose
end we have seen. It seems scarcely to have entered the minds of those who, in
England, petted and spoiled him, that he had a soul as valuable, or rather as
invaluable, as theirs; and that he needed, as all need, the transforming
influences of Divine grace to make him a future blessing, instead of a curse,
to his poor countrymen. We are told, indeed, of his being slow to receive
Christian instruction; and we read also that, among his goods and chattels
collected in England, he had a large quarto Bible, with coloured engravings—a
book, however, which was a sealed book to him and his countrymen.
The ships now stood north, and, on December 24,
discovered an uninhabited island, with a lagoon. It was hoped that turtle would
abound here; they therefore came to an anchor. The voyagers were not
disappointed, and a considerable number were taken. Two men, while thus
employed, lost themselves in different parts of the island, and as there was
not a drop of water to be found, they suffered greatly from thirst, especially
one who would not drink turtle’s blood. They were both happily recovered. The
telescopes were landed, and on December 30 an eclipse of the sun was observed.
Not a trace of any inhabitants having ever been on the island could be
discovered. There were about thirty cocoanut trees, but the fruit was of an
inferior quality. Three hundred turtle were taken, and as many fish as could be
consumed; but not a drop of fresh water could be found. As Christmas was spent
here, the name of Christmas Island was given to the new discovery. It lies in latitude 1 degrees 41 minutes North and longitude
157 degrees 15 minutes East. Some cocoanuts and yams were planted on the
island, and some melon-seeds; while a bottle was deposited, with the names of
the ships and the date of the visit. The ships sailed thence on January 2,
1778, and proceeded northward. The wind blew faintly at first, and then
freshened, and albatrosses, with other birds, were seen increasing in
number—all indications of land being near, though none was seen till the 18th,
when first one high island and then another hove in sight. On the 19th the
first seen bore east, several leagues distant, and being to windward could not
be approached. On standing towards the other, a third island was discovered in
the direction of west-north-west. At first it was doubtful whether the islands
were inhabited, but that question was soon solved by the appearance of several
canoes, which came alongside; but the people in them would not at first venture
on board, though they willingly exchanged a few fish and some sweet potatoes
for nails and other articles offered them. They spoke the language of Otaheite
and of the other islands lately visited. They were of a brown colour, of an
ordinary size, and the cast of their features was not unlike that of Europeans.
Some wore their hair long, others short, but all had stained it of a brown
colour. Some were slightly tattooed, and all wore the usual girdle, stained
red, white, and black. As the ships sailed along the coast, looking for a
harbour, numerous villages were observed, with plantations of sugar-canes and
plantains, while vast numbers of people crowded the shore, or collected in
elevated places, to watch the ships.
The next day, the ships again standing in, several
natives ventured on board, and showed by the wild looks and gestures with which
they regarded everything on board that they had never before been visited by
Europeans. They knew the value of iron, however, when they saw it, and it was
supposed that they had gained their knowledge of it from the fact that the masts
and spars of a ship with iron attached, and casks with iron hoops, had been
cast on their shore. They soon proved themselves to be daring thieves, and
unhappily, a boat being sent on shore, on their attempting to seize the oars
they were fired at, and one man was killed. Of this circumstance Captain Cook
was not informed at the time.
As soon as Captain Cook landed, the people assembled fell flat on their faces; nor would they rise till by
expressive gestures he urged them to do so. He understood that this was the way
they paid respect to their own great chiefs. Having arranged about getting a
supply of water, he walked with Messrs Anderson and Wilder into the country, to
visit an obelisk of wickerwork, fifty feet high, standing in a morai. A native
had been selected as a guide, and wherever they went the people fell prostrate
before the captain. The morai was similar to those seen at Otaheite. In and
about it were a number of idols, one having on its head what resembled an
ancient helmet. They ascertained, without doubt, that human sacrifices were
offered up at these morais. On the wickerwork were pieces of grey cloth, such
as was generally offered to idols, and a piece of which had been pressed on the
captain on landing. The next day, among other articles brought off, were some
beautiful cloaks of red and other feathers, and helmets and caps of the same.
Captain Cook, in his journal, expresses his belief
that the people were cannibals. This arose from seeing a man on board who had a
piece of salted meat done up in a cloth, and which he said that he ate to do
him good. It seems to have been highly dried and seasoned, and to have been
taken as a stimulant.
The natives called their island Atooi, and Captain
Cook gave the name of the Sandwich Islands to the whole group. The friendly
disposition of the natives was shown on all occasions, especially when three
boats went on shore, and, bad weather coming on, were detained for several
days. Five islands were seen on this occasion, and were distinguished by the
names of Woahoo, Atooi, Oneeheow, Oreehoua, and Tahoora. The islands were
mostly high, well watered, and apparently thickly populated.
It was found that the taboo existed with even greater
vigour than at Tongataboo, for the people constantly asked, with signs of fear,
whether anything they desired to see, and the English
were unwilling to show, was taboo, or, as they pronounced the word, tafoo.
On February 2, 1778, the ships left the Sandwich
Islands, and stood towards the coast of America.
On March 7, early in the morning, the long-looked-for
coast of New Albion, so-called by Sir Francis Drake, hove in sight. The ships
stood along the coast, now off and now on again, with uncertain weather, till
at length, on March 29, an inlet appeared in latitude 49 degrees 15 minutes North, and longitude 126 degrees 35 minutes East. The ships
sailed up this inlet for several miles, when they cast anchor. Natives came off
in three canoes, shaped like Norway yawls. Having drawn near, a person stood up
in one of them and invited the strangers, in a speech and by gesture, to land,
at the same time strewing handfuls of red feathers towards them, while his
companions threw red dust in the same way. The next day a large number of
people came off, who all behaved in the most peaceable manner, and offered for
sale a number of skins of bears, foxes, wolves, deer, racoon, polecats,
martens, and sea otters. The difficulty was to find articles to exchange for
these really valuable commodities, for the natives would receive nothing but
metal, and, at last, insisted on having brass. To supply them, whole suits of
clothes were stripped of their buttons, bureaus of their handles, and copper
kettles, tin canisters, and candlesticks went to wreck. The ships required a
great deal of repairs, and even some fresh masts, and for this purpose they
were hauled close into the shore and securely moored. The natives called this
inlet Nootka Sound, but Captain Cook gave it the name of King George’s Sound.
Two persons were on board the ships at this time whose
names afterwards became well-known—Mr Vancouver, then a midshipman of the
Resolution, who afterwards, as Captain Vancouver, made many important
discoveries on the coast then visited, and gave his name to a valuable island,
now a colony of Great Britain; and Corporal Ledyard, whose travels in Siberia
were of a very extraordinary character.
The clothing of the people of Nootka Sound consisted
of a dress of flax, fringed with fur, and reaching to the feet; and over it a
cloak of the same substance, with a hole cut in it, through which the head was
thrust, and which hung down over the shoulders and arms as low as the waist.
The head was covered with a hat like a truncated cone of matting, with a knob
or tassel at the top, and strung under the chin. A large cloak of bear or wolf
skin was occasionally worn over all. They also, at times, wore wooden masks.
Their habitations were made of planks loosely put together, about seven or
eight feet in height in front, and higher at the back.
Several families resided in each, with a very slight division between them.
Each had its own bench, and in the centre was the fire, without hearth or
chimney. At the ends were seen trunks of trees, carved into hideous images, and
rudely painted, supposed to be their gods, though but little veneration was
paid them. Two silver spoons, of old Spanish manufacture, were obtained here
from a native, who wore them as ornaments round his neck.
The progress of the ships along this coast can be but
briefly described. Although the mercury in the barometer fell very rapidly,
Captain Cook was so anxious to put to sea that he kept to his purpose of
sailing on April 26. A perfect hurricane came on ere long, in which the
Resolution sprang a serious leak. When the weather moderated one pump kept it
under. The ships proceeded along the coast, and several islands and headlands
were seen and named.
The voyagers landed at several places, and had some
intercourse with the natives. One inlet, where the ships brought up, was named
Prince William’s Sound. Here the natives made a daring attempt to plunder the
Discovery, a mob of them getting on board, evidently under the impression that
she was feebly guarded. But before they had time to carry out their nefarious
design, the crew came on deck with their cutlasses, and the plunderers went off
in their canoes.
Captain Cook, believing that it was too late in the
year to do anything of importance in the way of fresh discoveries, resolved to
return to the south, and wait at the Sandwich Islands till the next season.
From Prince William’s Sound the ships proceeded along
the coast, steering south-west, and passing many more capes, till the mouth of
a large river was found, up which they sailed. A volcano was here seen,
emitting smoke, but no fire.
A number of natives, of no very prepossessing
appearance, now came off the banks of the river to the ships, and a considerable quantity of skins were obtained from them. It
was held by some on board that this river might be a strait, leading to
Hudson’s Bay; and to settle this question Captain Cook sailed up it nearly
seventy leagues from its mouth, at which distance it still seemed to be a
river, and nothing more, upon which the explorers returned. On June 1,
Lieutenant King was sent on shore to display the royal flag, and to take
possession of the country, as in former instances, in the name of the King of
Great Britain. In describing this inlet Captain Cook left a blank in the chart,
and therefore the Earl of Sandwich directed that it should be called Cook’s Inlet.
Leaving Prince William’s Sound, the next place reached
was the island of Oonolaschka. Here, at different times, some canoes came off
with natives, who had bows of the European fashion, and delivered two Russian
letters, the purport of which could not be understood.
During the stay of the ships at this island a canoe
was upset, and the occupant, a fine young man, was brought on board the
Resolution, when, without hesitation, he entered the captain’s cabin, and
exchanged his wet garments for a European suit of clothes, which he put on with
perfect ease.
Soon after this the expedition suffered a very great
loss in the death of Mr Anderson, the surgeon of the Resolution, who had long
been suffering from consumption. The ships were proceeding northward at the
time, along the coast of Asia, but were compelled to return on account of the
shallowness of the water. An island in sight was called Anderson’s Island, to
perpetuate the memory of that gentleman.
On the 9th the ships anchored under a point of land to
which the name of Cape Prince of Wales was given, and which was considered the
most western point of America. It is only thirteen leagues distant from the
eastern cape of Siberia. Thence they stood over to the coast of Siberia to the
country of Tschutski. Again sailing, the ships steered to the east, and on the
18th fell in with the ice, which, in latitude 70 degrees 44 minutes, was as
compact as a wall, and ten or twelve feet high, being much higher farther to
the north. It was covered with sea-horses, a number of which were caught, and,
in spite of the prejudices of some of the crew, were found to be superior to
salt pork. Cook continued to traverse the Arctic Sea, beyond Behring’s Straits,
in various directions till the 29th, when the ice beginning to form rapidly he
abandoned all hope of attaining his object that year.
On October 3 the ships anchored in the harbour of
Samganoodha, in the island of Oonolaschka. The carpenters at once set to work
to repair the ships. While they lay here, each of the captains received the
present of a well-known Russian dish. It consisted of a salmon, highly
seasoned, and baked in a coating of rye bread like a loaf. The loaves were
accompanied by notes in Russian. A few bottles of rum, wine, and porter were
sent in return by Corporal Ledyard, who was directed to make the Russians
understand that the strangers were English and their friends, and to gain all
the information in his power. On the 14th a visit was received from a Russian
of considerable ability. Cook entrusted to his care a letter and chart for the
Lords Commissioners of the Admiralty, which were duly delivered. The natives of
this island were the best behaved and most peaceably disposed of any yet met
with, while not one of them was found guilty of an act of dishonesty. They
were, however, far from moral in their conduct.
Samganoodha Harbour was left on October 20, and the
ships proceeded south towards the Sandwich Islands. Cook’s intention was to
spend the winter there, and to return to Kamtschatka by the middle of May. In
case of separation he directed Captain Clerke to meet him at the Sandwich
Islands for the first place of rendezvous, and the harbour of Fetropaulowska,
in Kamtschatka, for the second. The rigging of the ships had now become very
bad; on board the Discovery the main-tack gave way, killed one man, and wounded
the boatswain and two others.
On November 25 one of the Sandwich Islands, called by
the natives Mowee, hove in sight. Several canoes came off, belonging to a chief
named Terreeoboo; but as another island was discovered, called Owhyhee, (now
altered in spelling to Hawaii) which it was found possible to fetch, the ships
stood towards it, and their visitors accordingly left them. On the morning of
December 2 the summits of the mountains of Owhyhee were seen, covered with
snow. On the evening an eclipse of the moon was observed. For several weeks the
ships continued plying round the island, bartering with the natives, who came
off with hogs, fowls, fruit, and roots. On January 16, 1779, a bay being discovered,
the masters were sent in to examine it, and having reported favourably, the
ships, on the next day, came to an anchor in Karakakooa Bay.
The ships were crowded with visitors, but not a single
person had a weapon of any sort. There must have been at least a thousand about
the two ships, and one of them took the rudder out of a boat and made off with
it. Cook ordered some muskets and four-pounders to be fired over the canoe
which was escaping. The multitude, however, seemed more surprised than frightened.
Besides those who had come off in canoes the shore of
the bay was covered with spectators, and many hundreds were swimming round the
ships, like shoals of fish. Few of the voyagers now regretted that they had
been unable to find a north-west passage home in the summer, as they “thus had
it in their power to revisit the Sandwich Islands, and to enrich the voyage
with a discovery which, though the last, seemed in many respects to be the most
important that had hitherto been made by Europeans throughout the extent of the
Pacific Ocean.”
This paragraph concludes Captain Cook’s journal; they
were probably the last words he ever wrote. Captain King is our chief authority
for the remaining transactions of the voyage.
Among the chiefs who attached themselves to the
English was a young man named Pareea, who introduced himself as an officer of
the king of the island, then gone on a military
expedition to Mowee. That he had great influence among his people was evident,
for so large a number of people had collected on one side of the Discovery that
they made her heel over; Captain Cook pointed out the fact to him, and he
immediately cleared the ship. Another chief, the next day, cleared the
Resolution in the same way; and one man loitering behind, he took him up in his
arms and threw him into the sea. They brought on board a third chief, once a
warrior, now a priest, named Koah, a little old man of emaciated figure, his
red eyes and scaly skin showing he was a hard drinker of cava. Not far from the
shore was a temple, or morai. It was a square, solid pile of stones, about
forty yards long, twenty broad, and fourteen in height. The top was flat and
well-paved, and surrounded by a wooden rail, on which were fixed the skulls of
the victims sacrificed on the death of their chiefs. At one end was a kind of
scaffold, and on the opposite side, towards the sea, two small houses with a
covered communication. At the entrance were two large wooden images, with
features violently distorted, and on the head of each was a large piece of
carved wood, of a conical form, inverted. The lower part was without form, and
wrapped round with a red cloth. Not far off, in a retired grove by the side of
a pool, was a collection of huts, inhabited by priests who attended this
temple, of which Koah was the chief. There were two villages on the shores of
the bay—one on the north point, called Kowrooa, and at the bottom of the bay
one still larger, called Kakooa.
Our narrative is now drawing near to the tragic scene
which terminated both the labours and life of Captain James Cook. But, to
understand what led to that event, a preliminary explanation must be given.
The natives of Owhyhee had a legend to the effect that
a certain god, Rono, or Orono, formerly lived near Karakakooa Bay, and that,
having killed his wife in a fit of jealousy, remorse
drove him from the island. He set sail in a strangely shaped canoe, promising
that he would return on a floating island, furnished with all that man could
desire. When, therefore, the English ships appeared, their commander was
supposed to be the long-absent Rono, come to restore peace and prosperity to
the country.
The priest Koah having dined
on board the Resolution, accompanied Captain Cook and Mr King on shore—Mr King
being taken for the son of the former. They were met by four men, having wands
tipped with dog’s hair, and who shouted a short sentence in which the word
Orono was plainly distinguishable and frequently repeated. During this progress
the crowd either rushed away as in fear, or fell prostrate on the ground around
the party. Koah led the way into the morai, and, chanting a hymn, took the
captain to a sort of altar, on which were arranged twelve idols in a
semicircle, while on a table, before the centre one, which nearly resembled the
idols of Otaheite, lay a putrid hog. A tall young man, with a beard, Kaireekeea
by name, having presented Cook to the idols, old Koah put the putrid hog to his
nose, and then let it drop. At this time a procession approached, bearing a hog
and red cloth. Kaireekeea went forward to meet them, when they all prostrated
themselves. The hog then was offered to the captain by Koah, who wound the red
cloth round him. Chanting followed. Captain Cook, meanwhile, had considerable
difficulty in keeping his seat upon the rotten scaffolding. They then
descended, and as Koah passed the images he snapped his fingers at them, and
said something in a sneering tone. He, however, prostrated himself before the
centre figure, and kissed it, and induced the captain to do the same. The
captain and Mr King were then led to another division of the morai, where, in a
sunk space, three or four feet deep, they took their seats between two wooden
idols, Koah holding up one of the captain’s arms, and King the other. While
here another procession arrived, with a baked hog and vegetables. Cook put an
end to the ceremony as soon as he could, and returned on board.
No doubt the proceedings of the old priest and the
people were in some measure incomprehensible to Captain Cook; but it is certain
that, in bearing a prominent part in the mummery just narrated, he must have
been aware that he was encouraging heathen idolatry and hero-worship in its
grossest forms. It is not to be supposed that he was acquainted with the legend
of Rono; but the conduct of the people must have shown him their utter
debasement, and he can scarcely have failed to perceive that by submitting to
their ceremonies, and taking a part in them, he was lowering himself to their
level.
It is probable that Captain Cook expected, by yielding
to the superstitions of the natives, to obtain greater facilities for trading,
and keeping up amicable relations with them. If so, the subsequent events prove
how baseless were these anticipations, while the reader will scarcely fail to
be reminded of the striking Scripture narrative of the king of whom the people
shouted, “It is the voice of a god, and not of a man!” and who “gave not God
the glory.”
The day following that on which the events described
took place, Mr King, with a company of marines, landed, and erected an
observatory near the morai, the ground being marked off by the priests. For
some unknown reason—but one probably connected with the previous exhibition—the
entire bay was tabooed for a day or two, and no canoes ventured off with
provisions. The priests, however, sent to the observatory, and also to the
ships, a regular supply of hogs and vegetables for Orono, as if they were
discharging a religious duty, and would take nothing in return. Whenever, too,
after this, Captain Cook went on shore, he was attended by one of the priests,
who gave notice to the people to prostrate themselves; and inferior chiefs
often requested to be allowed to make offerings of hogs, which they did with
evident marks of fear in their countenances.
On January 24, 1779, the bay was again tabooed on
account of the arrival of the king, Terreeoboo, who soon came off privately in
a canoe, with his wife and children. He was found to be the same infirm old man
who had come on board the Resolution when the ships were off Mowee. The next
day the king came off in state, on board a large canoe, attended by two others.
In the first he himself came, dressed, as were his
attendant chiefs, in rich feathered cloaks, and armed with long spears and
helmets. In the second were Kaoo, the chief of the priests, and his brethren,
with idols of wickerwork of gigantic size, covered with feathers of different
colours and red cloth. Their eyes were large pearl oysters, with a black mark
fixed in the centre; while their mouths were marked with double rows of dogs’
fangs. The whole had a most hideous appearance. In a third canoe were hogs and
vegetables. The visitors, however, did not go on board, but, inviting the
captain on shore, returned. Mr King, who was at the
observatory, ordered out the guard to receive the party. The king then
threw a superb cloak over the captain’s shoulders, and placed a helmet on his
head; he then spread at his feet six other cloaks, all exceedingly beautiful;
and his attendants brought four hogs, with sugar-canes, bread-fruit, and
cocoanuts. The ceremony was concluded by the king exchanging names with Cook.
An old seaman, greatly attached to Captain Cook, died
here, and was buried in the morai, with the usual funeral service read over
him; but the priests thought they ought to do their part, and threw a dead hog
and plantains into the grave, and for several nights sacrificed hogs, and
chanted their hymns.
When the ships were about to sail a magnificent
present of provisions was made to the captain; and Terreeoboo and Kaoo waited
on him and entreated that he would leave his supposed son, Mr King, behind. On
February 4 the ship sailed, but met with very bad weather, during which they
picked up two canoes, driven off the land, the people in them nearly exhausted.
In this gale, also, the Resolution sprang her foremast, and fearing that,
should the weather continue, another harbour might not be found, Cook returned,
on the 10th of the month, to Karakakooa Bay.
It was observed by some of the explorers on this
occasion that the conduct of the natives had now undergone an ominous change.
The bay was found to be under taboo, and several circumstances occurred which
gave evidence that, from some cause or other, the English were regarded by the
natives with suspicion. And this breach was unhappily widened by some of the
common causes of dispute. For instance, some people from the island visiting
the Discovery, after the taboo was removed, went off with several articles they
had stolen, whereupon the ship opened fire on the fugitives, and a chief on
shore was killed. The stolen articles were soon returned, but an officer
commanding a party on shore not knowing this seized a canoe belonging to
Pareea. In a squabble which ensued that chief was knocked down. Captain Cook,
also, not knowing that the articles had been brought back, followed the
supposed thieves for several miles in the interior, when, on its getting dark,
he returned unmolested on board.
The next morning the Discovery’s cutter was found to
have been carried off, and Captain Cook resolved to seize the king, and hold
him captive till the boat was returned. For this purpose, loading his
double-barrelled gun, he went on shore with Mr Phillips and nine marines. Mr
King ordered the marines to remain within the tents, to load their pieces with
ball, and not to quit their arms. He then went up to the huts of the priests,
and endeavoured to quiet their alarm, assuring them that no one would be hurt.
Captain Cook, meantime, proceeded to the king’s house, and found him just
awake. He easily persuaded the old man to come on board with two of his sons;
but as they were embarking, one of his wives came down and entreated him not to
go off.
A vast number of people now began to collect, armed
with all sorts of weapons and their war mats. Captain Cook held the king’s
hand, and pressed him to come on; but finding that the lives of many natives
might be sacrificed if he persisted in the attempt, he abandoned it, and only
now thought of how he might best draw off his party. Unfortunately, the boats
stationed in the bay had fired at some canoes trying to get out, and killed a
chief of the first rank. This news quickly reached the hostile natives. Mr
Phillips, on this, withdrew his men to some rocks close to the water-side.
The natives now began to throw stones, and one man,
especially, threatened the captain with his dagger. In defence he fired. As the
barrel was only loaded with small shot it killed no one. The other barrel had a
ball in it, with which a man was killed. By this time the marines had begun to
fire, and the captain turned round, either to order them to cease or to direct
the boats to come in, when a tall man struck him on the back with a long club,
and he fell forward on his hands and knees, letting his fowling-piece drop. A
chief with a long dagger now plunged it into his back; he fell under the water,
and the natives, who crowded round, prevented him from rising. Nothing more was
seen of him. All was now horror and confusion. The natives pressed on the
marines, four of whom were killed before they could reach the boats, and
another, who could not swim, remained struggling in the water, when Lieutenant
Phillips, with heroic gallantry, leaped overboard, and though badly wounded
himself brought the man safely on board the pinnace. Though the boats still
kept up a hot fire, the chiefs were seen plunging their daggers in the body of
Cook, seemingly with the idea that they were consecrated by the death of so
great a man. It was said that old Koah, who had been long suspected, had been
seen going about with a dagger hid under his cloak, for the purpose, it was
supposed, of killing Captain Cook or some of his officers.
All this time Lieutenant King, with a party of men,
had remained on shore, at the observatory near the morai. Before long the
natives began to attack them, but met with so warm a reception that they
willingly agreed to a truce. As soon as the murderers of Cook had retired, a
party of young midshipmen pulled to the shore in a skiff, where they saw the
bodies of the marines lying without sign of life; but the danger of landing was
too great to be risked.
Mr King went on shore to try and negotiate for the
body of Cook. On the 15th a man who had been his constant attendant came off
with some human flesh, saying that the rest had been burnt, but that the head
and bones and hands were in possession of the king. The natives even now would
not believe that Rono was killed. When they saw him fall they cried out, “This
is not Rono!” Others inquired when he would come back, and whether he would
punish them. An order had been given to fire some houses, but unfortunately the
flames communicated to the priests’ dwellings, all of which were consumed,
though they had been the best friends to the English. Several people were shot,
attempting to escape. On the 18th King Terreeoboo sent a chief with presents to
sue for peace; and on the 20th the hands and various parts of the body of Cook
were brought on board, wrapped in a quantity of fine cloth, and covered with a
cloak of black and white feathers. The feet and other parts were returned the
next day, and being placed in a coffin they were committed to the deep, with
the usual naval honours.
We may imagine the feelings of the members of the
expedition as they witnessed the ceremony, and thought that he who had been so
long their chief, and who had led them successfully through so many dangers,
was no more. The officers might have felt many vain regrets; they might have
asked themselves whether all had been done that could have been done to save
the valuable life which had been so cruelly sacrificed, and whether the object
which had been attempted was adequate to the risk that had been run. So furious
was the rage of the crews of the two ships that they almost mutinied against
their officers, when prevented from going on shore, as they desired, to wreak
their vengeance on the heads of the natives. It is remarkable that Captain
Clerke had received orders to go on shore and seize the king; but, suffering
from the consumption which was rapidly hurrying him to his grave, he was too
weak to leave his cabin; and, on hearing this, Cook immediately exclaimed that
he would go himself.
Captain Cook was in the fifty-first year of his age
when he was thus suddenly cut off. He was a man of great intelligence,
perseverance, energy, and determination. He possessed a calm judgment and cool
courage under the most trying difficulties. As a seaman he was probably
unsurpassed. By employing every moment he could snatch from his professional
duties, with the aid of such books as came to his hand, he made himself a good
mathematician and a first-rate astronomer, while few officers of his day could
have equalled him as a marine surveyor and draughtsman. All subsequent
navigators, who have visited the regions he traversed, have borne evidence to
the great accuracy of his surveys, and the exactness with which he laid down on
his charts the numerous lands he discovered.
Various opinions have been expressed as to Captain
Cook’s temper. That he was, at times, hasty and irritable, there seems to be no
doubt; but this fault was greatly counterbalanced by his kind-hearted and
humane disposition. He seems to have had the power of attracting both officers
and men to his person; hence many who had accompanied him in his first voyage
volunteered to serve under him again in his subsequent expeditions. At the same
time he was stern and determined, though always just; and he considered it his
duty, when necessary, to carry out to the full the rigid discipline of the Navy
in those days. He was a kind and affectionate husband and father, and it is
said that his portrait at Greenwich Hospital, from which numerous copies have
been made, does not convey a satisfactory idea of the ordinary expression of
his countenance. It was painted, at the earnest desire of Sir Joseph Banks, by
Sir Nathaniel Dance, just before Cook left England on his last expedition, and
as the mind of the navigator was probably far away on board his vessels, the
grave and preoccupied expression which the portrait exhibits is fully accounted
for.
His ability as a seaman, and his calmness in danger, inspired the most perfect confidence in all who served under him, so that in times of the greatest trial he could always reckon on being implicitly obeyed; it is said that, placing reliance on his officers, after he had given his directions, he would retire to rest, and sleep as soundly as though no danger were near. Such is the character drawn of the great navigator by those who knew him; but we shall form a more just estimate of him if we consider the work he accomplished. We have only to compare a chart of the Pacific before Cook’s time, and to note the wide blanks and the erroneous position of lands, with one drawn from his surveys, to see at a glance the extent of his discoveries; but a still higher estimation will be formed of them if we judge of them by their value to the present generation. Let us consider the importance of his admirable survey of the whole eastern coast of New Holland, showing its vast size and insular character. Not less important was his survey of the islands of New Zealand, which, with New Holland, or Australia, are now among the most valuable possessions of the British crown. He discovered New Caledonia, and surveyed most of the islands of the New Hebrides, and other islands in the Austral Ocean. He made known to the world the larger portion of the Friendly Islands, or Tonga group, as also of the Marquesas. Nothing can surpass the general accuracy of his description of the habits and customs of the inhabitants of Otaheite. He completed the discovery and survey of the Society Islands. He was successful in his search for Easter, or Davis Island, which had in vain been looked-for by several previous navigators. He visited the groups of the Low, or Coral Archipelago, and discovered the numerous separate islands of Norfolk, Botany, Palmerston, Hervey, Savage, Mangaia, Wateeoo, Otakootaia, Turtle, Toobouai, and Christmas. His most important discovery was his last—that of the Sandwich Islands—since become an independent and semi-civilised kingdom. He sailed along the North American coast, where, from unavoidable circumstances, his surveys were less accurate than usual. They were, however, completed, many years after, by his follower Captain Vancouver. He ascertained the breadth of the strait between America and Asia to be eighteen leagues, a point left unsettled by Behring, and many years passed before any navigator penetrated farther to the north than he had done. His explorations in the Antarctic Ocean showed a hardihood and determination seldom surpassed. He brought to light Sandwich Land, settled the position of Kerguelen’s Land, as also the Isle Grande of La Roche, while he made a survey, long unsurpassed, of the southern shores of Tierra del Fuego. Such is a rough and rapid sketch of the discoveries made by Cook daring his three voyages; but what he, with justice, chiefly prided himself on was the means by which he successfully maintained his crews in perfect health during his second and third voyages; and it is satisfactory to know that his successor in the command of the expedition, by following his system, brought home his ships’ companies with few or no sick among them. As soon as the remains of Captain Cook had been
committed to the deep the taboo which had been placed on the bay by the chief
Eappo was removed, at the request of Captain Clerke, who said that, as the
Orono was buried, the remembrance of what had passed was buried with him. As
soon as it was known that the people might bring their provisions as usual the
ships were surrounded by canoes, and many chiefs came on board, expressing
great sorrow at what had happened, and their satisfaction at the reconciliation
which had taken place. Several friends, who did not come themselves, sent
presents of large hogs and other provisions. Among the rest came the treacherous
old Koah, but he was refused admittance.
Captain Clerke was anxious to visit the islands to
leeward before the news of the events which had occurred at Owhyhee could reach
them, and a bad effect be produced. He therefore gave orders to unmoor, and
every preparation was made for quitting the bay. In the evening all the natives
were sent on shore, and Eappo and the friendly Kaireekeea took an affectionate
farewell. As the ships stood out of the bay the natives collected in great
numbers on the shore, and received the last farewells of the English with every
mark of affection and goodwill.
The first island visited was that of Woahoo, which was
found to be high and picturesque, and thickly populated; the next was the
island of Atooi. A party was here sent on shore to fill the casks with water,
when the natives collected in great numbers, threatening to attack them, and it
was with difficulty that they were enabled to reach the boats and return on
board ship. The next day, however, some chiefs arrived on the spot; and the day
after Mr King, who commanded the party, going on shore, found the whole
distance to the watering-place marked with little white flags, and the English
were not in the slightest degree molested. While the ships were at this island
it was ascertained that some goats which were left there at the first visit of
the English soon increased in number, and had bidden fair to stock the island,
when a quarrel took place about them, and the animals were killed. A contest
between two tribes or families was still going on about the matter, in which
several people had lost their lives.
It was now March 12, and preparations were made for
quitting the islands and proceeding on the search for a passage, through
Behring’s Straits, into the Atlantic. There was, from the first, very little
prospect of its success. Captain Clerke was sinking rapidly with consumption,
and every one but himself knew that his days were
numbered. Still, in spite of his weakness, he kept up his spirits in a
wonderful manner, and though fully aware that the cold climate he was going to
encounter would prove injurious to his health, this did not prevent him from
attempting to carry out the instructions of his late chief to the utmost of his
power.
On March 15 the ships left the Sandwich group, and
steered for the harbour of Saint Peter and Saint Paul. The ships encountered
very severe weather on approaching the coast of Siberia. The rigging and decks
were so completely coated with ice that it was not without great difficulty the
ropes could be handled, and the crew sensibly felt the change from the warm
temperature to which they had been so long accustomed. To add to their
difficulties, the Resolution sprang a serious leak, and split her second suit
of sails. As the decks below were deluged with water, the only place in which
the sail-makers could work was in the cabin of their dying captain. At length,
on April 28, the harbour of Saint Peter and Saint Paul was reached. The town
was found to consist of about thirty miserable log huts, and small conical
buildings raised on poles. The commandant was a
sergeant, with a few men under him. The appearance of the expedition at first
caused great consternation among the inhabitants. This arose from the
circumstance that the celebrated Polish exile Beniowski had, a short time
before, made his escape from Bolcheretsk with a couple of vessels and a
considerable number of men. It was supposed that the exploring squadron was in
some way connected with him. Another opinion was that the strangers were French,
at that time enemies of the Russians. Fortunately, a German, of the name of
Port, was at the place, and as Mr Webber spoke German well, the
intercommunication was speedily established, and as soon as the Russians were
convinced that their visitors were English nothing could exceed their kindness
and hospitality. As provisions were, however, very dear here, Captain Clerke
despatched Captain Gore and Mr King, with Mr Webber and the German, to visit
Major Behm, the Governor of Bolcheretsk, in order to obtain a supply through
him. They travelled partly in boats and canoes, and partly in sleighs drawn by
dogs, and were well wrapped up in skins to protect them from the cold.
On their arrival at Bolcheretsk, they were received
with the greatest kindness and hospitality by Major Behm and the officers of
the garrison. These kind-hearted and liberal men would not allow the English to
pay for such stores as the town could produce. Among other things, they
presented the ships’ companies with three bags of tobacco, of a hundredweight
each, and loaf-sugar for the officers, while Madame Behm sent several
delicacies to poor Captain Clerke. Major Behm accompanied the English officers
to the ships, and made arrangements that stores should be sent from Okotsk to
meet them on their return, should they fail to discover the passage of which
they were in search. It is worthy of remark that when the English seamen
received the tobacco which had been sent them from Bolcheretsk, they begged
that their own allowance of grog might be stopped, and that it might be
presented to the Russian garrison, who, they understood, were in want of
spirits. Knowing the value a sailor sets on his grog, the feeling of gratitude
which prompted the proposal will be the better appreciated. The generous Russian
would, however, accept but a very small portion of what was offered.
As Major Behm was on the point of returning to Saint
Petersburg, Captain Gierke, feeling sure that he was a man of the strictest
honour, resolved to entrust him with a copy of the journal of the voyage, and
an account of all transactions up to the arrival of the ships in the harbour of
Saint Peter and Saint Paul. Mr Bayley and Mr King also sent home an account of
all the astronomical and other scientific observations made during the voyage.
These were duly delivered, within a few months from the time of their being
entrusted to Major Behm.
It is remarkable that on the arrival of the expedition
in the harbour of Saint Peter and Saint Paul, the whole Russian garrison of the
place were found to be suffering more or less from scurvy, many of the men
being in the last stage of that disease. They were immediately placed under the
care of the English surgeons, and, by a free use of sour-krout and sweet-wort,
they nearly all quickly recovered. Through the exertions of Major Behm, a
supply of rye-flour was furnished to the ships, and a bullock was sent on
board, which was served out to the men on Sunday. It was the first fresh beef
they had tasted since leaving the Cape of Good Hope, two years and a half
before. Twenty head of cattle were afterwards sent on board, with other
supplies, and the English themselves caught with their nets an abundance of
fine fish.
On June 12 the ships were unmoored for the purpose of
putting to sea, but it was not till the 16th that they were able to get clear
of the bay. The eruption of a neighbouring volcano took place at this time,
which covered the decks with cinders and small stones. From the first the ships
encountered bad weather. The intense cold severely tried the crews. The men had
taken no care of their fur jackets and other warm clothing, but they had been
collected by their officers, and cased up in casks, to be produced when most
required.
The expedition passed through Behring’s Straits on
July 5, and having run along the coast of Asia, stretched across to that of
America, with the intention of exploring it between the latitudes 68 degrees
and 69 degrees. In this attempt, however, the explorers were disappointed,
being stopped, on the 7th, by a large and compact field of ice connected with
the land. They therefore altered their course to the westward, in the hopes of
finding some opening, and thus being able to get round to the north of the ice.
They continued sailing in that direction till the 9th, for nearly forty
leagues, without discovering an opening. Still their dying chief persevered in
his efforts till the 27th, although unable to penetrate farther north than 70
degrees 33 minutes, which was five leagues short of
the point which had been gained the previous year. In the attempt the Discovery
was nearly lost, and received very severe damage. She
became so entangled by several large pieces of ice that her way was stopped,
and immediately dropping bodily to leeward she fell broadside on to the edge of
a considerable mass. At the same time, there being an open sea to windward, the
surf made her strike violently on it. The mass of ice, however, at length
either so far removed, or broke, as to set the ship at liberty, when another
attempt to escape was made; but, unfortunately, before she gathered sufficient
way to be under command she again fell to leeward on
another fragment. The swell now making it unsafe to lie to windward of the ice,
and there being no prospect of getting clear, the ship was pushed into a small
opening, the sails were furled, and she was made fast with ice-hooks. In this
dangerous position she was seen at noon by her consort, a fresh gale driving
more ice towards her. It is easy to conceive the anxiety felt on board the
Resolution, which was kept in the neighbourhood, firing a gun every half-hour.
At last, towards evening, there was a shift of wind, and by nine o’clock the
Discovery appeared, having, by setting all sail, forced her way out of the ice.
She had, however, lost a considerable amount of sheathing from the bows, and
had become very leaky from the blows received.
While in these latitudes several sea-horses were
killed, which the seamen were persuaded, without much difficulty, to eat in
preference to their salt provisions. Two white bears were also killed, which,
though having a somewhat fishy taste, were considered dainties. Finding that
all prospect of carrying the ships through any passage which might exist to the
eastward was utterly hopeless, Captain Gierke announced his intention of
returning to Awatska Bay to repair damages, and thence to continue the voyage
in the direction of Japan. Joy brightened every countenance as soon as these
resolutions were made known. All were heartily tired of a
navigation full of danger, in which the utmost perseverance had not been
repaid with the slightest prospect of success. Notwithstanding the tedious
voyage to be made, and the immense distance to be run, every one seemed to feel
and speak as though they were once again approaching the shores of Old England.
There was one, however—the gallant commander of the
expedition, Captain Clerke—who was destined never again to see his native land.
On the 17th he was too weak to get out of bed, and therefore gave directions
that all orders should be received from Mr King. On the morning of August 22 he
breathed his last, to the deep regret of all who served under him. He had spent
the whole of his life at sea, from his earliest boyhood. He had been in several
actions, and in one, between the Bellona and Courageux, having been stationed
in the mizzen-top, he was carried overboard with the
mast, but was taken up unhurt. He was a midshipman in the Dolphin, commanded by
Commodore Byron, on his first voyage round the world, and afterwards served on
the American station. In 1768 he made his second voyage round the world, in the
Endeavour, under Captain Cook, and returned a lieutenant. His third voyage of
circumnavigation was in the Resolution, and on her return, in 1775, he was
promoted to the rank of Master and Commander. When Captain Cook’s third
expedition was determined on he was appointed to command under him.
On the 23rd the ships again anchored in the harbour of
Saint Peter and Saint Paul. No sooner had they brought up than their old friend
the sergeant came on board, and all were greatly affected when he announced
that he had brought some fruit for their captain.
The charge of the expedition now devolved on Captain
Gore, who took command of the Resolution, while Captain King was appointed to
the Discovery. Captain Gore immediately sent off an express to Bolcheretsk,
requesting to be supplied with sixteen head of cattle. The stores from the
Discovery being landed, attempts were made to repair the damages she had
received. On stripping off the sheathing, three feet of the third strake under
the wale were found to be stove in, and the timbers within started. The farther
they proceeded in removing the sheathing, the more they discovered the decayed
state of the ship’s hull. The chief damage was repaired with a birch tree,
which had been cut down when they were there before, and was the only one in
the neighbourhood large enough for the purpose; but Captain King gave orders
that no more sheathing should be ripped off, being apprehensive that further
decayed planks might be met with which it would be impossible to replace. This
condition of his ship could not have been a pleasant subject of contemplation
to the commander, when he considered that he had yet more than half the circuit
of the world to make before he could reach home.
Large quantities of salmon were now caught with the
seine, and salted for sea stores, and the sea-horse blubber was also boiled
down for oil, all the candles having long been expended.
On Sunday, the 29th, the remains of Captain Gierke
were interred with all the solemnity possible, under a tree, in a spot which
the Russian Papa, or priest of the settlement, said he believed would form the
centre of a new church it was proposed shortly to build. The officers and men
of both ships walked in procession to the grave, attended by the Russian
garrison, while the ships fired minute guns, and the service being ended the
marines fired three volleys.
The remainder of the time in the harbour was spent in
waiting for stores, in further repairing the ships, in two or three
bear-hunting expeditions, in entertaining the garrison and natives in return
for the hospitality which had been received, and in receiving a visit from the
Acting Governor and other Russian officers.
On October 9, the ships having cleared the entrance of
Awatska Bay, steered to the southward for the purpose
of examining the islands to the north of Japan, and then proceeding on to
Macao. The condition of the ships’ hulls and rigging rendered it dangerous to
make any more prolonged explorations. Even the larger part of this plan it was
found impossible to follow, for, strong westerly winds blowing, they were
driven off the land, and after passing Japan they anchored at Macao. Here, not
without some delay and difficulty, they procured the stores they required;
Captain King having to make an excursion to Canton for the purpose. He here
sold about twenty sea otter and other skins, belonging chiefly to their
deceased commanders, for the sum of eight hundred dollars. On returning, he
found that the larger portion of those on board had been sold, and had realised
not much less than two thousand pounds. The large profits on the skins, which
had been looked upon as of little value beforehand, had so excited the minds of
the men that two of them made off with a six-oared cutter, for the purpose of
returning to North America; and as they were not overtaken, they probably very
soon perished.
The reports brought home by the expedition probably
set on foot that trade in furs with the west coast of North America which
afterwards became of considerable importance. In consequence of hearing, at
Macao, of the war which had broken out between England and France, the ships
mounted all their guns; but Captain Gore being informed, at the same time, that
the French had issued orders to their cruisers that the ships under the command
of Captain Cook should be treated as belonging to neutral or friendly powers,
resolved himself to preserve, throughout the remainder of the voyage, the
strictest neutrality.
The expedition left Macao on January 12, 1780, and on
the 20th anchored in a harbour of Pulo Condore. Here a supply of buffaloes was
obtained. They were large animals, and very wild. Two were kept on board the
Discovery by Captain King, who intended to take them to England. They soon
became perfectly tame, but, unfortunately, one of them suffered a severe
injury, and both were killed.
On leaving Pulo Condore the ships passed through the
Straits of Banca, in sight of the island of Sumatra. The Resolution brought up
off the island of Cracatoa, in the Straits of Sunda, and filled up her casks
with water, which the Discovery was unable to do, in consequence of being
becalmed. On reaching Cape Town the English were treated with the same kindness
and attention which they had received on their former visits. Here they
obtained confirmation of the intelligence that the French had given directions
to their cruisers not to molest them. Having taken their stores on board, they
sailed out of Table Bay on May 9, and on June 12 passed the equator for the
fourth time during their voyage.
The ships made the coast of Ireland on August 12, but
southerly winds compelled them to run to the north. On October 4 the ships
arrived at the Nore, after an absence of four years, two months, and twenty-two
days. During that time the Resolution had lost but five men by sickness, three
of whom were in a precarious state of health when leaving England, while the
Discovery did not lose a man. It is remarkable that during the whole time they
were at sea the ships never lost sight of each other for a day together, except
twice; the first time owing to an accident which happened to the Discovery off
the coast of Owhyhee, and the second to the fogs that were met with at the
entrance of Awatska Bay. A stronger proof cannot be given of the skill and
vigilance of the subaltern officers, to whom the merit of this entirely
belonged.
The death of Captain Cook was already known in England
by means of the despatches sent home through Major Behm. All that a nation
could do was done to testify respect for his memory. His widow received a
pension of 200 pounds a year, and each of his children had 25 pounds a year
settled on them. Other sums were granted to his widow, and medals were struck
to commemorate his achievements, while a coat of arms was granted to his
family.
Of his six children, three died in their infancy, and
the other three were cut off in their early manhood. The second, Nathaniel, a
promising youth, was lost, when a midshipman, on board the Thunderer, in a
hurricane off Jamaica on October 3, 1780. The youngest, Hugh, was intended for
the ministry, and died at Oxford, in the seventeenth year of his age. The
eldest, James, who was in the Navy, commanded the Spitfire sloop-of-war. He was
drowned, in 1794, at the age of thirty, when attempting to push off from Poole,
during a gale of wind, to rejoin his ship.
It is said that the bereaved mother, on receiving
tidings of the death of her last surviving son, destroyed all the letters she
had received from her husband, in the vain hope of banishing recollection of
the past. She survived, however, to the year 1835, when she died, at the age of
ninety-three.
A handsome piece of plate was presented to Major Behm,
in acknowledgment of the attention and liberality with which he treated the
English in Siberia; while gold medals were offered to the French king for his
generous orders with regard to the ships of the expedition, as also to the
Empress of Russia, as it was in her dominions, and by one of her officers, that
they had been so liberally treated.
Chapter Five.
Subsequent
History of Polynesia.
In the concluding pages of this work it is proposed to give a brief sketch of the progress of Christianity and civilisation in the islands of the Pacific visited by Captain Cook. The accounts brought home by the discoverers of the
degraded moral condition of the islanders, stirred up the hearts of Christians
in England, and when, in 1795, the London Missionary Society was formed, one of
its first proceedings was to send to those distant lands the Gospel of Christ’s
salvation.
They began their labours upon an extensive scale. They
purchased a ship, and sent out twenty-five labourers to commence missions
simultaneously at the Marquesan, Tahitian, and Friendly Islands.
The following is the account given of the reception of
this band of Christian evangelists:—
“On March 7, 1797, the first missionaries from the
Duff went on shore, and were met on the beach by the king, Pomare, and his
queen. By them they were kindly welcomed, as well as by Paitia, an aged chief
of the district. They were conducted to a large, oval-shaped native house,
which has been but recently finished for Captain Bligh, whom they expected to
return. Their dwelling was pleasantly situated on the western side of the
river, near the extremity of Point Venus. The islanders were delighted to behold
foreigners coming to take up their permanent residence among them, as those
they had heretofore seen had been transient visitors.
“The inhabitants of Tahiti, having never seen any
European females or children, were filled with amazement and delight when the
wives and children of the missionaries landed. Several times during the first
days of their residence on shore large parties arrived from different places,
in front of the house, requesting that the white women and children would come
to the door and show themselves. The chiefs and people were not satisfied with
giving them the large and commodious ‘Fare Beritani’ (British house), as they
called the one they had built for Captain Bligh, but readily and cheerfully
ceded to Captain Wilson and the missionaries, in an official and formal manner,
the district of Matavai, in which their habitation was situated. The king and
queen, with other branches of the royal family, and the most influential
persons in the nation, were present; and Haamanemane, an aged chief of Raiatea,
and chief priest of Tahiti, was the principal agent for the natives on this
occasion.
“Whatever advantages the king or chiefs might expect
to derive from this settlement on the island, it must not be supposed that any
desire to receive moral or religious instruction formed a part. A desire to
possess European property, and to receive the assistance of the Europeans in
the exercise of the mechanical arts or in their wars, was probably the motive
by which the natives were most strongly influenced.
“Having landed ten missionaries at Tongataboo, in the
Friendly Islands, Captain Wilson visited and surveyed several of the Marquesan
Islands, and left Mr Crook, a missionary, there. He then returned to Tahiti,
and on July 6 the Duff again anchored in Matavai Bay. The health of the
missionaries had not been affected by the climate. The conduct of the natives
had been friendly and respectful, and supplies in abundance had been furnished
during his absence. On August 4, 1797, the Duff finally sailed from the bay.
The missionaries returning from the ship, as well as those on shore, watched
her course, as she slowly receded from their view, under no ordinary
sensations. They now felt that they were cut off from all but Divine guidance,
protection, and support, and had parted with those by whose counsels and
presence they had been assisted in entering upon their labours, but whom, on
earth, they did not expect to meet again.
“Their acquaintance with the most useful of the
mechanic arts not only delighted the natives, but raised the missionaries in
their estimation, and led them to desire their friendship. This was strikingly
evinced on several occasions, when they beheld them use their carpenters’
tools, cut with a saw a number of boards out of a tree, which they had never
thought it possible to split into more than two, and make with these chests and
articles of furniture. When they beheld a boat built, upwards of twenty feet
long and six tons burden, they were pleased and surprised; but when the
blacksmith’s shop was erected, and the forge and anvil were first employed on
their shores, they were filled with astonishment. When the heated iron was
hammered on the anvil, and the sparks flew among them, they fancied it was
spitting at them, and were frightened, as they also were with the hissing
occasioned by immersing it in water; yet they were delighted to see the
facility with which a bar of iron was thus converted into hatchets, adzes,
fish-spears, fish-hooks, and other things. Pomare, entering one day when the
blacksmith was employed, after gazing a few minutes at the work, was so
transported at what he saw that he caught up the smith in his arms, and,
unmindful of the dirt and perspiration inseparable from his occupation, most
cordially embraced him, and saluted him, according to the custom of his
country, by touching noses.” (Abridged from Polynesian
Researches, by the Rev. W. Ellis.)
It is not to be wondered at that the favourable
reports sent home by these missionaries encouraged those who received them to believe
that almost all difficulties had already been, or were in a fair way of being
speedily overcome, and that these distant islands were, to use the figurative
language of Scripture, “stretching out their hands unto God.” They did not
know—it was wisely and mercifully hidden from them—that a long night of toil
had yet to be passed before the dawn of that better day they longed to see, and
for which they prayed and strove.
“Decisive and extensive as the change has since
become,” says the writer just quoted, “it was long before any salutary effects
appeared as the result of their endeavours; and although the scene is now one
of loveliness and quietude, cheerful, yet placid as the smooth waters of the
bay, it has often worn a very different aspect. Here the first missionaries
frequently heard the song accompanying the licentious areois dance, the
deafening noise of the worship, and saw the human victim carried by for
sacrifice. Here, too, they often heard the startling cry of war, and saw their
frightened neighbours fly before the murderous spear and plundering hand of
lawless power. The invader’s torch reduced the native hut to ashes, while the
lurid flame seared the green foliage of the trees, and clouds of smoke, rising
up among their groves, darkened, for a time, surrounding objects. On such
occasions, and they were not infrequent, the contrast between the country and
the inhabitants must have been most affecting; appearing as if the demons of
darkness had lighted up infernal fires in the bowers of paradise.”
These representations probably did not reach England
until after the missionaries had been some time in the islands, and meanwhile
the ship Duff was sent out a second time, with a strong reinforcement of thirty
additional labourers.
“God, however, for a time, appeared to disappoint all
their expectations; for this hitherto favoured ship was captured by the
Buonaparte privateer. The property was entirely lost, and the missionaries,
with their families, after suffering many difficulties and privations, returned
to England.” In addition to this trial “the Marquesan mission failed. At
Tongataboo some of the missionaries lost their lives, and that mission was, in
consequence of a series of disastrous circumstances, abandoned.” More
discouragements were in store, for “those settled at Tahiti, under such
favourable auspices, had, from fear of their lives, nearly all fled to New
South Wales; so that, after a few years, very little remained of this splendid
embassy of Christian mercy to the South Seas. A few of the brethren, however,
never abandoned their posts; and others returned after having been a short time
absent.”
In addition to all other disappointments, these
returned missionaries and their brethren appeared to be labouring in vain and
spending their strength for nought. “For sixteen years,” we are told,
“notwithstanding the untiring zeal, the incessant journeys, the faithful
exhortations of these devoted men, no spirit of interest or inquiry appeared,
no solitary instance of conversion took place; the wars of the natives
continued frequent and desolating, and their idolatries abominable and cruel.
The heavens above seemed to be as brass, and the earth as iron.
“At length,” continues the Christian historian, “two
native servants, formerly in the families of the missionaries, had received,
unknown to them, some favourable impressions, and had united together for
prayer. To these many other persons had attached themselves, so that, on the
return of the missionaries to Tahiti, at the termination of the war, they found
a great number of ‘pure Atua,’ or ‘praying people’; and they had little else to
do but to help forward the work which God had so unexpectedly and wonderfully
commenced.
“Another circumstance, demanding special observation
in reference to the commencement of the great work at Tahiti, is that,
discouraged by so many years of fruitless toil, the directors of the Society
entertained serious thoughts of abandoning the mission altogether. A few undeviating friends of that field of missionary enterprise,
however, opposed the measure.” Their persuasions prevailed, and after
special and earnest prayer to God, instead of a recall, “letters of
encouragement were written to the missionaries. And while the vessel which
carried these letters was on her passage to Tahiti, another ship was conveying
to England not only the news of the entire overthrow of idolatry, but also the
rejected idols of the people. Thus was fulfilled the gracious promise, ‘Before
they call I will answer, and while they are yet speaking I will hear.’”
(Williams’s Missionary Enterprises in the South Sea Islands.)
Among the converts of Tahiti was the king, Pomare,
who, having been severely tried by the rebellion of some part of his subjects, became deeply impressed with the insufficiency of
his idol gods to help him, and, after having recalled the banished
missionaries, listened to their instructions, and embraced the faith of
Christianity. His example being followed by a majority of his people the idols
were renounced, as already mentioned; and, as soon as he was firmly
re-established on his throne, he built a Christian church, which was opened in
the year 1819; and the first baptism of a native Tahitian was administered
within its walls, in the presence of upwards of four thousand spectators, the
king himself being the subject of the rite.
Thus inaugurating a new era in his reign, Pomare
introduced a code of useful laws, and brought about many much-needed reforms in
his kingdom. He not only proved himself a warm friend of the missionaries, but
gave them valuable assistance in the important work of translating the
Scriptures into the Tahitian tongue—a fact which proves Pomare to have been a
man of no ordinary natural abilities. He did not live long enough, however, to see the completion of this design, but, dying in 1821, he left it
to his daughter, who succeeded him in his sovereignty, taking her father’s name
Pomare.
Among the laws passed in Tahiti at this time was one
prohibiting the importation and sale of ardent spirits, which had been so great
a bane to the people; and the law was found to be beneficial to the prosperity
and moral character of the country, though the foreign traders, who had made a
large profit by its importation, were enraged when this source of gain was cut
off.
In 1835 the translation of the Bible was completed,
and its publication was attended and followed by happy accompaniments and
results. At this time the number of natives in communion with the Christian
churches throughout the island numbered over two thousand; and among the
candidates for Church fellowship were the queen herself, her husband, and her
mother.
And now arose a dark cloud which, for a time, brought
great distress upon the faithful followers of Christ in Tahiti, and was
permitted to try their constancy, while, at the same time, the freedom, and
liberty, and prosperity of the island were grievously threatened. It may be
stated, in few words, that Louis Philippe, at that time King of the French, had
set his eyes on Tahiti, and had introduced his agents into the country that an
excuse might be found for taking possession of the island. First, the consuls
insisted that, as the law prohibiting the introduction of liquor interfered
with trade, it should be rescinded. This was firmly refused. Then, two French
Roman Catholic priests were landed, but were ordered by the queen to quit the
country. They complied; but one shortly returned with a companion, and the
French admiral, appearing directly afterwards, insisted, with his guns bearing
on the town, that they should be allowed to remain, and demanded 400 pounds for
the injury they had been supposed to suffer when compelled to quit the island.
French ships continued to be sent, at frequent
intervals, and French troops were landed; the queen fled to a neighbouring
island; the people fought bravely, but were defeated; the mission-houses and
stations were destroyed; the missionaries were driven out of the country, and
Mr Pritchard, who had been a missionary, and was now British consul, was imprisoned
and otherwise ill-treated.
The Protestant missionary societies throughout Europe
and America were indignant at this conduct of a civilised nation. In
consequence of the representations of England, France desisted from her attacks
on the other islands, but Tahiti fell into her power in 1846. The French,
however, could not turn the people from the simple faith they had learned from
the English missionaries. They chose ministers from their own people, and
continued to meet and worship God with the simple forms to which they had been
accustomed, and it is a remarkable fact that Romanism, notwithstanding its
gorgeous ceremonies and corrupt practices, did not captivate them.
One only of their beloved missionaries was allowed to
remain, the Rev. William Howe, as chaplain to the British consul, and who was
ever ready to give the native pastors the benefit of his advice and assistance,
though opposed by the Romish bishop and the priests. At length, through his
earnest representations to the French Protestant missionary societies, an
appeal was made to the Emperor Napoleon, who permitted French Protestant
missionaries to go out. They were cordially received by Mr Howe and the native
preachers, and the greater part of the Romish priests were subsequently withdrawn.
In the words of a recent report of the British and
Foreign Bible Society, (that of 18 8) “The Bible still continues to supply the
inhabitants of the Tahitian group of islands with a safe guide amidst all the
errors to which they are exposed, and a sure ground of hope in the prospect of
eternity. The sale and distribution of the Scriptures progresses steadily, and
the strong attachment of the people to the truths of the Gospel remains
unabated, and forms a security against the seductions of Popery which it is not
easy to over-estimate. Games, and sports, and feasts are all alike tried to
seduce the natives from their allegiance to Him whom they have learnt to love
and to serve; and though, through the weakness of the flesh, some are attracted
and drawn aside, yet, for the most part, they soon become convinced of the
emptiness and folly of these things, and return to the sound and wholesome food
which they had been tempted to forsake.”
After leaving Tahiti, the first place at which Captain
Cook touched was the lovely and fertile island of Huaheine. This became the
refuge of the first party of missionaries when, in 1808, they were driven from
Tahiti; and it was afterwards visited by John Williams, Ellis, and others,
accompanied by some chiefs from Eimeo, who purposed forming a mission there. As
this place became, in a certain degree, the centre of operations, that
particular missionary enterprise in the Society Islands is generally known as
the Huaheine Mission.
While Mr Williams was residing at Huaheine, Tamatoa,
the King of Raiatea, who had, while visiting Eimeo and Tahiti, learned
something of the principles of Christianity, arrived with several chiefs,
entreating that missionaries might be sent to instruct their people in the
truth. Messrs Williams and Threlkeld promptly responded to the call, and
accompanied the king back to Raiatea. The population of the island was at that
time only thirteen hundred, though the island is the largest of the group, and,
from its reputed sanctity, and from being the centre and headquarters of all
the idolatries and abominations of the neighbouring islands, its chiefs
exercised great authority over them.
Tamatoa, instructed by the Holy Spirit, and aided by
others who had learnt something of the truths of Christianity, had for some
time been labouring among his fellow-islanders. He had himself been converted
by what might well be considered a providential circumstance. Two years before,
a small vessel, having on board the king, Pomare, Mr Wilson, the missionary,
and several Tahitians, had been driven by a storm from her anchorage at Eimeo
down to Raiatea. Here they were hospitably received, and continued three months, the whole of which time was employed by Mr Wilson
and the king in preaching the Gospel to the inhabitants. The chief, Tamatoa,
was among their principal converts.
After their teachers had departed, Tamatoa and his
fellow-inquirers felt an earnest desire to learn more of the truth. They built
a place of worship, met together for mutual instruction, kept holy the Sabbath,
and put away their idols and heathen practices. Several times the heathens laid
plots to destroy them, but were each time signally foiled in their wicked
plans.
At length, Tamatoa paid that memorable visit to
Huaheine which resulted in Messrs Williams and Threlkeld taking up their abode
at Raiatea. Having collected the hitherto scattered inhabitants into villages,
he built a substantial mission-house as a model, which was readily imitated.
Places of worship and schoolhouses were also built; and though many years
elapsed before the abominations of heathenism were eradicated, the great mass
of the people became not only well educated and moral, but earnest and
enlightened Christians. The satisfactory progress made by the inhabitants of
the islands where Mr Williams resided was owing,
humanly speaking, to the wonderful rapidity with which he had acquired their
language, and was able to preach to them, in it, the Gospel of Jesus Christ.
Soon after the mission at Huaheine was established Mr
Ellis set up a printing-press, from which quickly issued the
Gospel by Luke, eight hundred copies of which were sent to Raiatea. Small school-books were also printed in the native language. The desire for
instruction became general wherever missionary stations were established. Not
only the children, but adults became scholars. During the hours of instruction
other engagements were suspended, and the various scenes of busy occupation
throughout the settlements forsaken.
Such was the picture to be seen at that time in
several islands of the Society group. Borabora, or Bolabola, whose inhabitants
in Cook’s time had been the fiercest warriors of the neighbouring islands,
yielded to the benign influence of the Gospel. The history of the last island visited by the great navigator before he left
the eastern side of the Pacific for New Zealand, called by him Oheteroa, but
known generally as Rurutu, is of great interest. It is situated about two
hundred and fifty miles to the south of Raiatea. A destructive pestilence
having visited the island, two chiefs, one named Auura, built two canoes, and,
with as many of the people as they could convey, left their native shores in
search of a happier land, and to escape from their infuriated deities.
After touching at Tubuai, they were cast on the reef
surrounding Maurua. Here, instead of being murdered, as might once have been
their fate, the starving voyagers were received with all kindness and charity.
How was this? Through the agency of native teachers the people had learned the
blessed truths of the Gospel, and were trying to obey its precepts. Auura and
his companions, hearing that the white men, who had brought to their seas that
beautiful religion the practical fruits of which they had just experienced,
were living in the islands the summits of whose mountains they could see, set
sail once more, with the desire of hearing from their own lips a fuller account
of the religion they taught. They missed Borabora, but reached Raiatea. Here
they remained rather more than three months. When they were landed they were
ignorant savages, wild in appearance and habits. Before they left Auura could
read the Gospel of Matthew, had learned the greater part of the catechism drawn
up for the natives, and could write correctly. Several others could do nearly
as well, though previously ignorant that such an art as writing existed.
But these earnest men were not content to go back to
their people alone; they entreated that some missionaries would accompany them.
Two native deacons at once offered themselves, and were accepted. Auura’s great
fear was that many of his countrymen would have been carried off by the
pestilence before the glad tidings of salvation could be preached to them. At
that time a vessel belonging to a friend of the mission touched at Eaiatea, and
the captain agreed to carry Auura and his companions, with the missionaries, to
their home.
Within fifteen months after this, Rurutu was visited
by Dr Tyerman and G. Bennet, Esquire, who had been sent out by the directors of
the London Missionary Society to visit their stations in the Pacific. When they
reached it they were not certain what island it was, but were greatly surprised
at seeing several neat-looking white houses at the head of the bay. A pier, a
quarter of a mile in length, had been constructed of vast coral blocks,
affording a convenient landing-place. Besides the two comfortable
mission-houses, there was a large place of worship, eighty feet by thirty-six,
wattled, plastered, well floored and seated, built within a twelvemonth, under
the direction of the two native missionaries, who performed much of the work
with their own hands. Many of the chiefs were dressed in European clothing, and
all were attired in the most decent and becoming manner. Not a vestige of
idolatry was to be seen, not an idol was to be found in the island.
Mr Turnbull, in his account of a voyage he made to the
Pacific in 1804, describes the way in which the then savage inhabitants of
Raiatea attempted to cut off the ship in which he sailed. See the contrast in
the conduct of the people of Rurutu shortly after they had embraced
Christianity. Captain Chase commanded the Falcon, an American trader, which was
cast away on a reef off their island. He says; “The natives have given us all
the assistance in their power from the time the ship struck to the present
moment. The first day, while landing the things from the ship, they were put
into the hands of the natives, and carried up to the native mission-house, a
distance of half a mile, and not a single article of clothing was taken from
any man belonging to the ship, though they had it in their power to have
plundered us of everything that was landed. Since I have lived on shore, I, and
my officers and people, have received the kindest treatment from the natives
that can be imagined, for which I shall ever be thankful.”
Aitutaki, one of the Hervey group, was another of the
islands discovered by Captain Cook. It contained about two thousand
inhabitants, described as especially wild and savage. Mr Williams heard of it
from Auura, and on a voyage to Sydney, which he was compelled to take on
account of the health of his wife, he landed on its shores two native
missionaries, Papeiha and Vahapata. On first landing they were led by the
people to the morai and given up to the gods; but their lives were spared and
they were left at liberty. Wars broke out in the island, and all their property
was stolen; but they persevered in preaching the Gospel, and, by degrees,
gained converts. The king, Tamatoa, became a Christian; but his old grandfather
refused to give up his gods. While holding a high festival in their honour, a
beloved daughter was taken ill. In vain he besought his gods to restore her to
health; she died. In his rage, he ordered his son to set fire to his morai, and
to destroy it with his idols; two others caught fire near it, and the son was
proceeding to burn others, when the people dragged him away, expecting to see
him struck down by the vengeance of the outraged gods. As no evil consequences
followed, the idolaters began to call in question the power of their deities.
Shortly after a vessel arrived from Raiatea, bringing
another missionary, with many books, and several pigs and goats, which Papeiha
and his companion had promised the people. This raised the missionaries in
their estimation, and they with one accord threw away all their idols, and
resolved to listen to the teaching of the Gospel. On his return from Sydney, Mr
Williams, calling at Aitutaki, found that all the inhabitants had nominally
embraced Christianity, while a chapel, two hundred feet long, had been built for the worship of the true God. They have
now the entire Scriptures in their own language, and their desire after and
reverence for the Word of God are very remarkable.
The description given of the inhabitants of Aitutaki
applies equally to numerous other islands of the Pacific, which have been for
some time under missionary instruction, provided there are no ports where the
crews of foreign vessels remain any length of time, and set a bad example to
the surrounding population.
Rarotonga, one of the Hervey group, about seven
hundred miles south of Tahiti, and discovered by Williams, in 1823, when the
people were in the most savage condition, is now the chief missionary station
in the Pacific. In 1839 a missionary college was established, the buildings
consisting of a number of separate neat stone cottages, in which the married
students and their wives could reside, a lecture-room, and a room for female
classes. Up to 1844 thirty-three native missionaries, male and female, had
received instruction, and six of the young men had gone forth as pioneers to
Western Polynesia. Up to 1860 two hundred students had been admitted, a
considerable number of whom were married, and the institution had been greatly
enlarged in many respects. The course of instruction embraces theology, Church
history, Biblical exposition, biography, geography, grammar, and composition of
essays and sermons. The students are also taught several mechanical arts, and
for two or three hours every day are employed in the workshop. At the printing
establishment on the island a variety of works have been translated, printed,
and bound. In three months, ending March 1859, Bogue’s Lectures, the Pilgrim’s
Progress, twelve hundred copies of Voyages of Mission Ship,
hymn-books, Scripture lessons, and several other works were turned out of hand.
The press-work of these various books, comprising nearly three hundred thousand
sheets a year, had all been performed by young men, the first-fruits of
missionary labours before their fathers had any written language.
We must now describe the present state of other
solitary islands and groups discovered by Captain Cook. In the course of his
second voyage (1774) he fell in with a low, solitary island, which, from the
ferocity of the inhabitants, he called Savage Island. The inhabitants,
numbering between three and four thousand, for very many years remained in the
condition in which Cook found them. The first attempt to leave native
missionaries was made by the Rev. John Williams, in 1830. But the natives
refused to receive them. In 1840, and in 1842, other attempts were made. In the
latter year the Rev. A. Buzacott nearly lost his life.
Still these visits had a good effect on the younger
part of the population, who desired to see more of the strangers. Several found
their way to Samoa, where they embraced the Gospel, and two of them, after a
course of instruction at the training college in Samoa, were found well fitted
to return, and to spread its glad tidings among their benighted countrymen.
They were accordingly conveyed to Savage Island in the John Williams,
missionary ship, but were received with a good deal of suspicion by the
natives, and only one remained. He narrowly escaped being put to death, but
undauntedly persevered, and, by degrees, gathered converts around him. When
visited in 1852 by the Rev. A.W. Murray, he had upwards of two hundred sincere
believers gathered into a church, and many heathen practices had been abandoned
by others.
In 1861 the John Williams conveyed Mr and Mrs Lawes to
Savage Island. They were the first European missionaries appointed to labour
there. Hundreds of men and women, all well clothed, were assembled on the shore
to receive them. Outwardly, not a vestige of heathenism remained among them.
There were five good chapels in the island, one of which held eleven hundred,
but it was too small for the congregation. Prayer meetings were frequently
held, at which all the people in the district attended. On each occasion when
they were held by Mr Lawes not less than eight hundred were present. The whole
of the inhabitants are now professing Christians, and
a very large proportion are earnest and enlightened believers.
The reader will call to mind the incidents of Captain
Cook’s visit to the Tonga, or Friendly group, the high state of cultivation in
which he found the islands, the apparently friendly reception he met with from
the chiefs, and their treacherous purposes to cut off the ship, as they shortly
afterwards did a merchantman which visited their shores, murdering most of the
crew.
In consequence of Captain Cook’s too favourable
report, a number of missionaries were sent out by the London Missionary
Society, in the ship Duff, already mentioned, under the command of Captain
Wilson. These pious men landed on the islands in 1797, but they made no
apparent progress, and war breaking out, three of them lost their lives, and
the rest escaped to Sydney. This was in the year 1800.
In 1802, Mr Lawry, of the Wesleyan Missionary Society,
commenced a mission at Nukualofa, in Tongataboo. Though compelled for a time to
abandon it, he returned in 1826, and, through his instrumentality, Tubou, the
king, and many of his chiefs and people embraced Christianity. It is worthy of
remark that, just before this time, the London Missionary Society had commenced
a mission on the island; but they yielded up the field to the Wesleyans, while
the latter retired from Samoa, where they had commenced a mission. The
Wesleyans have since then laboured exclusively, and with most encouraging
success, in the Friendly and Fiji Islands and New Zealand, leaving to the
London Missionary Society the wide scope of the Pacific.
In 1827 the Revs. Nathaniel Turner and William Cross took up their residence at Nukualofa. At
that time Josiah Tubou was king in Tonga. Taufaahau, now King George, was king
only of Haabai, and Feenau was king of Vavou. The first became a Christian, as
did his queen, and was baptised on January 10, 1830. He died in 1845, Feenau
having previously died; thus George became king in chief, and reigns over the
three groups, Tonga, Haabai, and Vavou, or the whole of the Friendly Islands.
The labours of the two zealous missionaries just mentioned were largely blessed,
and when Tubou was baptised the congregation amounted to six hundred professing
Christians.
King Josiah’s reign was not altogether free from
difficulties. The heathen party was strong, and took up arms against him, being
supported by some French Roman Catholic priests who had settled in the islands.
They tried to embroil him, as they had already done Queen Pomare, of Tahiti,
with their own government, but were unsuccessful, and with the assistance of
King George the rebels were put down.
King George had himself become a Christian and a
preacher, and contributed greatly to the spread of the Gospel among his
countrymen. He is thus described by Mr Lawry, after he had become sovereign of
the whole group; it was in the large chapel of Nukualofa: “The king was in the
pulpit. The attention of his audience was riveted while he expounded the words
of our Lord, ‘I am come that ye might have life.’ The king is a tall, graceful
person; in the pulpit he was dressed in a black coat, and his manner was solemn
and earnest. He held in his hand a small bound manuscript book, in which his
sermon was written, but he seldom looked at it. His action was dignified, his
delivery fluent and graceful, and not without majesty. His hearers hung upon
his lips with earnest and increasing interest. Much of what he said was put
interrogatively, a mode of address which is very acceptable among the Tongans.
It was affecting to see this dignified man stretching out his hand over his
people, and to observe that one of his little fingers had been cut off: this
was formerly done as an offering to a heathen god, a custom among his people
before they became Christians. But while he bore this mark of Pagan origin, he
clearly showed that to him was grace given to preach among the Gentiles the unsearchable
riches of Christ.”
The Tongans have been especially blessed in having had
several missionaries of high character, abilities, and zeal sent among them.
There are schools sufficient for the wants of the whole population, under
native teachers, and overlooked by the missionaries, whose duties are somewhat
arduous. There is a training institution at Nukualofa, for missionaries, and
for masters and mistresses of schools. There are also schools, or colleges, for
the upper classes; indeed, many of the wants of a civilised and intelligent
community are supplied in the Tonga Islands. The population of the whole group
is supposed to amount to between thirty and forty thousand.
The islands of Western Polynesia—New Hebrides,
Loyalty, and Britannia—were little-known, or, at all events, little thought of,
till the year 1839, when they were brought into melancholy prominence by the
distressing tragedy which occurred in one of them, the island of Erromanga.
The Rev. John Williams, after his return from England
in the previous year, sailed in the Camden missionary vessel, resolved to
convey the Gospel message to the inhabitants of these remote islands, hitherto
sunk in the deepest heathen darkness. It is not too much to say that there was
no species of wickedness practised by heathens in any part of the world which
could not have found its parallel in those countries. Barbarous rites, nameless
abominations, and cannibalism in its most fearful forms characterised the whole
population. Mr Williams was accompanied by several European, and a considerable
number of native missionaries, who were to be landed as opportunities might
offer, to preach the Gospel.
Having landed missionaries at the island of Tanna and
elsewhere, with every prospect of success, the Camden proceeded to Erromanga,
off which island she arrived on November 20, 1839. Here Mr Williams, Mr Harris,
Mr Cunningham, and Captain Morgan landed, and while the two former were at a
distance from their companions, the natives attacked and killed them. The
murder had been provoked, not by the crew of the Camden, but by that of some
other ship, who had ruthlessly shot down several of
the natives and carried off their provisions. Thus the innocent suffered for
the guilty, and while the life of one eminent missionary was sacrificed, that
of another was cut off at the commencement of what might have been a course of
similar usefulness. Let it be added, as an interesting fact, that the murderer
of John Williams was afterwards converted to God, and lived as a sincere and consistent
Christian.
Notwithstanding the sad commencement of this
missionary enterprise, it was resolved to pursue it with vigour. At Aneiteum,
the first island of the New Hebrides visited by the missionary ship in 1841,
two Samoan missionaries were landed. These devoted men had much to endure, and
it was not till after years of toil that they saw any really satisfactory
results from their labours. By degrees many came to seek instruction, some of
whom abandoned their heathen practices; and subsequently other native teachers
were introduced; but when, in 1848, the Rev. J. Geddie arrived at Aneiteum, he
still found the great mass of the people fearfully degraded, and addicted to
the most horrible cruelties. Soon after his arrival eight women were strangled—one,
an interesting young woman whose husband he had been attending till he died; he
attempted to save her, and was very nearly clubbed to death by her relatives in
consequence.
A wonderful change is now evident. In 1858 there were
sixty villages on the island, each of which had a school-house or a chapel,
with a resident teacher. Nearly the whole of the New Testament, and some books
of the Old, had been translated, and a large number of these lately degraded
heathens could both read and write.
Fatuna is a small island, containing about a thousand
inhabitants. Here Williams touched just before his death; but no teachers were
left there. A couple of years afterwards, however, two Samoan evangelists,
Samuela and Apela, were landed, the former accompanied by his wife. They
laboured for four years with some success, when a severe epidemic breaking out
among the inhabitants they were accused of being its cause, and were killed and
eaten. Samuela’s faithful wife was offered her life if she would become one of
the wives of the chief. She replied, “I came to teach you what is right, not to
sin amongst you.” No sooner had she uttered the words than she fell beneath the
club of a savage. Notwithstanding this tragedy, missionaries from the lately
heathen Aneiteum have gone to Fatuna, and many of the savages have been
converted.
At Tanna, supposed to possess fifteen thousand
inhabitants, Mr Williams left three missionaries the day before he was murdered
at Erromanga; but two of them soon died, the climate being more injurious to
the natives of Eastern Polynesia than to Europeans. In 1842 Messrs Turner and
Nisbet were sent to occupy the island, but were driven away by the savages, and
sought shelter in Samoa. Native teachers from Aneiteum, however, took their
places, and met with some success; and in 1858 several European missionaries
landed on the island; and the larger part of the people have come to the truth.
With Erromanga the name of Williams will always be
associated. After his death, native evangelists from Samoa and Rarotonga landed
on its shores, but died, or were compelled to leave, from the effects of the
climate. In 1857 the Rev. G.N. Gordon, and his wife, took up their residence on
the island. They laboured on with considerable success, Oviladon, the chief of
the district, being among the first-fruits of their toils. The greater number
of the inhabitants of his district also became Christians.
An epidemic, however, broke out in 1860, and the
heathen inhabitants of another district, believing that it was caused by the
Christians, attacked the settlement, and killed Mr and Mrs Gordon. The day
after they were buried, amidst the tears and lamentations of the people; the
native teacher, who had escaped, stood beside the grave, and delivered an
address which powerfully affected the bystanders.
In the large island of Faté or Vaté, Christian
teachers have been landed at different times, but some have been killed and
eaten, and others have died of disease. In 1858, however, three teachers, with
their wives, were landed under encouraging circumstances. From Nina, a small
island near Tanna, several of the natives, hearing of the wonderful things
taking place on the latter island, proceeded thither to procure a teacher. In
consequence of their application, in 1858, the John Williams took them two from
Aneiteum, who are now labouring successfully among them.
The Loyalty group must be briefly noticed. Native
teachers were landed in 1841, and after they had induced many natives to
abandon heathenism, Messrs Jones and Creagh arrived in the island in 1854.
Their labours have been blessed; the Gospels and other parts of the Scriptures
have been printed in the Nengonese language, and upwards of three thousand of
the inhabitants are under Christian instruction, although a large number of the
natives still follow their heathen customs.
The mission in Lifu was not commenced till 1843, when
native evangelists were landed, and in 1858 two European missionaries arrived
to take charge of the work. The inhabitants amount to about ten thousand, and of these very few, if any, now remain
heathens, though it is to be feared that the great mass of the converts can
only be looked on as nominal Christians.
The small Britannia group, near New Caledonia, has
been occupied by teachers from Rarotonga and Mars since 1837, but Roman
Catholic priests have arrived on the principal island, sent, they say, by the
French governor of New Caledonia. They have built a capital, called Porte de
France, but it is a penal colony, and free emigrants have not been attracted to
its shores.
The last islands visited by Captain Cook were those to
which he gave the name of the Sandwich Islands, and which now form the small
but independent kingdom of Hawaii, having a capital called Honolulu, with a
population of eleven thousand, not less than a thousand of whom are white
foreigners. With its well-paved, lighted streets, its king’s palace, its houses
of parliament, its cathedral church, its numerous hotels, its police, and other
accompaniments of high civilisation, it is difficult to imagine that a hundred
years ago this was the home of tattooed savages. To Englishmen in advanced
years, indeed, the murder of Captain Cook at Owhyhee seems like an event that
happened in their own childhood. And, in truth, not
fifty years ago the natives of Hawaii were ignorant and idolatrous heathens,
while it is but as yesterday that a refined, elegant, and well-educated lady,
the queen of those islands, was visiting England.
When Cook was killed Kalampupua was king. He was
succeeded by his nephew, Kamehamea the First, who made himself sovereign of the
entire group. When visited by Captain Vancouver, in 1793, it is said that he
requested that Christian missionaries might be sent to him. Whether Captain
Vancouver delivered the message to the English Government or not, no attention
was paid to it. Captain Vancouver, however, returned the next year with some
horned cattle and sheep, which he presented to the king, obtaining a promise
that none should be killed for the space of ten years. This promise was faithfully
kept; but so rapidly did the animals increase that they became exceedingly
troublesome to the natives by injuring their fences and taro plantations. They
were accordingly driven into the mountains, where they now form a source of
considerable wealth to the nation.
Kamehamea was about to abolish the taboo system when
he died in 1819, and was succeeded by his son Liholiho, who took the name of
Kamehamea the Second. He carried into effect his father’s intention, and also
destroyed his temples and gods.
In that very year the American Board of Missions
resolved to send to the Sandwich Islands an efficient band of missionaries with
three native youths who had been educated in the States. Joyful and totally
unexpected news awaited them on their arrival. Idolatry was overthrown, and the
king and most of his chiefs were ready to afford them protection and support.
They had, however, an arduous task before them in their efforts to impart
instruction to a population numbering at least one hundred thousand, dwelling
in eight islands, with a superficial area of seven thousand square miles;
Owhyhee alone, now written Hawaii, being four hundred and fifteen miles in
circumference.
In 1824 there were fifty native teachers and two
thousand scholars, and so rapidly did education advance, that in 1831 there
were eleven hundred schools, in which fully seventeen hundred scholars had
obtained the branches of a common education, and were able to read, write, and
sum up simple accounts. The prime minister, seven leading chiefs, and the
regent were members of the Christian Church; and a very decided change was
manifest in the general population.
Within a few years the language was reduced to a
written form, and two printing-presses were at work at Honolulu. A large
edition of the Gospels in the Hawaii language, printed in the United States,
was in circulation and there were no less than nine hundred schools and
forty-five thousand scholars. In 1853, after a great awakening, there were
above twenty-two thousand church members, and there were chapels at all the
stations. One at Lahaina could hold three thousand persons.
In 1853 the mission of the American Board was
dissolved, their object having been fully realised in Christianising the
people, planting churches, and making them self-supporting. Kamehamea the
Third, the brother and successor of the king, who died in England, reigned well
and wisely till 1854. On his death, Prince Alexander Liholiho, a well-educated
and religiously disposed young man, became king. His wife is the Queen Emma who
once visited England. They lost their only son in 1862. This so affected the
king that he never recovered from the shock.
He was succeeded by his brother who reigned over the
kingdom for some years, under the title of Kamehamea the Fifth. His uncle had
established a too democratic constitution; he has given the people one more
suited to their ideas and the state of the country. The chamber of nobles and
that of the representatives of the people are convoked every two years. It is
their duty to make the laws and to vote supplies. Several foreigners are
employed in the government, and the foreign population of English, Americans,
French, and Germans is increasing rapidly.
The Hawaiians own a considerable number of vessels,
which trade to China, California, British Columbia, and other parts of the
Pacific. The national flag is composed of coloured stripes with the Union-Jack
of old England quartered in the corner. The independence of the island kingdom
is guaranteed by England, France, and America, and it will probably continue,
as it is at present, in advance of all the other states which may arise in the
Pacific. With these signs of prosperity, it is no wonder that Romish priests
are doing all in their power to spread their tenets through the Sandwich Islands.
But the Bible and a free press will, it is devoutly to
be hoped, triumph.
Among other publications constantly issuing from the
Hawaiian press are several newspapers, both in English and the native language,
which have a wide circulation. That there is a steady increase in the commerce
of the country is shown by the exports of sugar, coffee, and other produce,
while several manufactures have been introduced to give employment especially
to the women. The port of Honolulu has long been the chief resort of whale
ships in the Pacific, and now many others, trading between the coasts of
America and Asia, call there for supplies.
Other islands and shores visited by Cook remain in
much the same condition as in his day. The sorrowful history of the attempt to
convey the Gospel to the inhabitants of Tierra del Fuego, by Captain Allan
Gardiner, is too well-known to require further mention. Java has been restored
to its original masters, the Dutch; and the Cape of Good Hope is now a British
colony. The great southern land of which Cook went in search has been found to
exist, though its approach is guarded by immense barriers of ice; and the great
problem of a north-west passage has been solved by the sacrifice of some of
England’s bravest sons.
Not much need be added in the closing paragraphs of
this volume. In following the interesting narrative of the voyages of the
eminent discoverer whose name is a household word in English biography, the
reader, while he sees some things to regret, will award to him a well-deserved
tribute of admiration for his courage and skill, his perseverance and
enterprising spirit. One thing was set before him, and that one thing he did.
His main object was scientific; his first voyage was undertaken to observe the
transit of the planet Venus, the Royal Society having represented that
important service would be rendered to the interests of astronomical science by
the appointment of properly qualified individuals to observe that phenomenon.
The second was in search of a southern continent, which, at that time, was a
favourite object of geographical speculation. The third and last was to
endeavour to find a passage from the Pacific into the Atlantic Ocean. These
objects were praiseworthy, yet they were not the highest aims of the truest and
purest ambition. To be a martyr for science was earthly glory; but to be a
willing martyr for God is glory, honour, immortality, and eternal life.
The discoveries made by Captain Cook were barren of
any results beyond those which are necessarily doomed to perish when the world
and all that is in it shall be dissolved, until God was pleased, in His own
good time, and by the influence of His gracious Spirit operating on the minds
of His servants, to make them show forth His praise. Then was made manifest His
almighty power, His infinite wisdom, and His amazing love, in the triumphs of
the Gospel of the Lord Jesus Christ in the very strongholds of Satan and sin;
conveying to His waiting people the assurance also that He had listened, and
still listens, to their aspirations and prayers.
The End.
|